334 20 7MB
English Pages 129
BY APPOINTMENT TO HER MAJESTY QUEEN ELIZABETH II MANUFACTURERS OF DAIMLER AND JAGUAR CARS JAGUAR CARS LIMITED COVENTRY
BY APPOINTMENT TO HER MAJESTY QUEEN ELIZABETH THE QUEEN MOTHER MANUFACTURERS OF DAIMLER AND JAGUAR CARS JAGUAR CARS LIMITED COVENTRY
BY APPOINTMENT TO HIS ROYAL HIGHNESS THE PRINCE OF WALES MANUFACTURERS OF DAIMLER AND JAGUAR CARS JAGUAR CARS LIMITED COVENTRY
1998 Range Electrical Guide
Published by Parts and Service Communications Jaguar Cars Limited Publication Part Number – JTP 615
XK8 Range 1998
Introduction
Electrical Guide Format This Electrical Guide is made up of tw o major sections. The first section, at the front of the book, provides general information for and about the use of the book, and information and illustrations to aid in the understanding of the XK8 electrical / electronic systems, as w ell as the location and identification of components. The second section includes the Figures, w hich are the basis of the book. Each Figure is identified by a Figure Number (i.e. Fig. 01.1) and Title, and is accompanied by a page of data containing information specific to that Figure. It is recommended that the user read through the front section of the book to develop a familiarity w ith the layout of the book and w ith the system of symbols and abbreviations used. The Table of Contents on the follow ing pages should help to guide the user.
Standard Abbreviations The follow ing abbreviations are used throughout this Electrical Guide: B+ Battery Voltage CAN Controller Area Netw ork COUPE Coupe Vehicles CONV. Convertible Vehicles DI Direction Indicator LH Left-Hand LHD Left-Hand Drive NAS North American Specification RH Right-Hand RHD Right-Hand Drive ROW Rest of World SCP Standard Corporate Protocol Netw ork VIN Vehicle Identification Number Refer to the vehicle Service M anual for a glossary of standard terms and their abbreviations.
Vehicle Identification Numbers (VIN) VIN ranges are presented throughout the book in the follow ing manner:
➞ VIN 123456 indicates “ up to VIN 123456” ; VIN 123456 ➞ indicates “ from VIN 123456 on” . X K8 Electrical System Architecture The XK8 system “ architecture” is new to Jaguar vehicles and features vehicle multiplexing. M ultiplexing allow s for greatly simplified w iring harnesses, w hile at the same time allow ing flexibility in programming market variants. Tw o data netw orks are used in the system: a controller area netw ork (CAN) for the engine, drive train and related systems, and a standard corporate protocol netw ork (SCP) for the body systems. Any vehicle subsystem depicted on the figures w ith the CAN or SCP included uses data derived from the netw ork, or transmits data via the netw ork to achieve control. M essages for both netw orks are cataloged in the Appendix of this book. When appropriate, the user w ill be referred to the Appendix by a note on the Data page. In addition to the tw o netw orks, the XK8 uses a serial data bus (ISO) for diagnostics and for the programming of certain control modules. The XK8 uses both pow er and logic grounds; how ever, it does not use a common logic ground stud connection as in previous vehicles.
D A TE OF ISSU E:
SEPTEM BER 1 9 9 7
1
Table of Contents
XK8 Range 1998
Component Index ........................................................................................................ 5 – 9 User Instructions ........................................................................................................ 10 – 15 Connectors ................................................................................................................ 16 M ain Pow er Distribution; Ground Point Identification and Location ............................. 17 Harness Layout .......................................................................................................... 18 Control M odule Identification and Location ................................................................. 19 Control M odule Connector Pin Identification and Location .......................................... 20 – 22 Relay and Fuse Box Identification and Location .......................................................... 23
NOTE: The Appendix, w hich contains a catalog of CAN and SCP Netw ork messages, follow s the Figure and Data pages.
2
D A TE OF ISSU E:
SEPTEM BER 1 9 9 7
XK8 Range 1998
FIGURES Fig. Description
Table of Contents
Variant
01 Power Distribution 01.1 ...... M ain Pow er Distribution ................................................................ All Vehicles 01.2 ...... Battery Pow er Distribution: Driver and Passenger Fuse Boxes ....... All Vehicles 01.3 ...... Battery Pow er Distribution: Trunk, Engine Compartment and EM S Fuse Boxes ........................................................................... All Vehicles 01.4 ...... Ignition Sw itched Pow er Distribution ............................................. All Vehicles 01.5 ...... Engine M anagement Sw itched Pow er Distribution ........................ All Vehicles 02 Ground Distribution 02.1 ...... Ignition Sw itched Ground Distribution ............................................ All Vehicles 03 Battery; Starter; Generator 03.1 ...... Battery; Starter; Generator: AJ26 N/A ............................................ AJ26 N/A Vehicles 03.2 ...... Battery; Starter; Generator: AJ26 SC .............................................. AJ26 SC Vehicles 04 04.1 04.2 04.3 04.4 04.5
...... ...... ...... ...... ......
Engine Management AJ26 N/A NAS Engine M anagement: Part 1 ................................... AJ26 N/A NAS Vehicles VIN 024687 AJ26 N/A ROW Engine M anagement: Part 1 ................................. AJ26 N/A ROW Vehicles VIN 024687 AJ26 N/A Engine M anagement: Part 2 ........................................... AJ26 N/A Vehicles VIN 024687 AJ26 SC ROW Engine M anagement: Part 1 ................................... AJ26 SC ROW Vehicles AJ26 SC ROW Engine M anagement: Part 2 ................................... AJ26 SC ROW Vehicles
➞
➞ ➞
05 Transmission 05.1 ...... AJ26 N/A Automatic Transmission ................................................. AJ26 N/A Vehicles 05.2 ...... AJ26 SC Automatic Transmission .................................................. AJ26 SC Vehicles 05.3 ...... Gearshift Interlock .......................................................................... All Vehicles 06 Anti-Lock Braking; Traction Control 06.1 ...... Anti-Lock Braking; Traction Control ................................................ All Vehicles 07 Climate Control 07.1 ...... Climate Control: Part 1 ................................................................... All Vehicles 07.2 ...... Climate Control: Part 2 ................................................................... All Vehicles 08 Instrumentation; Audible Warnings 08.1 ...... Instrument Packs ........................................................................... All Vehicles 08.2 ...... Audible Warnings ........................................................................... All Vehicles 09 Exterior Lighting 09.1 ...... Exterior Lighting: Front ................................................................... All Vehicles 09.2 ...... Exterior Lighting: Rear .................................................................... All Vehicles 09.3 ...... Headlamp Leveling ........................................................................ Headlamp Leveling Vehicles
D A TE OF ISSU E:
FEBRU A RY 1 9 9 8
3
Table of Contents
FIGURES Fig. Description
XK8 Range 1998
Variant
10 Interior Lighting 10.1 ...... Interior Lighting .............................................................................. All Vehicles 10.2 ...... Dimmer-Controlled Lighting ........................................................... All Vehicles 11 11.1 11.2 11.3 11.4 11.5
...... ...... ...... ...... ......
Steering; Mirrors; Suspension Pow er Assisted Steering ................................................................ All Vehicles Steering Column M ovement .......................................................... All Vehicles M irror M ovement .......................................................................... All Vehicles Interior and Exterior M irrors; Fold-Back M irrors .............................. All Vehicles Suspension Adaptive Damping ...................................................... Adaptive Damping Vehicles
12 12.1 12.2 12.3 12.4
...... ...... ...... ......
Seat Systems Driver Seat: M emory ...................................................................... M emory Seat Vehicles Driver Seat: Non M emory .............................................................. Non M emory Seat Vehicles Passenger Seat: 3-Way M ovement ................................................ 3-Way M ovement Vehicles Passenger Seat: 2-Way M ovement ................................................ 2-Way M ovement Vehicles
13 Door Locking; Security 13.1 ...... Central Door Locking ..................................................................... All Vehicles
14 Wash / Wipe System 14.1 ...... Wash / Wipe System ..................................................................... All Vehicles 15 Window Lifts; Convertible Top 15.1 ...... Window Lifts ................................................................................. All Vehicles 15.2 ...... Convertible Top .............................................................................. Convertible Vehicles 16 16.1 16.2 16.3 16.4
...... ...... ...... ......
In-Car Entertainment; Telephone Standard In-Car Entertainment: Convertible .................................... Convertible Vehicles Standard In-Car Entertainment: Coupe ........................................... Coupe Vehicles Premium In-Car Entertainment ....................................................... Premium ICE Vehicles Radio Telephone ............................................................................ All Vehicles
17 Supplementary Restraint System 17.1 ...... Airbag System ............................................................................... All Vehicles 18 Ancillaries 18.1 ...... Ancillaries: Horns; Cigar Lighters; Accessory Connectors; Garage Door Opener ...................................................................... All Vehicles 19 Vehicle Multiplex Systems 19.1 ...... CAN (Netw ork); SCP Netw ork; Serial Data Links ............................ All Vehicles
4
D A TE OF ISSU E:
FEBRU A RY 1 9 9 8
XK8 Range 1998 ABS / TRACTION CONTROL CONTROL M ODULE ................. Fig. 06.1 ................................................................................................ Fig. 19.1 ACCELEROM ETERS ............................................................... Fig. 11.5 ACTIVE SECURITY SOUNDER ................................................ Fig. 13.2 ADAPTIVE DAM PING CONTROL M ODULE ............................ Fig. 11.5 ................................................................................................ Fig. 19.1 AIR CONDITIONING COM PRESSOR CLUTCH ....................... Fig. 04.3 ................................................................................................ Fig. 07.2 AIR CONDITIONING CONTROL M ODULE .............................. Fig. 04.3 ................................................................................................ Fig. 07.1 ................................................................................................ Fig. 07.2 ................................................................................................ Fig. 19.1 AIR CONDITIONING CONTROL PANEL .................................. Fig. 07.1 ................................................................................................ Fig. 10.2 AIR INTAKE – LH ..................................................................... Fig. 07.1 AIR INTAKE – RH ..................................................................... Fig. 07.1 AIRBAG / SRS CONTROL M ODULE ....................................... Fig. 17.1 ................................................................................................ Fig. 19.1 AIRBAG INTERROGATION CONNECTOR ............................... Fig. 17.1
Component Index BRAKE SWITCH – LHD ........................................................... Fig. 04.1 ................................................................................................ Fig. 04.2 ................................................................................................ Fig. 05.2 ................................................................................................ Fig. 06.1 ................................................................................................ Fig. 09.2 ................................................................................................ Fig. 11.5 BRAKE SWITCH – RHD ........................................................... Fig. 04.1 ................................................................................................ Fig. 04.2 ................................................................................................ Fig. 05.2 ................................................................................................ Fig. 06.1 ................................................................................................ Fig. 09.2 ................................................................................................ Fig. 11.5 CAM SHAFT POSITION SENSOR ............................................ Fig. 04.1 ................................................................................................ Fig. 04.2 CANISTER CLOSE VALVE ....................................................... Fig 04.1 CD AUTO-CHANGER............................................................... Fig. 16.1 ................................................................................................ Fig. 16.2 ................................................................................................ Fig. 16.3 CENTER CONSOLE SWITCH PACK ........................................ Fig. 09.1 ................................................................................................ Fig. 09.2 ................................................................................................ Fig. 10.2
AIRBAGS ................................................................................. Fig. 17.1
CIGAR LIGHTERS .................................................................... Fig. 10.2 ................................................................................................ Fig. 18.1
AM BIENT TEM PERATURE SENSOR....................................... Fig. 07.1
COLUM N JOY STICK (COLUM N SWITCHGEAR) .................... Fig. 11.2
ANTENNA M OTOR ................................................................. Fig. 16.3
CONVERTIBLE TOP PUM P ..................................................... Fig. 15.2
ASPIRATOR ASSEM BLY ......................................................... Fig. 07.1
CONVERTIBLE TOP SWITCH .................................................. Fig. 10.2 ................................................................................................ Fig. 15.2
AUDIBLE WARNING SPEAKER (COLUM N SWITCHGEAR) .... Fig. 08.2 COOLANT LEVEL SWITCH ..................................................... Fig. 08.1 AUTO TILT SWITCH (COLUM N SWITCHGEAR)...................... Fig. 11.2 CRUISE CONTROL ON / OFF SWITCH ................................... Fig. 10.2 BATTERY ................................................................................. Fig. 01.1 ................................................................................................ Fig. 03.1
CRUISE CONTROL SWITCH ................................................... Fig. 04.3
BLOWER M OTORS ................................................................ Fig. 07.2
CRUISE CONTROL SWITCHES (STEERING WHEEL) .............. Fig. 04.3
BODY PROCESSOR M ODULE ................................................ Fig. 01.1 ................................................................................................ Fig. 03.1 ................................................................................................ Fig. 05.2 ................................................................................................ Fig. 08.2 ................................................................................................ Fig. 09.1 ................................................................................................ Fig. 09.2 ................................................................................................ Fig. 10.1 ................................................................................................ Fig. 11.2 ................................................................................................ Fig. 11.3 ................................................................................................ Fig. 11.4 ................................................................................................ Fig. 12.1 ................................................................................................ Fig. 12.2 ................................................................................................ Fig. 12.3 ................................................................................................ Fig. 12.4 ................................................................................................ Fig. 13.1 ................................................................................................ Fig. 13.2 ................................................................................................ Fig. 13.3 ................................................................................................ Fig. 14.1 ................................................................................................ Fig. 15.1 ................................................................................................ Fig. 18.1 ................................................................................................ Fig. 19.1
D – 4 SWITCH ......................................................................... Fig. 05.1 DAM PER SOLENOIDS ............................................................ Fig. 11.5 DATA LINK CONNECTOR ....................................................... Fig. 19.1 DIM M ER CONTROL (COLUM N SWITCHGEAR) ..................... Fig. 10.2 DIM M ER M ODULE ................................................................. Fig. 10.2 DIODE (BT29) – TRUNK SWITCH ............................................ Fig. 10.1 DOOR CONTROL M ODULE – DRIVER ................................... Fig. 10.1 ................................................................................................ Fig. 11.2 ................................................................................................ Fig. 11.3 ................................................................................................ Fig. 11.4 ................................................................................................ Fig. 12.1 ................................................................................................ Fig. 13.1 ................................................................................................ Fig. 13.2 ................................................................................................ Fig. 13.3 ................................................................................................ Fig. 15.1 ................................................................................................ Fig. 15.2 ................................................................................................ Fig. 19.1
BRAKE CANCEL SWITCH – LHD ............................................. Fig. 04.3 BRAKE CANCEL SWITCH – RHD ............................................ Fig. 04.3 BRAKE FLUID RESERVOIR ..................................................... Fig. 06.1
D A TE OF ISSU E:
SEPTEM BER 1 9 9 7
5
Component Index DOOR CONTROL M ODULE – PASSENGER ........................... Fig. 10.1 ................................................................................................ Fig. 11.3 ................................................................................................ Fig. 13.1 ................................................................................................ Fig. 13.2 ................................................................................................ Fig. 13.3 ................................................................................................ Fig. 15.1 ................................................................................................ Fig. 15.2 ................................................................................................ Fig. 19.1 DOOR LOCK ACTUATORS ..................................................... Fig. 13.1 DOOR LOCK SWITCH – PASSENGER .................................... Fig. 13.1 DOOR LOCK SWITCHES – DRIVER ........................................ Fig. 10.1 ................................................................................................ Fig. 13.1 ................................................................................................ Fig. 13.2 ................................................................................................ Fig. 13.3 ................................................................................................ Fig. 15.1 DOOR M IRROR M OTORS ...................................................... Fig. 11.3 DOOR M IRRORS .................................................................... Fig. 07.2 ................................................................................................ Fig. 11.4 DOOR SWITCH – DRIVER ....................................................... Fig. 10.1 ................................................................................................ Fig. 11.2 ................................................................................................ Fig. 11.3 ................................................................................................ Fig. 13.1 ................................................................................................ Fig. 13.2 ................................................................................................ Fig. 13.3 DOOR SWITCH – PASSENGER ............................................... Fig. 10.1 ................................................................................................ Fig. 13.1 ................................................................................................ Fig. 13.2 ................................................................................................ Fig. 13.3 ECM AND TCM COOLING FAN .............................................. Fig. 04.1 ................................................................................................ Fig. 04.2 ENGINE COM PARTM ENT SECURITY SWITCH ...................... Fig. 13.2 ................................................................................................ Fig. 13.3 ENGINE CONTROL M ODULE ................................................. Fig. 03.1 ................................................................................................ Fig. 04.1 ................................................................................................ Fig. 04.2 ................................................................................................ Fig. 04.3 ................................................................................................ Fig. 05.2 ................................................................................................ Fig. 07.2 ................................................................................................ Fig. 13.2 ................................................................................................ Fig. 13.3 ................................................................................................ Fig. 19.1 ENGINE COOLANT TEM PERATURE SENSOR ........................ Fig. 04.1 ................................................................................................ Fig. 04.2 ENGINE SPEED SENSOR ........................................................ Fig. 04.1 ................................................................................................ Fig. 04.2
XK8 Range 1998 FUEL PUM P ............................................................................ Fig. 04.3 FUEL TANK PRESURE SENSOR ............................................. Fig. 04.1 FULL RANGE SPEAKERS ........................................................ Fig. 16.1 ................................................................................................ Fig. 16.2 FUSE BOX – DRIVER SIDE ...................................................... Fig. 01.1 ................................................................................................ Fig. 01.2 ................................................................................................ Fig. 01.4 FUSE BOX – ENGINE COM PARTM ENT .................................. Fig. 01.1 ................................................................................................ Fig. 01.3 ................................................................................................ Fig. 01.4 ................................................................................................ Fig. 07.2 ................................................................................................ Fig. 09.1 ................................................................................................ Fig. 13.2 ................................................................................................ Fig. 13.3 ................................................................................................ Fig. 14.1 ................................................................................................ Fig. 18.1 FUSE BOX – ENGINE M ANAGEM ENT .................................... Fig. 01.1 ................................................................................................ Fig. 01.3 ................................................................................................ Fig. 01.5 FUSE BOX – PASSENGER SIDE .............................................. Fig. 01.1 ................................................................................................ Fig. 01.2 ................................................................................................ Fig. 01.4 FUSE BOX – TRUNK ................................................................ Fig. 01.1 ................................................................................................ Fig. 01.3 ................................................................................................ Fig. 01.4 ................................................................................................ Fig. 04.3 ................................................................................................ Fig. 07.2 ................................................................................................ Fig. 09.2 ................................................................................................ Fig. 18.1 GARAGE DOOR OPENER (ROOF CONSOLE) ......................... Fig. 18.1 GEAR SELECTOR ILLUM INATION M ODULE ......................... Fig. 05.1 ................................................................................................ Fig. 05.2 ................................................................................................ Fig. 10.2 ................................................................................................ Fig. 19.1 GEARSHIFT INTERLOCK SOLENOID ...................................... Fig. 05.2 GENERATOR ........................................................................... Fig. 03.1 GLASS BREAKAGE SENSOR (ROOF CONSOLE) .................... Fig. 13.2 GLOVE BOX LAM P ................................................................. Fig. 10.1 HANDSET ................................................................................ Fig. 16.4 HEADLAM P LEVELING ACTUATORS ..................................... Fig. 09.3 HEATED BACKLIGHT .............................................................. Fig. 07.2 HEATED OXYGEN SENSORS .................................................. Fig. 04.1 ................................................................................................ Fig. 04.2
EVAPORATIVE EM ISSION CONTROL VALVE ......................... Fig. 04.1 ................................................................................................ Fig. 04.2
HEATER PUM P ....................................................................... Fig. 07.2
EVAPORATOR / HEATER M ATRIX ASSEM BLY ...................... Fig. 07.1
HEATER VALVE ....................................................................... Fig. 07.2
FASCIA ACCESSORY CONNECTOR ....................................... Fig. 18.1
HIGH-M OUNTED STOP LAM P ................................................ Fig. 09.2
FOOT WELL LAM PS ............................................................... Fig. 10.1
HIGH POWER PROTECTION M ODULE .................................. Fig. 01.1 ................................................................................................ Fig. 03.1
FRONT FOG LAM PS ............................................................... Fig. 09.1 FRONT LAM P UNITS .............................................................. Fig. 09.1 FUEL FILL FLAP SOLENOID ................................................... Fig. 13.1 FUEL INJECTORS ................................................................... Fig. 04.3
HORN SWITCHES (STEERING WHEEL) .................................. Fig. 18.1 HORNS .................................................................................... Fig. 13.2 ................................................................................................ Fig. 13.3 ................................................................................................ Fig. 18.1
FUEL LEVEL SENSOR ............................................................. Fig. 08.1
6
D A TE OF ISSU E:
SEPTEM BER 1 9 9 7
XK8 Range 1998 IGNITION COILS...................................................................... Fig. 04.3 IGNITION M ODULES .............................................................. Fig. 04.3 IGNITION SWITCH (KEY-IN SWITCH) ...................................... Fig. 10.1 ................................................................................................ Fig. 11.2 ................................................................................................ Fig. 13.1 IGNITION SWITCH .................................................................. Fig. 02.1 ................................................................................................ Fig. 03.1 IM PACT SENSORS.................................................................. Fig. 17.1
Component Index M INOR INSTRUM ENT PACK .................................................. Fig. 08.1 ................................................................................................ Fig. 10.2 M IRROR JOY STICK (DRIVER DOOR SWITCH PACK) ............ Fig. 11.3 ................................................................................................ Fig. 11.4 M ODE SWITCH (TRANSM ISSION) ......................................... Fig. 05.1 ................................................................................................ Fig. 10.2 NEUTRAL SWITCH .................................................................. Fig. 03.1
INERTIA SWITCH .................................................................... Fig. 02.1
NOT-IN-PARK M ICROSWITCH ................................................ Fig. 05.2 ................................................................................................ Fig. 11.2 ................................................................................................ Fig. 11.3 ................................................................................................ Fig. 13.1
INTERIOR REAR VIEW M IRROR ............................................. Fig. 11.4
NUM BER PLATE LAM PS ........................................................ Fig. 09.2
KEY FOB ANTENNAS .............................................................. Fig. 13.1 ................................................................................................ Fig. 13.2 ................................................................................................ Fig. 13.3
OIL PRESSURE SWITCH ......................................................... Fig. 08.1
INCLINATION SENSOR ........................................................... Fig. 13.2
KEY TRANSPONDER M ODULE .............................................. Fig. 03.1 ................................................................................................ Fig. 13.2 ................................................................................................ Fig. 13.3 ................................................................................................ Fig. 19.1 KEYLOCK SOLENOID (COLUM N SWITCHGEAR) ................... Fig. 05.2 KICKDOWN SWITCH – LHD .................................................... Fig. 05.1 KICKDOWN SWITCH – RHD ................................................... Fig. 05.1
PARKING BRAKE SWITCH ...................................................... Fig. 04.1 ................................................................................................ Fig. 04.2 PASSIVE SECURITY SOUNDER .............................................. Fig. 13.2 ................................................................................................ Fig. 13.3 PEDAL POSITION AND M ECHANICAL GUARD SENSORS .... Fig. 04.1 ................................................................................................ Fig. 04.2 POWER AM PLIFIER ................................................................ Fig. 16.3 POWER ASSISTED STEERING CONTROL M ODULE.............. Fig. 11.1 POWER WASH PUM P ............................................................ Fig. 14.1
KNOCK SENSORS ................................................................... Fig. 04.1 ................................................................................................ Fig. 04.2
PUDDLE LAM PS ..................................................................... Fig. 10.1
LAM P CONTROL M ODULE .................................................... Fig. 09.2
QUARTER LIGHT LIFTS........................................................... Fig. 15.2
LATCH CONTROL VALVE ....................................................... Fig. 15.2
RADIATOR FAN CONTROL RELAY M ODULE ........................ Fig. 04.3 ................................................................................................ Fig. 07.2
LEVELING SWITCH (CENTER CONSOLE SWITCH PACK) ...... Fig. 09.3 LIGHTING STALK (COLUM N SWITCHGEAR) .......................... Fig. 09.1 ................................................................................................ Fig. 09.2 ................................................................................................ Fig. 10.2 ................................................................................................ Fig. 11.4 ................................................................................................ Fig. 14.1 M AIN CONTROL VALVE ......................................................... Fig. 15.2 M AJOR INSTRUM ENT PACK .................................................. Fig. 05.2 ................................................................................................ Fig. 08.1 ................................................................................................ Fig. 09.1 ................................................................................................ Fig. 09.2 ................................................................................................ Fig. 10.2 ................................................................................................ Fig. 11.3 ................................................................................................ Fig. 11.4 ................................................................................................ Fig. 12.1 ................................................................................................ Fig. 13.2 ................................................................................................ Fig. 13.3 ................................................................................................ Fig. 15.1 ................................................................................................ Fig. 15.2 ................................................................................................ Fig. 16.1 ................................................................................................ Fig. 16.2 ................................................................................................ Fig. 16.3 ................................................................................................ Fig. 19.1
RADIATOR FANS .................................................................... Fig. 04.3 ................................................................................................ Fig. 07.2 RADIO / CASSETTE HEAD UNIT ............................................. Fig. 16.1 ................................................................................................ Fig. 16.2 ................................................................................................ Fig. 16.3 ................................................................................................ Fig. 16.4 RADIO ANTENNA ................................................................... Fig. 16.1 ................................................................................................ Fig. 16.2 ................................................................................................ Fig. 16.3 RADIO CONTROL SWITCHES (STEERING WHEEL) ............... Fig. 16.1 ................................................................................................ Fig. 16.2 ................................................................................................ Fig. 16.3 RADIO ILLUM INATION ........................................................... Fig. 10.2 READER / EXCITER COIL (COLUM N SWITCHGEAR) ............. Fig. 13.2 ................................................................................................ Fig. 13.3 REAR INTERIOR LAM P (COUPE ONLY).................................. Fig. 10.1 REAR QUARTER FULL RANGE SPEAKERS ............................ Fig. 16.1 ................................................................................................ Fig. 16.2 REAR QUARTER M ID-RANGE SPEAKERS .............................. Fig. 16.3
M ASS AIR FLOW SENSOR ..................................................... Fig. 04.1 ................................................................................................ Fig. 04.2
REAR SUB-WOOFERS ............................................................ Fig. 16.3
M ICROPHONE (TELEPHONE) ................................................. Fig. 16.4
REFRIGERANT 4-WAY PRESSURE SWITCH ........................... Fig. 04.3 ................................................................................................ Fig. 07.2
M ID-BASS SPEAKERS ............................................................ Fig. 16.3
REGULATOR ........................................................................... Fig. 03.1 ROOF CONSOLE .................................................................... Fig. 10.1 ................................................................................................ Fig. 13.3
D A TE OF ISSU E:
SEPTEM BER 1 9 9 7
7
Component Index SEAT BELT SWITCH ............................................................... Fig. 12.1 ................................................................................................ Fig. 12.2 SEAT CONTROL M ODULE – DRIVER ..................................... Fig. 11.4 ................................................................................................ Fig. 12.1 ................................................................................................ Fig. 12.2 ................................................................................................ Fig. 19.1 SEAT CONTROL M ODULE – PASSENGER ............................. Fig. 11.4 ................................................................................................ Fig. 12.3 ................................................................................................ Fig. 12.4 ................................................................................................ Fig. 19.1 SEAT CUSHION (HEATER) – DRIVER ...................................... Fig. 12.1 ................................................................................................ Fig. 12.2 SEAT CUSHION (HEATER) – PASSENGER .............................. Fig. 12.3 ................................................................................................ Fig. 12.4 SEAT HEATER SWITCH (CENTER CONSOLE SWITCH PACK) ............................... Fig. 12.1 ................................................................................................ Fig. 12.2 ................................................................................................ Fig. 12.3 ................................................................................................ Fig. 12.4
XK8 Range 1998 ................................................................................................ Fig. 12.1 SWITCH PACK – DRIVER SEAT............................................... Fig. 12.1 ................................................................................................ Fig. 12.2 SWITCH PACK – PASSENGER DOOR ..................................... Fig. 10.2 SWITCH PACK – PASSENGER SEAT ...................................... Fig. 12.3 ................................................................................................ Fig. 12.4 TAIL LAM P UNITS ................................................................... Fig. 09.2 TELEPHONE ANTENNA .......................................................... Fig. 16.4 TELEPHONE TRANSCEIVER ................................................... Fig. 16.4 THROTTLE M OTOR ................................................................ Fig. 04.1 ................................................................................................ Fig. 04.2 THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR .............................................. Fig. 04.1 ................................................................................................ Fig. 04.2 TOP CLOSED SWITCH ............................................................ Fig. 15.2 TOP DOWN SWITCH .............................................................. Fig. 15.2 TOP LATCH CLOSED SWITCH ............................................... Fig. 15.2
SEAT LUM BAR PUM P – DRIVER ............................................ Fig. 12.1 ................................................................................................ Fig. 12.2
TOP RAISED SWITCH ............................................................. Fig. 15.2
SEAT LUM BAR PUM P – PASSENGER .................................... Fig. 12.3
TOP READY-TO-LATCH SWITCH ............................................ Fig. 15.2
SEAT M OTORS – DRIVER ....................................................... Fig. 12.1 ................................................................................................ Fig. 12.2
TRANSIT ISOLATION DEVICE ................................................. Fig. 01.1
SEAT M OTORS – PASSENGER ............................................... Fig. 12.3 ................................................................................................ Fig. 12.4 SECURITY ACTIVE INDICATOR (GEAR SELECTOR M ODULE) ........................................... Fig. 13.2 ................................................................................................ Fig. 13.3 SECURITY AND LOCKING CONTROL M ODULE .................... Fig. 09.2 ................................................................................................ Fig. 11.4 ................................................................................................ Fig. 13.1 ................................................................................................ Fig. 13.2 ................................................................................................ Fig. 13.3 ................................................................................................ Fig. 15.1 ................................................................................................ Fig. 15.2 ................................................................................................ Fig. 19.1
TRANSM ISSION CONTROL M ODULE .................................... Fig. 05.1 ................................................................................................ Fig. 19.1 TRANSM ISSION ELECTRICS .................................................. Fig. 05.1 TRANSM ISSION ROTARY SWITCH ........................................ Fig. 05.1 TRIP COM PUTER SWITCH PACK ........................................... Fig. 08.1 ................................................................................................ Fig. 10.2 TRIP CYCLE SWITCH (COLUM N SWITCHGEAR) .................... Fig. 08.1 TRUNK ACCESSORY CONNECTOR ........................................ Fig. 18.1 TRUNK AND FUEL FILL RELEASE SWITCH ............................ Fig. 10.2 ................................................................................................ Fig. 13.1 TRUNK LAM PS ....................................................................... Fig. 10.1
SIDE DI REPEATERS (ROW) ................................................... Fig. 09.1 ................................................................................................ Fig. 09.1
TRUNK RELEASE SOLENOID ................................................. Fig. 13.1
SIDE M ARKERS (NAS ONLY) .................................................. Fig. 09.1 ................................................................................................ Fig. 09.2
TRUNK SWITCH ...................................................................... Fig. 10.1 ................................................................................................ Fig. 13.1 ................................................................................................ Fig. 13.2 ................................................................................................ Fig. 13.3
SOLAR SENSOR ..................................................................... Fig. 07.1 SQUAB (HEATERS) – DRIVER ................................................. Fig. 12.1 ................................................................................................ Fig. 12.2 SQUAWKERS (FASCIA) ........................................................... Fig. 16.3
TWEETERS.............................................................................. Fig. 16.3 VACUUM SWITCHING VALVES .............................................. Fig. 04.1 ................................................................................................ Fig. 04.2
STARTER M OTOR .................................................................. Fig. 03.1
VALET SWITCH ....................................................................... Fig. 10.2 ................................................................................................ Fig. 13.1 ................................................................................................ Fig. 13.2 ................................................................................................ Fig. 13.3
STEERING COLUM N M OTORS .............................................. Fig. 11.2
VANITY LAM PS ....................................................................... Fig. 10.1
SUPPRESSION M ODULE ....................................................... Fig. 03.1
VARIABLE STEERING CONVERTER – LHD ............................. Fig. 11.1
SWITCH PACK – DRIVER DOOR ............................................. Fig. 10.2
VARIABLE STEERING CONVERTER – RHD ............................ Fig. 11.1
STABILITY / TRACTION CONTROL SWITCH (CENTER CONSOLE SWITCH PACK) ............................... Fig. 06.1
SWITCH PACK – DRIVER DOOR M EM ORY............................ Fig. 10.2 ................................................................................................ Fig. 11.2 ................................................................................................ Fig. 11.3
8
D A TE OF ISSU E:
SEPTEM BER 1 9 9 7
XK8 Range 1998
Component Index
VARIABLE VALVE TIM ING SOLENOID VALVES ..................... Fig. 04.1 ................................................................................................ Fig. 04.2 VENT ASSEM BLY ................................................................... Fig. 07.1 WASH / WIPE STALK (COLUM N SWITCHGEAR).................... Fig. 14.1 WHEEL SPEED SENSORS ...................................................... Fig. 06.1 WINDOW LIFT SWITCHES – DRIVER DOOR (DRIVER DOOR SWITCH PACK) ....................................... Fig. 15.1 WINDOW LIFT SWITCHES – PASSENGER DOOR (PASSENGER DOOR SWITCH PACK) ............................... Fig. 15.1 WINDOW LIFTS ...................................................................... Fig. 15.1 WINDSHIELD HEATERS ......................................................... Fig. 07.2 WINDSHIELD WASH PUM P AND FLUID LEVEL SENSOR ..... Fig. 14.1 WIPER M OTOR ....................................................................... Fig. 14.1
D A TE OF ISSU E:
SEPTEM BER 1 9 9 7
9
User Instructions
XK8 Range 1998
Figure and Data Page Layout Figure Pages Each Figure represents a specific electrical system of the vehicle. The Figures are arranged numerically by system (01 – Power Distribution, 02 – Ground Distribution, etc.) w ith variations in the system identified by a numeral follow ing a decimal point (01.1, 01.2, etc.). Refer to the Table of Contents for a complete list of the Figures. The Figures 01 – Power Distribution detail the distribution of power to each of the systems. Numbered reference symbols refer the user to a specific Figure and from a specific Figure back to the Power Distribution Figures. This method eliminates the need to include detailed Power Distribution information on each of the Figures. Similarly, the Figure 02 – Ground Distribution details the ignition switched ground distribution. The reference symbols are defined on page 12. Each Figure appears on a right-hand page w ith a corresponding Data page to the left. The Figure and Data pages are folding pages. The user must fold out both pages in order to access all the information provided.
Data Pages The Data page includes information to assist the user in identifying and locating components, connectors and grounds. This information is supplemented by the illustrations in this front section of the book. When network data is required for the understanding of a particular circuit, the user is directed to the Appendix. Where circuits include a Control M odule, Pin Out information is provided w ith values for “ active” and “ inactive” states. The values listed are approximately those that can be expected at the control module connector pins w ith all circuit connections made and all components connected and fitted. “ Active” means a load is applied or a switch is ON; “ inactive” means a load is not applied or a sw itch is OFF. This information is provided to assist the user in understanding circuit operation and should be used FOR REFERENCE ONLY.
10
D A TE OF ISSU E:
SEPTEM BER 1 9 9 7
XK8 Range 1998
User Instructions
CONTROL M ODULE PIN OUT INFORM ATION
FIGURE NUM BER
Fig. 03.1
CONTROL M ODULE PIN OUT INFORM ATION BODY PROCESSOR M ODULE P
Description
I
FC14-7
D
FC14-39
Pin
COM PONENT, RELAY, CONNECTOR AND GROUND INFORM ATION
COM PONENTS Active
Inactive
NEUTRAL SWITCH STATUS
GROUND (N)
B+ (P, R, D, 4, 3, 2)
SECURITY ACKNOWLEDGE
ENCODED COM M UNICATIONS
I
FC14-41
STARTER ENGAGE REQUEST
GROUND (CRANKING)
B+
BODY PROCESSOR M ODULE
FC14 / 104-WAY AM P EEEC / GREY
PASSENGER SIDE FASCIA / AIRBAG BRACKET
O
FC14-73
STARTER RELAY ACTIVATE
GROUND (CRANKING)
B+
ENGINE CONTROL M ODULE
ENGINE COM PARTM ENT / CONTROL M ODULE ENCLOSURE
B+
B+
EM 10 / 28-WAY M ULTILOCK 040 / GREY EM 11 / 16-WAY M ULTILOCK 040 / GREY EM 12 / 22-WAY M ULTILOCK 040 / GREY EM 13 / 34-WAY M ULTILOCK 040 / GREY EM 14 / 12-WAY M ULTILOCK 47 / WHITE EM 15 / 22-WAY M ULTILOCK 47 / WHITE
I
FC14-80
BATTERY SUPPLY VOLTAGE
D
FC14-92
ENCODED COM M UNICATIONS
Component
ENGINE CONTROL M ODULE P
Pin
Description
Active
Inactive
D
EM 10-6
OK TO START – ENCODED COM M UNICATIONS
I
EM 10-15
PARK / NEUTRAL CONFIRM ATION
B+ (P, N)
GROUND (R,D,4,3,2)
D
EM 10-17
SECURITY ACKNOWLEDGE
ENCODED COM M UNICATIONS
I
EM 11-6
ENGINE CRANK
GROUND (CRANKING)
B+
KEY TRANSPONDER M ODULE P
Pin
Description
Active
D
FC22-9
GLASS BREAKAGE / OK TO START (ENCODED COM M UNICATION)
D
FC22-16
OK TO START (ENCODED COM M UNICATION)
D
FC22-17
SECURITY ACKNOWLEDGE (ENCODED COM M UNICATION)
Connector / Type / Color
BATTERY
Location / Access
BT66 / EYELET BT67 / EYELET
TRUNK, RIGHT HAND SIDE
GENERATOR
AN1 / EYELET AN2 / EYELET ST11 / EYELET
ENGINE COM PARTM ENT / RIGHT FRONT
HIGH POWER PROTECTION M ODULE
BT60 / EYELET BT61 / EYELET BT62 / EYELET BT63 / EYELET
TRUNK / ADJACENT TO BATTERY
IGNITION SWITCH (KEY-IN SWITCH)
FC4 / 8-WAY M ULTILOCK 070 / WHITE
STEERING COLUM N
KEY TRANSPONDER M ODULE
FC22 / 20-WAY M ULTILOCK 040 / GREEN
ADJACENT TO DRIVER SIDE FUSE BOX
NEUTRAL SWITCH
FC89 / 3-WAY M ULTILOCK 070 / GREY
REGULATOR (GENERATOR)
PI50 / 3-WAY SUM ITOM O 0902 / BLACK
STARTER M OTOR
ST2 / EYELET ST3 / EYELET ST10 / EYELET
ENGINE BLOCK
SUPPRESSION M ODULE
AN3 / 2-WAY ECONOSEAL III LC/ RED
REARWARD OF RIGHT FRONT HEADLAM P
Inactive
GEAR SELECTOR ASSEM BLY ENGINE COM PARTM ENT / GENERATOR
RELAYS Relay
Color / Stripe
Connector / Color
Location / Access
STARTER RELAY
BROWN
EM 50 / BROWN
RH ENCLOSURE RELAYS
HARNESS-TO-HARNESS CONNECTORS Connector
Type / Color
Location / Access
BT80
EYELET
EM 1
20-WAY M ULTILOCK 070 / WHITE
ENGINE COM PARTM ENT / ADJACENT TO RIGHT HAND ENCLOSURE
EM 2
18-WAY M ULTILOCK 070 / YELLOW
ENGINE COM PARTM ENT / ADJACENT TO RIGHT HAND ENCLOSURE
EM 3
14-WAY M ULTILOCK 070 / GREY
ENGINE COM PARTM ENT / ADJACENT TO RIGHT HAND ENCLOSURE
EM 60
ENGINE COM PARTM ENT / FALSE BULKHEAD, RIGHT HAND SIDE
2-WAY ECONOSEAL III HC / BLACK
ENGINE COM PARTM ENT / BEHIND LEFT INNER FENDER HEAT SHIELD
PI1
57-WAY SUM ITOM O / BLACK
ENGINE COM PARTM ENT / BRACKET ON TOP OF TRANSM ISSION
ST1
EYELET
ENGINE COM PARTM ENT / FALSE BULKHEAD, RIGHT HAND SIDE
GROUNDS Ground
Location / Type
BT68
BATTERY GROUND STUD
FC3BR
EYELET (PAIR) – RIGHT HAND LEG / TRANSM ISSION TUNNEL, LEFT HAND SIDE
CONTROL M ODULE PIN OUT INFORM ATION (FOLD OUT PAGE)
The following symbols are used to represent values for Control Module Pin Out data: I Input O Output SG Signal Ground
D C S
Serial and encoded communications CAN (Network) SCP Network
KHz Frequency x 1000 MS Milliseconds MV Millivolts
B+ Battery voltage V Voltage (DC) Hz Frequency
CAUTION: The information on this data page is furnished to aid the user in understanding circuit operation. THIS INFORMATION SHOULD BE USED FOR REFERENCE ONLY. NOTE: The values listed are approximately those that can be expected at the control module connector pins with all circuit connections made and all components connected and fitted. “Active” means a load is applied or a switch is ON; “Inactive” means a load is not applied or a switch is OFF.
REFER TO THE FRONT OF THE BOOK FOR ILLUSTRATIONS DETAILING THE LOCATION AND IDENTIFICATION OF COMPONENTS, RELAYS, CONNECTORS, HARNESSES, GROUNDS, VEHICLE CONTROL MODULES AND CONTROL MODULE PINS. D A TE OF ISSU E: FEBRU A RY 19 9 8
DATE OF ISSUE
DATA PAGE
FIGURE
M ODEL RANGE AND YEAR
TITLE
FIGURE NUM BER
Battery; Starter; Generator: AJ26 N/A
XK8 Range 1998
FALSE BULKHEAD STUD CONNECTOR
N
BT80
BT61 250A x 2
B
N
BT67
BT68
BT66
BT60
N
BT63
250A
01.1
HIGH POWER PROTECTION MODULE
BATTERY
NB
15
B+ FC14-80
RW
1
WO
II
02.1
Y
FC4-3
BK
WN
I FC4-5
EM50
D FC14-39
02.1
75
SU
FC4-2
NW
3
5
WR
WK
1
2
GO
D
37
FC14-92
IGNITION SWITCH (III)
FC3BL
GO EMS28
EM1-15
I FC14-41
FC4-1
FCS48
GO
GO
O FC14-73
RW
III
BK
N
ST1
01.1
BT62
N
Fig. 03.1
Battery; Starter; Generator: AJ26 N/ A
II ENGINE CRANKING CONTROL
STARTER RELAY BK FCS47
BK
BK
LOGIC
RU
RU
FC89-3
I FC14-7
FC89-1
POWER
NEUTRAL SWITCH
FC3BR
BODY PROCESSOR MODULE
GO
I ENGINE START
EM11-6
FUEL PUMP CONTROL AND IGNITION
SU
D GLASS BREAKAGE
SECURITY ACKNOWLEDGE
FC22-9
PARK, NEUTRAL (CIRCUIT CONTINUED)
G
05.1
I EM10-15
SECURITY ACKNOWLEDGE
D
O.K. TO START
D
Y
Y EM10-17
Y FCS74
EM3-8
D SECURITY
ACKNOWLEDGE
FC22-17
O
O EM10-6
EM2-18
D O.K. TO START FC22-16
ENGINE CONTROL MODULE
KEY TRANSPONDER MODULE WR
WR EM60-2
ST3 ST2
N
6
N
B 31
WP
ST10
II MAJOR INSTRUMENT PASK: CHARGE INDICATOR (CIRCUIT CONTINUED)
08.1
PI50-2
SW
SW EM1-14
SW PI1-11
STARTER MOTOR
REGULATOR
PI50-1
B
N AN1
AN3-1
ST11
B AN2
AN3-2
GENERATOR SUPPRESSION MODULE
1
6
1
5
7
51
Fig. 01.2
6 II
II
52
84
Fig. 01.3
40
60
Fig. 01.1 II
E
E
39
E
1 Fig. 01.5
KEY TO REFERENCE SYM BOLS
D A TE OF ISSU E:
SEPTEM BER 1 9 9 7
I
Fig. 01.4 18 I
Input
O
Output
D
Serial and Encoded Com m unications
Signal Ground (SG)
C
CAN (Netw ork)
S
SCP Netw ork
Fig. 02.1
FIGURE PAGE
V ARIAN T: AJ26 N / A V ehicles V IN RAN GE: 024687 DATE OF ISSU E: FEBRU ARY 1998
➞
VARIANT, VIN RANGE AND DATE OF ISSUE
11
User Instructions
XK8 Range 1998
NOTE: In the examples shown on this page, an ‘X’ is used where a number would appear on an actual Figure.
Reference Symbols Reference symbols are used for three purposes: • to allow the user to complete the individual system circuit to pow er supply or ground • to refer the user to a related circuit • to identify control module inputs, outputs and signal grounds
Battery Power Supply
X
This symbol represents a direct battery pow er supply and refers the user to Figure 01.1, 01.2 or 01.3. X
X
I
II
X E
Ignition Switched Power Supply
This symbol represents ignition sw itched pow er supply and refers the user to Figure 01.1, 01.4 or 01.5. The suffix I indicates auxiliary pow er. Pow er is supplied in ignition sw itch key positions I (AUXILIARY) and II (IGNITION). The suffix II indicates ignition power. Power is supplied in ignition switch key positions II (IGNITION) and III (ENGINE CRANK). The suffix E indicates engine management switched power. Power is supplied in ignition switch key positions II (IGNITION) and III (ENGINE CRANK) under ECM control. X
XX
XX
I
II
Ignition Switched Ground
This symbol represents an ignition sw itched ground and refers the user to Figure 02.1. This symbol w ithout a suffix indicates CRANK. Ground is completed in ignition sw itch key position III (ENGINE CRANK). The suffix I indicates auxiliary ground. Ground is completed in ignition switch key positions I (AUXILIARY) and II (IGNITION). The suffix II indicates ignition ground. Ground is completed in ignition sw itch key positions II (IGNITION) and III (ENGINE CRANK). XX.X
BPM
Figure Number Reference Flag
This symbol refers the reader to a figure number only. It does not refer to a flag w ith the same number on a different figure. As used in Figures 01.1 through 02.1, the reference flag refers the user to a continuation of the circuit. In this instance, the user matches the number to a Pow er Supply or Ground symbol to trace the circuit. In most other cases, it is not necessary to refer to another figure for completion of a circuit, as the reference flags are used to indicate parallel circuits and circuits that share components. M ost of the circuits w here this situation occurs are overlapped to avoid the necessity for cross-referencing to another figure. Exceptions to this rule are instances w here signals are transmitted to or received from other system circuits. When circuits are not overlapped, they are noted by (CIRCUIT CONTINUED).
BPM Because the Body Processor M odule appears numerous times, the abbreviation BPM is used in the reference flags on Figures 01.2 and 02.1 in order to conserve space. Control Module Input, Output, Data Link, Signal Ground and Network(s) I
Input
O
Output
D
Serial and Encoded Com m unications
Signal Ground (SG)
C
CAN (Netw ork)
S
SCP Netw ork
These six symbols are employed to assist the user in visualizing the ‘logic’ of circuits containing control modules. The symbols identify control module input, output, data link, signal ground and netw ork pins. These symbols are also employed on the corresponding data page.
12
D A TE OF ISSU E:
SEPTEM BER 1 9 9 7
XK8 Range 1998 Wiring Symbols
User Instructions Wiring Color Codes N B W K G R Y
SPLICE SIM PLIFIED SPLICE
BULB
Brow n Black White Pink Green Red Yellow
O S L U P BRD
Orange Slate Light Blue Purple Braid
CAPACITOR
When a w ire has tw o or more color code letters, the first letter indicates the main color and the subsequent letter(s) indicate the tracer color(s).
CONNECTOR
Wiring Harness Codes DIODE
DIODE (IN HARNESS) XX1-X
EYELET AND STUD
FUSE
LOGIC GROUND
POWER GROUND
LED LED
M OTOR
POTENTIOM ETER
RESISTOR
SOLENOID
SUPPRESSION DIODE
SUPPRESSION RESISTOR
THERM ISTOR
TRANSISTOR
XX1
XX1-X
Code AC AN AS BB BC BL BT DD DP EL EM EN FC FL FR IC IS LF LL PI QL QR RF RH RL RR RT SA SC SD SP SW TL
Description Air Conditioning (Climate Control) Generator Suppression M odule Generator to Starter Trunk Bridging Link M ain Pow er Distribution Trunk Lid Trunk Door, Driver Door, Passenger Engine M anagement Cruise Control Link Engine M anagement Engine M anagement Side M arker Link Fascia LH Front Wheel RH Front Wheel In-Car Entertainment Inclination Sensor Link Left Forw ard Pow er Steering Link Engine Convertible LH Quarter Light Link Convertible RH Quarter Light Link Roof Rearw ard LH Rear Wheel RH Rear Wheel Radio Telephone Starter to Generator Link Column Sw itchgear Seat, Driver Seat, Passenger Steering Wheel Telephone
Code Numbering When numbering connectors, grounds and splices, Jaguar Engineering uses a three-position format: AC001, AC002, etc. Because space is limited in this Electrical Guide, the codes have been shortened. Thus AC001-001 becomes AC1-1, AC002-001 becomes AC2-1, etc.
WIRE CONTINUED ZENER DIODE
D A TE OF ISSU E:
SEPTEM BER 1 9 9 7
13
User Instructions
XK8 Range 1998
Harness Component Numbers Connectors HARNESS CODE + CONNECTOR NUM BER + PIN NUM BER EXAM PLE: FC7-24 (pin number is separated by a dash) Where the pin number differs from LHD to RHD, the connector number w ill be further identified by (LHD) or (RHD).
FC7-24 Harness code
FC7-24 (LHD) FC7-15 (RHD) Pin num ber
Connector num ber
Splices HARNESS CODE + S (SPLICE) + SPLICE NUM BER EXAM PLE: RHS3 (no dash is used) NOTE: In order to avoid unnecessary circuit complication, multiple splices (more than tw o w ires) w ithin components, in w ires leading from input components to multiple circuits and in harness ‘ground’ sides, are simplified so as not to show w ires from other circuits.
RHS3
RHS3 SIM PLIFIED SPLICE
Harness code
Splice num ber
Splice
Diodes Harness diodes occur at connectors and are depicted as components and identified by a connector number. EXAM PLE:
BT29-1
BT29
BT29-2
Relay Connectors Relay connector numbers are show n w ithin the relay. The connector number is show n in the upper portion of the relay; the pin (terminal) number is show n adjacent to the pin. Certain relays are paired and share a modular connector. In this instance, the connector number remains the same for both relays w hile the pin numbers of the second relay are identified by numbers 6 – 10. EXAM PLE: AC20
14
AC20
4
9
3
5
8
10
1
2
6
7
D A TE OF ISSU E:
SEPTEM BER 1 9 9 7
XK8 Range 1998
User Instructions
Grounds HARNESS CODE + GROUND STUD NUM BER + EYELET STUD POSITION (A,B,C) + EYELET DESIGNATION (S,L,R)
Eyelet stud position There may be up to three eyelets on one stud. A, B and C are used to indicate the position of the eyelet on the stud: A – first (bottom), B – second (middle), C – third (top). Eyelet designation Tw o eyelet variations are used: a single eyelet and an eyelet pair. The single eyelet has a single ‘leg’, w hich is identified by an S; the eyelet pair has tw o ‘legs’, identified as L (left) or R (right). S
L
SINGLE EYELET
R
EYELET PAIR
EXAM PLES: Harness code
Harness code
Harness code
Ground stud num ber
Ground stud num ber
Ground stud num ber
FC2S
LF1A R
Single leg eyelet
BT1CS
RH leg of eyelet
Single leg eyelet
First eyelet on stud
Third eyelet on stud
Where the ground designation differs from LHD to RHD, the RHD ground is show n in parentheses. If the ground designation is the same for LHD and RHD, only one ground designation is used. EXAM PLES:
EM 2A R (EM 1A R)
D A TE OF ISSU E:
SEPTEM BER 1 9 9 7
LHD Vehicles RHD Vehicles
BT1A L
Sam e for LHD & RHD Vehicles
15
Connectors
XK8 Range 1998
The follow ing connectors are the common harness-to-harness connectors used throughout the vehicle.
Multilock 040 Low current (used as harness and ‘ direct ’ connect ion connector).
Multilock 070 High current (used as harness and ‘direct’ connection connector).
Econoseal III LC Low current sealed connector.
Econoseal III HC High current sealed connector.
Ford Card Used for SRS only.
16
D A TE OF ISSU E:
SEPTEM BER 1 9 9 7
XK8 Range 1998
M ain Pow er Distribution; Ground Point Identification and Location
M ain Pow er Distribution; Ground Point Identification and Location
MAIN POWER DISTRIBUTION
GROUND POINTS
ENGINE COM PARTM ENT FUSE BOX
GENERATOR LF70 ST11
LF1 STARTER M OTOR ST3
LF2
FALSE BULKHEAD STUD CONNECTOR BT80 ST1
ENGINE M ANAGEM ENT FUSE BOX (RHD)
EM 2
EM 70
EM 70
ENGINE M ANAGEM ENT FUSE BOX (LHD)
EM 1 RHD
LF3
FC4
FC3 (QUIET GROUND)
FC2 DRIVER SIDE FUSE BOX (LHD) PASSENGER SIDE FUSE BOX (RHD) FC1 CE2 RADIO / CASSETTE HEAD UNIT GROUND
FC90 FC93
RHD
BT79 EM 71 FC91 LF71
PASSENGER SIDE FUSE BOX (LHD) DRIVER SIDE FUSE BOX (RHD)
FC90 FC92
TUNNEL STUD CONNECTOR
FC6
FC5
RH3 (KEYFOB ANTENNA)
RH2
RH1
RADIO ANTENNA GROUND BT61
HIGH POWER PROTECTION M ODULE BT68 BATTERY GROUND
BT62 BT63
BT60
BT66
+
BT1 BT2 BT3
BATTERY
–
BT68 BT67
TRUNK FUSE BOX
D A TE OF ISSU E:
SEPTEM BER 1 9 9 7
BT64
17
Harness Layout
XK8 Range 1998
Harness Layout
LHD
RHD
FRONT OF VEHICLE
FRONT OF VEHICLE
LF2
LF1
LF2
LF41
LF1
LF41
LF42
FR – RH FRONT WHEEL
FL – LH FRONT WHEEL
LF42
FR – RH FRONT WHEEL
FL – LH FRONT WHEEL
ST – STARTER LINK PI – ENGINE
LL – POWER STEERING LINK EL – ENGINE M ANAGEM ENT CRUISE CONTROL LINK OR EN – ENGINE M ANAGEM ENT SIDE M ARKER LINK
LF – LEFT FORWARD PI1 PI2
LF3
LF3 LF40
EM60
EM2
LL1
EL1
EM – ENGINE M ANAGEM ENT
LF1 LF2 LF60
AC12 AC13 AC14 AC15
AC16
EM1 EM2 EM3
FC3
DD – DRIVER’S DOOR
SC – COLUM N SWITCHGEAR
LF1 LF2 LF60
DP1
DP – PASSENGER’S DOOR
DP – PASSENGER’S DOOR
EM60
EL1
EM1
EM2
AC – AIR CONDITIONING (CLIM ATE CONTROL)
DP1
FC2 SC1 SC2 SC3 SC4
PI1 PI2
LF3
FC1
FC4
EL – ENGINE M ANAGEM ENT CRUISE CONTROL LINK OR EN – ENGINE M ANAGEM ENT SIDE M ARKER LINK
LF – LEFT FORWARD
LF3 LF40
EM1
AC – AIR CONDITIONING (CLIM ATE CONTROL)
DD1
ST – STARTER LINK
PI – ENGINE
EM – ENGINE M ANAGEM ENT
AC12 AC13 AC14 AC15
AC16
EM1 EM2 EM3
DD1
FC3
FC1
FC4
FC2
RF1
RF1
RF – ROOF
DD – DRIVER’S DOOR
SC1 SC2 SC3 SC4
SC – COLUM N SWITCHGEAR SW1 SW2
SW – STEERING WHEEL
FC – FASCIA
TL – TELEPHONE
FC – FASCIA
SW1 SW2
TL – TELEPHONE RT3
IC1 IC2
RT – RADIO TELEPHONE IC – IN-CAR ENTERTAINM ENT
RF – ROOF
RT20
RT3
RT20 IC1 IC2
RT – RADIO TELEPHONE IC – IN-CAR ENTERTAINM ENT
FC5
FC6 IC4
FC5
FC6 IC4
SD1 SD2
SD – DRIVER’S SEAT
SP1 SP2
SP – PASSENGER’S SEAT
RH1 RH2 RH12 RH14
RH2
RH5
RH6
RH1
QL – CONVERTIBLE LH QUARTER LIGHT LINK
BT3
BB1
SP1 SP2
SP – PASSENGER’S SEAT
BT1 BT2 BT3 BT4 BT58
SD1 SD2
BL1
RH2
QR – CONVERTIBLE RH QUARTER LIGHT LINK
RH5
RH6
18
RH1
QL – CONVERTIBLE LH QUARTER LIGHT LINK
BT3
BT1
BB1
BT1 BT2 BT3 BT4 BT58
QR – CONVERTIBLE RH QUARTER LIGHT LINK
BT1
BT2 BT73
BT72
RR – RH REAR WHEEL
RL – LH REAR WHEEL
BL1
BT73
RR – RH REAR WHEEL BL – TRUNK LID
BL – TRUNK LID BB – TRUNK BRIDGING LINK
RH – REARWARD
BT – TRUNK
BT2 BT72
SD – DRIVER’S SEAT
RH1 RH2 RH12 RH14
RH – REARWARD
BT – TRUNK
RL – LH REAR WHEEL
SW – STEERING WHEEL
BB – TRUNK BRIDGING LINK
D A TE OF ISSU E:
SEPTEM BER 1 9 9 7
XK8 Range 1998
Control M odule Identification and Location
LHD
RHD
RADIATOR FAN CONTROL RELAY M ODULE ABS / TRACTION CONTROL CONTROL M ODULE
Control M odule Identification and Location
RADIATOR FAN CONTROL RELAY M ODULE TRANSM ISSION CONTROL M ODULE
ABS / TRACTION CONTROL CONTROL M ODULE TRANSM ISSION CONTROL M ODULE
ENGINE CONTROL M ODULE ENGINE CONTROL M ODULE
BODY PROCESSOR M ODULE
AIR CONDITIONING CONTROL M ODULE
AIR CONDITIONING CONTROL M ODULE
M AJOR INSTRUM ENT PACK KEY TRANSPONDER M ODULE
AIRBAG / SRS CONTROL M ODULE POWER ASSISTED STEERING CONTROL M ODULE
AIRBAG / SRS CONTROL M ODULE M AJOR INSTRUM ENT PACK
DIM M ER M ODULE DRIVER DOOR CONTROL M ODULE
BODY PROCESSOR M ODULE
PASSENGER DOOR CONTROL M ODULE
KEY TRANSPONDER M ODULE DIM M ER M ODULE
PASSENGER DOOR CONTROL M ODULE
DRIVER DOOR CONTROL M ODULE POWER ASSISTED STEERING CONTROL M ODULE
DRIVER SEAT CONTROL M ODULE
PASSENGER SEAT CONTROL M ODULE
PASSENGER SEAT CONTROL M ODULE
GEAR SELECTOR ILLUM INATION M ODULE
GEAR SELECTOR ILLUM INATION M ODULE
SECURITY AND LOCKING CONTROL M ODULE ADAPTIVE DAM PING CONTROL M ODULE
D A TE OF ISSU E:
SEPTEM BER 1 9 9 7
DRIVER SEAT CONTROL M ODULE
LAM P CONTROL M ODULE
SECURITY AND LOCKING CONTROL M ODULE ADAPTIVE DAM PING CONTROL M ODULE
LAM P CONTROL M ODULE
19
Control M odule Connector Pin Identification and Location
XK8 Range 1998
Control M odule Connector Pin Identification and Location
ABS / TRACTION CONTROL CONTROL M ODULE
TRANSM ISSION CONTROL M ODULE: AJ26 N/ A
EM 7 EM 7 / 88-WAY / BLACK
LF37
28 BY
27 —
55 WB 88 —
87 —
86 Y
26 ND 54 WB
85 G
25 —
53 RU 84 —
24 —
23 BRD
52 RY 83 Y
51 OB 82 G
22 UY
50 — 81 —
21 BU 49 —
80 —
79 —
20 —
19 —
18 BS
17 —
16 U
15 BRD
14 N
13 US
12 RP
11 —
10 —
9 W
8 RB
7 —
48 —
47 —
46 —
45 RG
44 R
43 —
42 G
41 —
40 —
39 —
38 —
37 Y
36 S
35 —
78 —
77 —
76 —
75 —
74 —
73 —
72 —
71 —
70 —
69 —
68 —
67 —
66 —
65 —
6 B 34 B 64 —
5 OG 33 YP
4 OK
32 YU
63 —
62 —
L G
H Y
3 — 31 —
2 RS 30 YB
61 —
60 —
1 OU 29 OR
59 —
58 —
57 —
56 —
2 UG
1 WR
TRANSM ISSION CONTROL M ODULE: AJ26 SC
LF37 / 25-WAY / BLACK
TOP
17 W
18 R 10 —
1 UO
19 UP 11 —
2 US
20 WU 12 —
3 S
21 P
13 UB 4 G
22 U 14 R
5 Y
23 — 15 G
6 Y
24 B
25 WY
8 B
9 NR
EM 73
EM 72
16 RY 7 O
EM 73 / 18-WAY / BLACK 23 — 1 YU
2 BS
24 — 3 P
EM 72 / 14-WAY / BLACK
25 26 27 28 LGB LGU LGP LGN 4 —
5 —
6 —
7 —
8 —
29 WB
30 B 9 —
33 B 10 —
12 BG
34 BY 13 BW
35 BU 14 BK
36 BO
15 BLG
37 BN 16 BP
38 BR 17 BS
ENGINE CONTROL M ODULE
EM 14
EM 15
EM 13
EM 12
EM 11
EM 10
AJ26 N/A EM 14 / 12-WAY / WHITE
EM 15 / 22-WAY / WHITE
6 R
5 R
4 BK
3 WR
2 GY
1 GY
11 B
12 G
11 G
10 B
9 B
8 B
7 B
22 B
EM 13 / 34-WAY / GREY
10 —
9 RY
8 RG
7 BU
6 BW
5 BY
4 BO
3 PN
21 —
20 —
19 —
18 BS
17 BN
16 BG
15 BP
14 —
2 PU
1 PS
13 —
12 B
10 — 16 WU
9 KW
8 —
7 —
15 W
6 — 14 GR
26 25 24 23 LGU LGW LGO LGK
5 —
4 OK
EM 12 / 22-WAY / GREY 3 SP
13 PY
22 UB
2 W
12 RW 21 —
34 33 32 31 LPG LGS LGR LGY
20 B 30 —
19 Y
1 KN 11 PW
18 S
29 O
28 P
6 YW 11 —
10 RY
17 N 27 BG
5 WU
17 U
4 —
9 SG 16 N
22 BP
3 —
EM 11 / 16-WAY / GREY 1 —
8 SLG 15 R
21 —
2 —
14 G
13 GY
20 —
4 WU 7 —
16 K
10 G 15 R
EM 10 / 28-WAY / GREY
1 SR 6 GO
11 U 18 BY
2 —
7 RG
12 UP 19 BY
3 P
9 UY 14 BG
8 — 5 SG
13 O
8 UW 13 BY
12 BG
7 —
6 O
5 WK
12 K 21 UW
28 Y
4 UN
3 ULG
11 PG 20 BG
27 G
19 — 26 Y
18 —
10 US 17 Y
16 PK
25 G
15 G
9 NO
14 OU
24 —
23 BK
22 B
AJ26 SC EM 14 / 12-WAY / WHITE
EM 15 / 22-WAY / WHITE
6 R
5 R
4 BK
3 WR
2 GY
1 GY
11 B
12 G
11 G
10 B
9 B
8 B
7 B
22 B
EM 13 / 34-WAY / GREY
10 —
9 —
8 —
7 BU
6 BW
5 BY
4 BO
3 PN
21 —
20 —
19 —
18 BS
17 BN
16 BG
15 BP
14 —
2 PU
1 PS
13 —
12 B
10 RY 16 WU
9 KW
8 —
7 —
15 W
6 — 14 GR
26 25 24 23 LGU LGW LGO LGK 34 33 32 31 LPG LGS LGR LGY
20
22 UB
5 —
4 OK
EM 12 / 22-WAY / GREY 3 SP
13 PY
2 W
12 RW 21 —
20 B 30 —
19 Y 29 O
1 KN 11 PW
18 S 28 P
6 YW 11 —
17 N 27 BG
5 WU 10 RY
17 U 22 BP
4 YR
9 SG 16 N
21 —
3 YN
EM 11 / 16-WAY / GREY 1 YU
8 SLG 15 R
20 —
2 YG
14 G
13 GY
4 WU 7 —
16 K
10 G 15 R
9 UY 14 BG
EM 10 / 28-WAY / GREY
1 SR 6 GO
11 U 18 BY
2 —
7 RG
12 UP 19 BY
3 P
8 — 5 SG
13 O
8 UW 13 BY
12 BG
7 —
5 WK
12 K 21 UW
28 Y
6 O
3 ULG
2 UG
11 PG 20 BG
27 G
4 UN
19 — 26 Y
18 —
1 WR
10 US 17 Y
16 PK
25 G
D A TE OF ISSU E:
15 G 24 —
9 NO
14 OU 23 BK
22 B
FEBRU A RY 19 9 8
XK8 Range 1998
Control M odule Connector Pin Identification and Location
Control M odule Connector Pin Identification and Location
SECURITY AND LOCKING CONTROL M ODULE M AJOR INSTRUM ENT PACK BT41
BT40
BT40 / 16-WAY / BLACK
BT41 / 26-WAY / BLACK (NAS) 13 —
12 —
11 —
10 —
9 —
8 —
7 YP
6 —
5 RY
4 —
3 LGY
2 —
1 R
8 S
7 OG
6 NK
5 YW
4 GW
3 UG
2 OB
1 OR
26 —
25 —
24 —
23 —
22 —
21 —
20 —
19 YR
18 —
17 —
16 —
15 —
14 —
16 U
15 NY
14 BK
13 BK
12 —
11 UO
10 —
9 GR
BT41 / 26-WAY / BLACK (ROW)
FC25
13 —
12 —
11 —
10 BK
9 —
8 LGS
7 —
6 —
5 RY
4 —
3 —
2 —
1 —
26 YO
25 —
24 —
23 —
22 —
21 —
20 —
19 YR
18 —
17 —
16 —
15 —
14 —
DRIVER DOOR CONTROL M ODULE
FC26
FC25 / 48-WAY / BLACK
FC26 / 24-WAY / BLACK
1 BK
2 WG
3 RN
4 —
5 —
6 SO
7 —
8 —
9 —
10 SU
11 —
12 —
13 UY
14 R
15 —
16 —
17 —
18 —
19 S
20 U
21 —
22 —
23 Y
24 Y
1 RK
2 OW
3 PY
4 SG
5 OU
6 UB
7 ON
8 RG
9 RS
10 OB
11 RB
12 RU
25 NR
26 B
27 RO
28 RO
29 —
30 —
31 —
32 —
33 BR
34 —
35 Y
36 O
37 —
38 —
39 —
40 —
41 —
42 —
43 —
44 —
45 —
46 —
47 G
48 G
13 BW
14 RW
15 OU
16 YW
17 OS
18 OG
19 OS
20 UW
21 RLG
22 SW
23 OP
24 UR
DD11
DD10
DD11 / 22-WAY / BLACK 7 BP 15 WG
6 KS 14 —
22 UN
BODY PROCESSOR M ODULE
5 LGU 13 —
21 UP
4 OU
12 OY 20 GY
3 SN 11 —
19 —
2 UG 10 YO
18 —
DD10 / 22-WAY / BLUE 1 OB
9 YN 17 OR
7 OB 8 —
15 OU
16 —
6 SU
14 GW 22 PK
5 SY 13 PO
21 PU
4 PN
12 PW
20 WU
3 PG 11 PB
19 BR
2 BY 10 BG
18 BO
1 N 9 U
17 B
8 BK 16 S
PASSENGER DOOR CONTROL M ODULE FC14
FC14 / 104-WAY / GREY 79 NG
80 NB
81 GR
53 RK 27 GO
54 RB
28 RW 1 RY
2 GY
82 GR 55 SP
29 S
84 U
56 UW 30 U
3 GK
83 GB 57 —
31 SW 4 GU
85 S 58 SB
32 WN
5 SO
86 ON 59 PY
33 RG
6 YW
87 SK 60 RY
34 LGK 7 RU
8 —
88 YG 61 KG
35 OU
89 LGR
62 LGU
63 SW
36 37 LGW LGR
9 LGU
10 SR
90 BG
11 YB
91 BW 64 —
38 OR
92 SU 65 BK
39 Y 12 OP
93 YK 66 PU
40 WU 13 GO
94 LGO 67 UR
41 RW
14 UB
15 WO
NOTE: (NAS) PIN 13 NOT USED
D A TE OF ISSU E:
SEPTEM BER 1 9 9 7
42 UY
95 RS
68 US
96 PW 69 OK
43 BLG 16 RY
44 OY
17 OS
97 — 70 GS
71 SR
45 UG 18 YS
98 GB
99 PN 72 —
46 —
19 20 WLG OG
100 BR 73 GO
47 —
101 PW
74 RW
48 OG 21 —
22 WB
102 NY 75 —
49 —
103 B
76 GK 50 GY
23 WO
77 GP
51 RW
24 NW
DP11
104 NY 78 PG
DP11 / 22-WAY / BLACK
52 BS 25 B
DP10
7 — 26 YG
15 —
6 — 14 —
22 —
5 LGU 13 —
21 —
4 —
12 — 20 GY
3 — 11 —
19 —
2 — 10 —
18 —
DP10 / 22-WAY / BLUE 1 —
9 — 17 —
7 OB 8 —
16 —
15 OU
6 SU
14 GW 22 PK
21 PU
5 SY 13 PO
4 PN
12 PW
20 WU
3 PG 11 PB
19 —
2 PY 10 BG
18 BO
1 N 9 U
17 B
8 BK 16 S
21
Control M odule Connector Pin Identification and Location
XK8 Range 1998
Control M odule Connector Pin Identification and Location
DRIVER SEAT CONTROL M ODULE
SD3
PASSENGER SEAT CONTROL M ODULE
SD4
SD3 / 16-WAY / BLACK
SD5
SP3
SD4 / 26-WAY / BLACK
SD5 / 10-WAY / BLACK
SP5
SP3 / 16-WAY / BLACK
SP5 / 10-WAY / BLACK
9 UY
10 UW
11 KW
12 KY
13 GN
14 GP
15 GW
16 GY
14 WP
15 —
16 —
17 —
18 WB
19 —
20 —
21 —
22 —
23 —
24 —
25 —
26 —
6 —
7 —
8 G
9 S
10 U
9 UY
10 UW
11 KW
12 KY
13 GN
14 GP
15 GW
16 GY
6 —
7 —
8 G
9 S
10 U
1 PS
2 PO
3 OK
4 R
5 OB
6 OR
7 KS
8 KO
1 WG
2 WU
3 B
4 —
5 W
6 WN
7 —
8 —
9 —
10 WR
11 WY
12 WO
13 —
1 B
2 B
3 US
4 UO
5 NK
1 PS
2 PO
3 OK
4 R
5 OB
6 OR
7 KS
8 KO
1 B
2 B
3 US
4 UO
5 NK
KEY TRANSPONDER M ODULE AIRBAG / SRS CONTROL M ODULE ADAPTIVE DAM PING CONTROL M ODULE
BT69 FC22 FC29
FC30
FC22 / 20-WAY / GREEN (NAS) BT69 / 35-WAY / BLACK 19 —
FC29 / 12-WAY / BLACK 7 WK
8 OW
1 —
9 OP
FC30 / 12-WAY / GREY
10 —
2 —
3 —
4 BK
11 YU
5 YW
12 ON
12 BK
6 R
11 RS
6 WK
10 KU
9 KG
5 RG
4 KP
3 KN
8 RW
2 RP
1 SO
7 RW
20 PB 2 UP
21 UB
3 UW
22 RB 4 —
23 — 5 —
24 ON 6 —
25 U 7 —
26 US 8 —
27 NS 9 —
28 K 10 O
29 — 11 WR
30 OB 12 —
31 OW
13 OR
32 OK
14 OG
33 OY 15 OP
34 OU 16 —
35 — 17 —
10 —
9 SU
8 —
7 —
6 O
5 —
4 —
3 —
2 —
1 —
20 —
19 —
18 —
17 Y
16 O
15 —
14 —
13 —
12 —
11 —
18 B
FC22 / 20-WAY / GREEN (ROW)
1 —
10 —
9 SU
8 OG
7 OR
6 O
5 —
4 NR
3 —
2 —
1 SB
20 —
19 —
18 —
17 Y
16 O
15 —
14 WO
13 WN
12 BK
11 —
AIR CONDITIONING CONTROL M ODULE LAM P CONTROL M ODULE
AC4
AC4 / 22-WAY / BLACK
22
12 WR
13 B
1 WP
2 GY
AC3
AC2
AC3 / 12-WAY / GREY
14 B
15 GW
16 OU
17 UB
18 LGW
19 BW
20 BK
21 O
3 WN
4 WU
5 NY
6 PY
7 UG
8 P
9 UN
10 K
22 — 11 —
BT18
AC1
AC2 / 16-WAY / GREY
BT18 / 26-WAY / YELLOW
AC1 / 26-WAY / GREY
7 SY
8 SR
9 —
10 WP
11 UB
12 KU
9 OU
10 OR
11 YG
12 —
13 UY
14 —
15 UK
16 GP
1 ULG
2 S
3 SG
4 SB
5 OY
6 UG
1 OP
2 RG
3 YW
4 —
5 SU
6 SG
7 US
8 GO
14 —
15 —
1 RLG
2 U
16 LGN
17 RW
18 LGP
19 RU
20 SR
21 Y
22 NR
23 —
3 UY
4 PS
5 LGR
6 RY
7 PR
8 PY
9 RB
10 —
24 —
25 UR
26 GU
11 —
12 UW
13 UO
1 —
2 —
3 —
4 —
5 —
6 —
7 —
8 —
9 —
10 —
11 —
12 —
13 —
14 UP
15 UO
16 RY
17 RK
18 RU
19 UB
20 UW
21 RO
22 RG
23 RW
24 WG
25 R
26 BK
D A TE OF ISSU E:
SEPTEM BER 1 9 9 7
XK8 Range 1998
Relay and Fuse Box Identification and Location
Relay and Fuse Box Identification and Location
NOTE: RELAY COLORS ARE WRITTEN AS CASE COLOR (STRIPE) / CONNECTOR COLOR. FOR EXAM PLE, BLACK (BLUE) / BLUE INDICATES A RELAY HAVING A BLACK CASE WITH A BLUE STRIPE AND A BLUE CONNECTOR. IF THERE IS NO COLOR SHOWN IN PARENTHESES, THE RELAY CASE DOES NOT HAVE A STRIPE. SOM E RELAYS CONNECT DIRECTLY TO A FUSE BOX BUS. THE CONNECTOR COLOR FOR THESE RELAYS IS IDENTIFIED AS “BUS”. Fuel injection relay brow n / brow n Throttle motor power relay brow n / brow n Ignition coil relay brow n / brow n
Wiper FAST/ SLOW relay black / black LH blower motor relay black (blue) / blue
Wiper RUN/ STOP relay black / black Door mirror heater relay black (blue) / blue
RH blower motor relay black (blue) / blue Driver side fuse box (LHD) Passenger side fuse box (RHD)
DRIVESHAFT TUNNEL RELAYS
LH FASCIA RELAYS
EMS control relay brow n / bus
Air conditioning compressor clutch relay brow n / brow n
Ignition positive relay (LHD) Auxiliary positive relay (RHD) brow n / bus
Engine Management fuse box
CONTROL M ODULE ENCLOSURE RELAYS (RHD)
LH ENCLOSURE RELAYS
Heater pump relay brow n / bus Front fog relay brow n / bus Main beam relay brow n / bus
Powerwash relay brow n / bus Dip beam relay brow n / bus Horn relay brow n / bus Ignition positive relay brow n / bus
Engine compartment fuse box
ENGINE COM PARTM ENT FUSE BOX RELAYS
TRUNK RELAYS:
➞ VIN 024687
Tail lamp relay brow n / bus Heated backlight relay brow n / bus Rear fog relay brow n / bus Top up relay black / black Top down relay black / black
Fuel pump relay brow n / bus Stop lamp relay brow n / bus Accessory connector relay brow n / bus Ignition positive relay brow n / bus
RH FASCIA RELAYS LH quarter up relay / LH quarter down relay black (violet) / violet
Passenger side fuse box (LHD) Driver side fuse box (RHD)
RH ENCLOSURE RELAYS Auxiliary positive relay (LHD) Ignition positive relay (RHD) brow n / bus
CONTROL M ODULE ENCLOSURE RELAYS (LHD)
Intercooler pump relay (RHD): VIN 024687 brow n / brow n
RH quarter up relay / RH quarter down relay black (violet) / violet
➞
Heated backlight relay brow n / bus
➞
RH windshield heater relay brow n / brow n
Fuel pump 1 relay brow n / bus Stop lamp relay brow n / bus Accessory connector relay brow n / bus Ignition positive relay brow n / bus Trunk fuse box
FEBRU A RY 1 9 9 8
Starter relay brow n / brow n
Intercooler pump relay (LHD): VIN 024687 brow n / brow n Fuel injection relay brow n / brow n Throttle motor power relay brow n / brow n Ignition coil relay brow n / brow n
LH windshield heater relay brow n / brow n
Rear fog relay brow n / bus
D A TE OF ISSU E:
Door locking relay black (violet) / violet Air conditioning isolate relay black (violet) / violet
Tail lamp relay brow n / bus
Engine Management fuse box EMS control relay brow n / bus
Trunk fuse box
TRUNK RELAYS: VIN 024687
➞
Top up relay black / black Top down relay black / black LH quarter up relay / LH quarter down relay black (violet) / violet Fuel pump 2 relay brow n / brow n RH quarter up relay / RH quarter down relay black (violet) / violet
23
XK8 Range 1998
M ain Pow er Distribution
TUNNEL STUD CONNECTOR
FALSE BULKHEAD STUD CONNECTOR
N
N
N BT80
BT61 250A x 2
B
N
N BT67
BT62 BT60
BT66
BATTERY
EM71
FC91
LF71
ST1
6
03.1
04.1
04.2
03.2
STARTER
N
N
BT63
250A
BT79
Fig. 01.1
M ain Pow er Distribution
N N
HIGH POWER PROTECTION MODULE
BT68
(RHD) (LHD)
DRIVER DOOR CONTROL MODULE: WINDOW LIFT OPERATION (CIRCUIT CONTINUED) PASSENGER DOOR CONTROL MODULE: WINDOW LIFT OPERATION (CIRCUIT CONTINUED)
15.1 15.1
NO
26
PK BT44-2
11
NY
48
II
25 A BT44-1
N
II
RG
N
N
BT64
FC90
N
RG
FC6-6
N
LF7-9
FC93
FC92
EM20-6
FC90
LF70
EM70
BT49
BT2-14
TRANSIT ISOLATION DEVICE
2
1
1
2
1
2
2
1
1
2
5
3
5
3
5
3
5
3
5
3
IGNITION POSITIVE RELAY
1 KY RH2-20
N
FC21-6
KY
9
II
WN
N
BT12-9
B+ (BT66)
(BT65)
10
I
RG
BATTERY POST KY
12
2
1
II
O
AUXILIARY POSITIVE RELAY
IGNITION POSITIVE RELAY
3
2
I
IGNITION POSITIVE RELAY
4
3
II
EMS CONTROL RELAY
5
4
II
5
E
FC14-97
WO
5
I
II
FC14-15
WN
16
I
I
FC14-32
LOGIC
1
09.2
1
07.2
2
07.2
2
09.1
3
09.2
3
09.1
4
04.3
4
14.1
5
09.2
5
09.1
6
18.1
6
13.2
04.6
04.8
13.3
18.1
TRUNK FUSE BOX
1
6
7
51
Fig. 01.2
Fig. 01.1 1 II
5 E
52
81
Fig. 01.3
6
38
II
II
39 E
55 E
1 Fig. 01.5
18 I
BATTERY POWER BUS
IGNITION POWER BUS
BATTERY POWER BUS
IGNITION POWER BUS
PASSENGER SIDE FUSE BOX
I
Fig. 01.4
BATTERY POWER BUS
IGNITION AUXILIARY POWER BUS
BATTERY POWER BUS
IGNITION POWER BUS
BODY PROCESSOR MODULE
RELAYS
DRIVER SIDE FUSE BOX
ENGINE COMPARTMENT FUSE BOX
Input
O
Output
D
Serial and Encoded Com m unications
Signal Ground (SG)
C
CAN (Netw ork)
S
SCP Netw ork
Fig. 02.1
BATTERY POWER BUS
RELAYS
ENGINE MANAGEMENT POWER BUS
POWER
ENGINE MANAGEMENT FUSE BOX
V ARIAN T: All V ehicles V IN RAN GE: 018108 DATE OF ISSU E: FEBRU ARY 1998
➞
04.4
04.5
04.7
ECM CONTROL (CIRCUIT CONTINUED)
XK8 Range 1998
3
FC6 -1
#2 10A
FC6 -5
NK
7
11.4
12.1
12.2
BATTERY POWER BUS
#1 20A
SD1-2
NS
NS
8
NU NU
#3 30A
NU
NU
FC6 -3
LFS20
LF1-20
NU RW
9
07.2 14.1
10 14.1
NK #1 20A
RW
RW #4 10A
FC6 -8
FCS39
RW NB
#5 15A
NB
FC5 -9
NR
#2 10A
FC21 -5
#3
FC21 -3
NR
NR
NR
FCS19
FC5 -10
NY #7 15A
FC5 -4
#8 5A
FC5 -7
NY NP
NP FCS5
N N
NP FC5 -2
#9
N
SDS6
NW (LHD) NU (RHD) #11 20A
NW (LHD) NU (RHD)
NW FC21 -8
FC6 -4
#15 25A
NO FCS81
FC5 -3
NO
N
AC16-1 (LHD) AC15-20 (RHD)
NO
NLG #17 10A
NO
NO
NLG
DDS2
18 13.2
09.1
09.2
12.1
12.2
12.3
NP
12.4
13.3
NP
FC20 -9
18.1
NY NY
13.3
#6 10A
FC20 -10
#7 20A
FC20 -4
20 11.2
RH14-2
NY NY
FCS23
NB N
N #8 5A
12.2
12.4
35 11.2
11.3
12.1
36 11.3
11.4
15.1
13.1
13.2
31 13.1 32 13.1 33 13.1 34 15.1
37 13.1 38 10.1
22 12.1
N
FC20 -7
12.2
N
SPS1
SP1-5
NP
23 07.2
#9 10A
FC20 -2
24 19.1
#11 20A
FC21 -2
#13
FC21 -4
#15 25A
FC20 -3
25 10.1
11.2
11.3
11.4
12.1
13.1
13.2
13.3
15.1
26 01.1
NP
NU (LHD) NW (RHD)
NY
NY FCS82
NY
41 07.1 42 11.2 43 12.3
12.4
44 12.3
12.4
45 16.1
16.2
16.3
47 10.1
11.3
13.1
48 01.1
15.1
27 18.1
NR
N
NY
NY
NP NP
#18 10A
29 08.1
FC20 -6
FCS88
15.1
BT2-2
NG
FC20 -1
28 18.1
46 07.2
DP1-22
AC15-20 (LHD) AC16-1 (RHD)
NG #17 15A
NLG
NP
49 BPM 50 10.2 51 10.2
PASSENGER SIDE FUSE BOX
7
51
Fig. 01.2
Fig. 01.1 E
13.3
40 07.1
AC15-2 (LHD) AC16-3 (RHD)
NY
BT58-2
FC5 -6
6 5
13.2
39 16.4
BPM
II
15.1
IC2-13
15.1
DRIVER SIDE FUSE BOX
1
13.3
AC12-20
NB
19 BPM
21 12.1
NW NW
RH2-13
NLG
NR #18 5A
NW
15 BPM
BT2-8
FCS40
FC5 -1
NW DD1-4
DD1-22
RH2-8
NLG
NW
14 17.1
17 13.2
NW
ACS3
NU (LHD) NW (RHD) NY
NO
DPS2
NW AC13-14
NW
AC16-3 (LHD) AC15-2 (RHD)
NY #13 5A
NW NW
NW
13 17.1
16 06.1
12.3
NOTE: SPS1 – 3-way seat only.
SD1-5
FC6 -2
NR
FCS89
11 14.1
RF1-7
NR
NR
DP1-4
12 17.1
30 11.4
SP1-2
NR
#5 5A
#6 5A
NK
FC21 -1
#4 5A
1
Fig. 01.2
2
NK BATTERY POWER BUS
Battery Pow er Distribution: Driver and Passenger Side Fuse Boxes
Battery Pow er Distribution: Driver and Passenger Side Fuse Boxes
52
81
Fig. 01.3
6
38
II
II
39 E
55 E
I
Fig. 01.4 1 Fig. 01.5
18 I
Input
O
Output
D
Serial and Encoded Com m unications
Signal Ground (SG)
C
CAN (Netw ork)
S
SCP Netw ork
Fig. 02.1
V ARIAN T: All V ehicles V IN RAN GE: 018108 DATE OF ISSU E: SEPTEM BER 1997
➞
NOTE: Body Processor Module appears in numerous Figures.
XK8 Range 1998
1
4
NK
BATTERY POWER BUS
NK NK #1 5A
NK
(CONV.) BTS36
BT13 -7
NK NK NS
#2 20A
NS
BT13 -1
NG NG
#9 10A
NG
NG BTS42
BT11 -3
RELAYS Fig. 01.1
52 09.2
11.4
15.2
53 15.2 54 15.2 55 15.2 56 15.2
NG
58 16.1
16.2
#10 10A
NY
BT13 -2
NU NU
#12 20A (CONV.)
NU
BTS32
BT12 -3
NO NO #14 40A (CONV.)
BT13 -4
#16
BT12 -4
#18
BT10 -1
#20 20A (CONV.)
NO
BTS4
NR NR NR
BTS31
BT10 -3
NW #22 20A
NW
LF6 -3
#10
LF8 -2
#12 30A
LF7 -3
#14 30A
LF8 -4
#16 30A
LF7 -4
16.3
59 16.3
68 13.2
NLG
69 04.3
NG
70 04.3
NY
04.6 04.6
04.8 04.8
07.2
II
E
#3 25A
EM20 -3
61 13.1
13.2
NW
NW
NW
NW NO (N/A) NO
EMS41
EM20 -8
(SC)
72 06.1
#18 30A
LF5 -1
#20
LF5 -3
#5 10A
EM19 -9
#22
LF5 -2
#6
EM19 -10
#7
EM19 -4
#8 10A
EM19 -7
#9 30A
EM19 -2
#11
EM20 -2
#13
EM20 -4
#15 30A
EM19 -3
#17 30A
EM19 -1
NO
NY
NY
NLG
NLG
NG
NG
NG
NG
NP
NP
NW
NW
51
Fig. 01.2
52
81
Fig. 01.3
ENGINE COMPARTMENT FUSE BOX
63 15.2 64 15.2
66 15.2 67 15.2 67A 04.6
38
II
II
E
73 03.1
03.2
74 04.1
04.2
04.4
04.5
75 05.1 75A 04.7
NOTE: Circuit introduced VIN 024687 ➞.
76 04.3
04.6
04.8
77 04.3
04.6
04.8
07.2
78 04.1
04.2
04.4
04.5
04.6
04.8
65 15.2
6 39
NOTE: Circuit introduced VIN 024687 ➞.
62 15.2
04.8
NOTE: Circuit introduced VIN 024687 ➞. #18 10A
7
72A 04.8
13.3
EM19 -6
ENGINE MANAGEMENT FUSE BOX
6 5
EM20 -5
#4 5A
BT12 -7
Fig. 01.1 1
#2 20A
NO
TRUNK FUSE BOX
1
EM20 -1
07.2
71 06.1
NR
#1
60 16.3
IC4-2
NY
NW #9 10A
57 11.5
IC4-1
NG
Fig. 01.3
5
BATTERY POWER BUS
(COUPE)
BATTERY POWER BUS
RELAYS Fig. 01.1
Battery Pow er Distribution: Trunk, Engine Compartment and EM S Fuse Boxes
Battery Pow er Distribution: Trunk, Engine Compartment and EM S Fuse Boxes
55 E
I
Fig. 01.4 1 Fig. 01.5
18 I
Input
O
Output
D
Serial and Encoded Com m unications
Signal Ground (SG)
C
CAN (Netw ork)
S
SCP Netw ork
Fig. 02.1
V ARIAN T: All V ehicles V IN RAN GE: 018108 DATE OF ISSU E: FEBRU ARY 1998
➞
79 07.2 80 07.2 81 04.3
04.7
XK8 Range 1998
Ignition Sw itched Pow er Distribution
1
II
II
WU
IGNITION POWER BUS
WU #10 5A
6 II
FC6 -7
WP
7 II
WP
8 II
WP
WP #12 10A
FCS8
FC6 -10
WP
WP
9 II
ACS17
AC15-3
WP
FCS29
FC5 -8
WR
EMS15
WR #16 5A
DRIVER SIDE FUSE BOX
12 04.3 II
BT13 -9
#5
BT11 -2
WR
FC21 -10
04.6
WG
13 08.1 II
WG
14 04.1 II
WG
15 17.1 II
WR
16 11.4 II
WR
17 07.2 II
WR
18 07.2 II
WR
19 05.1 II
05.2
WR
20 05.1 II
05.2
WR
20A 05.2 II
#14 20A
FC20 -8
#16
FC20 -5
LG
LG
21 16.4 I
WY
WY
22 16.1 I
WU
23 18.1 I
IC2-12
WU
24A 04.6 II
WR
25 11.5 II
WB
26A 05.2 II
WB
27 05.1 II
WB
28 05.1 II
WP
29 03.1 II
WR
30 13.2 II
WR
31 09.3 II
WR
32 09.3 II
WR
33 09.3 II
WU
34 06.1 II
WK
35 03.1 II
03.2
WK
36 04.1 II
04.2
04.4
WK
37 04.3 II
04.6
04.8
04.2
04.8
NOTE: Circuit deleted VIN 024687 ➞.
1
09.2
2
07.2
4
04.3
04.8
RELAYS
TRUNK FUSE BOX
NOTE: Circuit introduced VIN 024687 ➞.
4 (SC)
WB
16.2
#1 10A
LF8 -7
#2 5A
LF8 -1
WB
(N/A) EMS42
LF40-13
WP
WP
PI2-12
LF3-13
16.3
WR #3 5A
LFS5
LF8 -8
WR LF60-9
WU LF8 -9
WK #5 10A
PASSENGER SIDE FUSE BOX
LF6 -2
WK LF40-10
WR
EMS6
LF5 -9
38 II
1 07.2 2 09.1 RELAYS
ENGINE COMPARTMENT FUSE BOX
6
7
51
Fig. 01.2
Fig. 01.1 1 II
5 E
52
81
Fig. 01.3
6
38
II
II
39 E
55 E
I
Fig. 01.4 1 Fig. 01.5
18 I
NOTE: Circuit introduced VIN 024687 ➞.
04.6
#4 5A
1
04.8
WG
II
FC21 -7
WG BTS1
BT10 -9
IGNITION POWER BUS
IGNITION AUXILIARY POWER BUS
#4 5A
24 09.2 II
II
I
#12 5A
BT13 -8
26
2
#10 5A
WG #3 5A
WG
07.2
WG
FCS63
FC5 -5
07.1
11 11.1 II
WR EM2-3
07.2
WP
RF1-1
WR
19.1
10 07.2 II
WG #14 10A
IGNITION POWER BUS
3
Fig. 01.4
Ignition Sw itched Pow er Distribution
Input
O
Output
D
Serial and Encoded Com m unications
Signal Ground (SG)
C
CAN (Netw ork)
S
SCP Netw ork
Fig. 02.1
V ARIAN T: All V ehicles V IN RAN GE: 018108 DATE OF ISSU E: FEBRU ARY 1998
➞
NOTE: Circuit introduced VIN 024687 ➞.
03.2
04.5
04.7
XK8 Range 1998
Engine M anagement Sw itched Pow er Supplies
Engine M anagement Sw itched Pow er Supplies
5
ENGINE MANAGEMENT POWER BUS
E
WR #10 5A
39 04.1 E
04.2
04.4
04.5
04.7
WR
40 04.1 E
04.2
04.4
04.5
04.7
WR
41 05.1 E
WR
42 04.1 E
04.2
04.4
04.5
04.7
WR
43 04.1 E
04.2
04.4
04.5
04.7
WU
44 04.1 E
04.2
04.4
04.5
04.7
WU
45 04.3 E
04.6
04.8
07.2
WU
46 04.1 E
04.2
04.4
04.5
WU
47 04.1 E
04.2
04.4
04.5
WU
48 04.1 E
04.2
04.4
04.5
WU
48A 04.7 E
WP
49 04.1 E
04.2
04.4
04.5
04.7
WP
50 04.1 E
04.2
04.4
04.5
04.7
WP
51 04.1 E
04.2
04.4
04.5
04.7
WP
52 04.3 E
04.6
04.8
WP
53 04.1 E
04.2
04.4
04.5
04.7
WP
54 04.3 E
04.6
04.8
07.2
WP
54A 04.7 E
NOTE: Circuit introduced VIN 024687 ➞.
WP
54B 04.7 E
NOTE: Circuit introduced VIN 024687 ➞.
WY
55 04.1 E
EMS7
EM20 -7
WR
WR ELS3
EL1-1
WU
WU LFS24
LF40-12
WU #12 10A
WR
WU EMS16
EM20 -10
WU
(N/A) PIS6
PI1-28
NOTE: LF3-9 introduced VIN 024687 ➞.
(SC)
WP LF3-9
WP #14 10A
EMS30
EM19 -8
WP
WP PI1-47
PIS8
WY #16 5A
EM19 -5
NOTE: Circuit introduced VIN 024687 ➞.
04.2
04.4
04.5
04.7
ENGINE MANAGEMENT FUSE BOX
1
6
7
51
Fig. 01.2
Fig. 01.1 1 II
5 E
52
81
Fig. 01.3
6
38
II
II
39 E
55 E
I
Fig. 01.4 1 Fig. 01.5
18 I
Input
O
Output
D
Serial and Encoded Com m unications
Signal Ground (SG)
C
CAN (Netw ork)
S
SCP Netw ork
Fig. 02.1
V ARIAN T: All V ehicles V IN RAN GE: 018108 DATE OF ISSU E: FEBRU ARY 1998
➞
Fig. 01.5
XK8 Range 1998
Ignition Sw itched Ground Distribution
III
III
III
III
II
II
II
II
I
I
I
I
IGNITION SWITCH (OFF)
IGNITION SWITCH (I)
IGNITION SWITCH (II)
IGNITION SWITCH (III)
WO
2 II
WO RW
III
1
WO
FCS48
FC4-5
BK
WO
FCS26
5 II
WN
I
4 II
WO FC4-3
BK
3 II
BPM
FC4-1 II
WO
FC4-2
WO
WO
6 II
ACS15
AC13-2
IGNITION SWITCH
WO
7 II
14.1 13.2
13.3
19.1 BPM 04.1
04.2
05.3
06.1
09.2
11.5
NOTE: Circuit deleted VIN 024687 ➞.
04.1
04.2
04.4
04.5
04.7
05.3
06.1
04.8
07.2
NOTE: Circuit introduced VIN 024687 ➞.
09.2
FC3BL
RG
8 II
WO
RG
FC46-2
RG
FC46-1 FC46-3
FCS25
LFS27
LF60-8
RG
RG RH2-9
WN
WN
01.1
9A 04.6 II
RG
10 01.1 II
RG
11 01.1 II
WN
12 01.1 I
WN
13 18.1 I
WN
14 10.2 I
WN
15 13.2 I
WN
16 BPM I
WN
17 07.1 I
WN
18 19.1 I
BT1-18
FCS20
WN
BPM
RG
BT1-16
RH2-10
9 II
RG
RG
INERTIA SWITCH
AC13-1
BPM
1
6
7
51
Fig. 01.2
Fig. 01.1 1 II
5 E
52
81
Fig. 01.3
6
38
II
II
39 E
55 E
I
Fig. 01.4 1 Fig. 01.5
18 I
Fig. 02.1
Ignition Sw itched Ground Distribution
Input
O
Output
D
Serial and Encoded Com m unications
Signal Ground (SG)
C
CAN (Netw ork)
S
SCP Netw ork
Fig. 02.1
13.3
NOTE: Body Processor Module appears in numerous Figures.
V ARIAN T: All V ehicles V IN RAN GE: 018108 DATE OF ISSU E: FEBRU ARY 1998
➞
11.5
XK8 Range 1998
Battery; Starter; Generator: AJ26 N/A
Fig. 03.1
Battery; Starter; Generator: AJ26 N/ A
FALSE BULKHEAD STUD CONNECTOR N
N BT80
BT61 250A x 2
B
N
BT67
BT68
01.1
BT62
N BT66
BT60
BATTERY
N
BT63
250A
01.1
HIGH POWER PROTECTION MODULE
NB
15
B+ FC14-80
RW
III
RW
1
FC14-41
WO
II
02.1
Y
FC4-3 FCS48
WN
I
73
SU
NW
3
5
WR
WK
1
2
GO
D
35
FC14-92
IGNITION SWITCH (III)
FC3BL
EM50
D FC14-39
02.1
FC4-2
FC4-5
GO EMS28
EM1-15
I
FC4-1
BK
GO
GO
O FC14-73
BK
ST1
II ENGINE CRANKING CONTROL
BK FCS47
BK
BK
RU
FC89-3
STARTER RELAY
POWER
RU
I FC14-7
FC89-1
LOGIC
NEUTRAL SWITCH FC3BR
BODY PROCESSOR MODULE
GO
I EM11-6
ENGINE START
FUEL PUMP CONTROL AND IGNITION
SU
D
GLASS BREAKAGE SECURITY ACKNOWLEDGE
D
SECURITY ACKNOWLEDGE
D
OK TO START
FC22-9
PARK, NEUTRAL (CIRCUIT CONTINUED)
05.1
SECURITY ACKNOWLEDGE
G EM10-15
Y
Y
D EM10-17
I OK TO START
Y FCS74
EM3-8
FC22-17
O
O
D EM10-6
EM2-18
FC22-16
ENGINE CONTROL MODULE
KEY TRANSPONDER MODULE WR
ST2
N
6
B 29
WP
ST10
II MAJOR INSTRUMENT PACK: CHARGE INDICATOR (CIRCUIT CONTINUED)
08.1
PI50-2
SW
SW EM1-14
SW PI1-11
STARTER MOTOR
REGULATOR
PI50-1
B
N AN1
AN3-1
ST11
B AN2
AN3-2
GENERATOR SUPPRESSION MODULE
1
6
7
51
Fig. 01.2
Fig. 01.1 1 II
5 E
52
81
Fig. 01.3
6
38
II
II
39 E
55 E
I
Fig. 01.4 1 Fig. 01.5
18 I
Input
O
Output
D
Serial and Encoded Com m unications
Signal Ground (SG)
C
CAN (Netw ork)
S
SCP Netw ork
Fig. 02.1
WR EM60-2
ST3
V ARIAN T: AJ26 N / A V ehicles V IN RAN GE: 018108 DATE OF ISSU E: FEBRU ARY 1998
➞
N
XK8 Range 1998
Battery; Starter; Generator: AJ26 SC
FALSE BULKHEAD STUD CONNECTOR
N
BT80
BT61 250A x 2
B
N
BT67
BT68
BT66
BT60
BATTERY
N
BT63
250A
01.1
HIGH POWER PROTECTION MODULE
NB
15
B+ FC14-80
RW
III
RW
1
FC14-41
WO
II
02.1
Y
FC4-3 FCS48
WN
I
73
SU
NW
3
5
WR
WK
1
2
GO
D
35
FC14-92
IGNITION SWITCH (III)
FC3BL
EM50
D FC14-39
02.1
FC4-2
FC4-5
GO EMS28
EM1-15
I
FC4-1
BK
GO
GO
O FC14-73
BK
N
ST1
01.1
BT62
N
Fig. 03.2
Battery; Starter; Generator: AJ26 SC
II
ENGINE CRANKING CONTROL
STARTER RELAY P, N
RU
O
RU
I
POWER
FC14-7
FC100-4
LOGIC
P, N
B
B EMS43
B EM2-2
EM2AL (EM1AL)
G
O FC100-5
I
BODY PROCESSOR MODULE
EM1-11
FC100-2
DUAL LINEAR SWITCH GO
I EM11-6
ENGINE START
FUEL PUMP CONTROL AND IGNITION
G
I
SU
EM10-15
SECURITY ACKNOWLEDGE
Y
Y
D EM10-17
OK TO START
Y FCS74
EM3-8
GLASS BREAKAGE SECURITY ACKNOWLEDGE
D
SECURITY ACKNOWLEDGE
D
OK TO START
FC22-17
O
O
D
D FC22-9
EM10-6
EM2-18
FC22-16
ENGINE CONTROL MODULE
WR
KEY TRANSPONDER MODULE
WR EM60-2
ST3 ST2
N
6
B 29
WP
ST10
II
MAJOR INSTRUMENT PACK: CHARGE INDICATOR (CIRCUIT CONTINUED)
PI50-2
08.1
SW
SW EM1-14
PI1-11
STARTER MOTOR
REGULATOR
SW PI50-1
B
N AN1
AN3-1
ST11
B AN2
AN3-2
GENERATOR SUPPRESSION MODULE
1
6
7
51
Fig. 01.2
Fig. 01.1 1 II
5 E
52
81
Fig. 01.3
6
38
II
II
39 E
55 E
I
Fig. 01.4 1 Fig. 01.5
18 I
Input
O
Output
D
Serial and Encoded Com m unications
Signal Ground (SG)
C
CAN (Netw ork)
S
SCP Netw ork
Fig. 02.1
V ARIAN T: AJ26 SC V ehicles V IN RAN GE: 024687 DATE OF ISSU E: FEBRU ARY 1998
➞
N
XK8 Range 1998
AJ26 N/A NAS Engine M anagement: Part 1 ECM AND TCM COOLING FAN
WY
55
A
B
E
EM64-2
UPSTREAM HO2S
VVT SOLENOID VALVES
EVAPP
MAFS
B
CMPS
CKPS
KS
IATS
KS
A
ECTS
A
CCV
B
DOWNSTREAM O2S
FTP SENSOR
A
B
B
EM64-1
υ
υ
B
Fig. 04.1
AJ26 N/ A NAS Engine M anagement: Part 1
λ
λ
λ
λ
I
EM11-9
I
EM11-10
I
EM11-11
O
EM11-12
I
EM11-13
BRAKE SWITCH
EM11-14
O
03.1
D EM10-6
SERIAL COMMUNICATION
K
19.1
EM12-12
I
EM12-13
I
EM12-14
I
EM12-15
I
EM12-16
I
EM12-17
O D
EM12-18
O
EM12-19
SERIAL COMMUNICATION
19.1
EMS CONTROL RELAY (CIRCUIT CONTINUED) SECURITY ACKNOWLEDGE
G
05.1
EM12-22
I EM10-15
PK
01.1
O EM10-16
Y
03.1
D EM10-17
CAN
G
19.1
C– EM10-25
CAN
Y
19.1
C+
G
19.1
EM13-4
O
EM13-11
O
EM13-12
O
EM13-13
I
EM13-17
I
EM13-18
I
EM13-19
I
EM13-20
I
EM13-27
I
EM13-28 EM13-29
CAN
Y
19.1
C+ EM10-28
ECM PROGRAMMING
19.1
ENGINE CRANK
03.1
P
D EM11-3
GO
I EM11-6
ECM PROGRAMMING
W
19.1
GY EM16
78 53
5
GY
GY EMS20
WP
B+ EM14-1
3
1
B+ EM14-2
GR
2
E
O
6
7
51
Fig. 01.2
1 II
5 E
52
81
Fig. 01.3
EM1-10
OK PW RW PY N S Y B BG P O
RH1-8
BRD EMS3
PI1 -50 -49
I
EM14-4
O
EM14-5
O
EM14-6
I
EM14-7
I
EM14-8
I
EM14-9
I
EM14-10
O
EM14-11
O
EM14-12
O
EM15-1
O
EM15-2
O
EM15-3
O
EM15-8
O
EM15-9
-51
-12
-14
PI1 -3 -4
-1
PIS9
EMS9
R G
BK R R B B B B G G
R G
PI2-7 PI2-6
EMS19
42
43
E
E
EMS18
EL2-2
EL3-2
1
2
EL2-1
EL3-1
PI33 -2
PI33 -1
PI42 -5
PI42 -3
PI42 -1
PI42 -4
PI42 -2
PI6 -3
-4 -1
I
EM15-11
I
EM15-12
I
EM15-22
PS PU PN RG RY B B B
-2
VACUUM SWITCHING VALVES 3
PEDAL POSITION
38
II
II
39 E
55 E
EMS38 EM1BR (EM2BR)
BK
Fig. 01.5
B
EMS37 EM1AL (EM2AL)
B
I
Fig. 01.4
1
MECHANICAL GUARD
-2
TPS THROTTLE MOTOR
ELS1
18 I
EMS36 EM1AR (EM2AR)
EL1-2
PEDAL POSITION AND MECHANICAL GUARD SENSORS
EL1-5
PW RW PY
EL1-4
6
EL4 -1
THROTTLE ASSEMBLY EMS31
EL1-3
NOTE: ELS1 – LHD Coupe and RHD Convertible only.
EM2AR (EM1AR)
Input
O
Output
D
Serial and Encoded Com m unications
Signal Ground (SG)
C
CAN (Netw ork)
S
SCP Netw ork
Fig. 02.1
V ARIAN T: AJ26 N / A N AS V ehicles V IN RAN GE: 024687 DATE OF ISSU E: FEBRU ARY 1998
➞
W
U
W
-1
BRD
N
BRD
U
BG RG UW
WU
OK
WP
BRD PS
U
B
W B
U G
UY
N
BRD
S
BRD
P
Y
BRD
OK RH1-9 RH1-10
UP GY G R N U BY BY BP
ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (CONTINUED Fig. 04.6)
Fig. 01.1
EM1-4
EMS1
EM13-14
THROTTLE MOTOR POWER RELAY
1
UW
D EM13-2
NG
EM1-9
C– EM10-27
BG RG UW
PIS1
EMS8 O
EM10-26
CAN
PI1-6
D EM10-13
PARK, NEUTRAL (CIRCUIT CONTINUED)
BG BG
BG
UW
EM10-12
O
BT2 -4 -5 -3
G
PARKING BRAKE SWITCH
OK TO START
I
E
LF40-5
EMS2
I EM10-14
EM2-13
EM11-16
EM24 -2
44
E
U BRD UW BG
FC19
51
PI1 -5
BG
OU
EM11-15
I
-1
UW
OU
I
O
EM11-8
B BRD
O
RG UW UY G U BG BY BG R K
UP
EM11-7
-20
UW
EM1-8 EM10-10
I
BG BG
PI1 -19
BY
I
EM10-23
-18
R
FCS35
US
EM10-22
I
PI1 -17
K BRD
AC13-3
US
EM10-21
I
EM22 -2
B
AC24-1
US
O
BG UW B BK
PI1 -22 -23 -21
B
AC24-4
US
EM10-20
BT5 -1 -2 -3
-2
B
GB
O
PI1 -25 -26 -24
B
B
EM14-3
-57
WR
II
B+
-31
WR
WO
7
-4 -1
E
BY BY GY
E
EM23 -3
50
PI1 -56 -54 -52
BG
WR
-2
-2
E
EM10-9
40
B
-4 -1
WP
R
N
BRD
S
P
Y
BRD
46
W B
EM21 -3
LF52 -1
BG RG UW
E
B+
O
PIS10
49
E
B BRD
48
U
R
W -2
UY E
NO
LF3-8
PI1-27
47
BY BY
PI1-16
B+ EM10-5
74
-2 PI27 -1
B+ EM10-1
II
W
-2 PI26 -1
-1
BRD PU
-3
R
W
-2 PI17 -1
PI4 -2
BG
PI15 -1
S
-3
W
-4
PI35 -5 -2 -1
S
WP
RG
-1
BRD
WK
E
LF58 -2
UP
36
-2
BG
WR
PI32 -1
BY GY WU
39
-2
WU
RY
PI31 -1
WU
EM2AL (EMIAL)
PN
EMS43
AJ26 N/A ROW Engine M anagement: Part 1 KS A
ECTS
A
B
B
EM64-1
υ
υ
B
HO2S
λ
λ NOT USED
-2
E
E
B+
EM11-11
O
EM11-12
I
EM11-13 EM11-14
I
EM12-12
I
EM12-13
I
EM12-14
I
EM12-15
D EM10-6
K
19.1
D
EM12-17 O
EM12-18
O
EM12-19
EM10-12
SERIAL COMMUNICATION
O
19.1
G
05.1
EM12-22
EMS CONTROL RELAY (CIRCUIT CONTINUED)
I
SECURITY ACKNOWLEDGE
PK
01.1
O EM10-16
Y
03.1
D EM10-17
CAN
G
19.1
C– EM10-25
CAN
Y
19.1
C+
O
EM13-11
O
EM13-12
O
EM13-13
I
EM13-17
I
EM13-18
I
EM13-19
I
EM13-20
I
EM13-27
I
EM13-28
EM10-26
CAN
G
19.1
EM13-29
Y
19.1
C+ EM10-28
ECM PROGRAMMING
P
19.1
D EM11-3
ENGINE CRANK
GO
03.1
I EM11-6
ECM PROGRAMMING
W
19.1
GY EM16
78 53
B+ EM14-1
3
5
WP
1
2
GY
GY EMS20
B+ EM14-2
GR
E
O
II
I
EM14-4
6
7
51
Fig. 01.2
5 E
52
81
Fig. 01.3
B
W B
U
OK
WP
BRD PS
OK
UY
N
BRD
PI1 -50 -49
O
EM14-5
O
EM14-6
I
EM14-7
I
EM14-8
I
EM14-9
I
EM14-10
O
EM14-11
O
EM14-12
O
EM15-1
O
EM15-2
O
EM15-3
O
EM15-8
O
EM15-9
-51
-12
-14
PI1 -3 -4
-1
PIS9
EMS9
R G
BK R R B B B B G G
R G
PI2-7 PI2-6
EMS19
EMS18
I
EM15-11
I
EM15-12
I
EM15-22
PS PU PN RG RY B B B
42
43
E
E
EL2-2
EL3-2
1
2
EL2-1
EL3-1
PI33 -2
PI33 -1
PI42 -5
PI42 -3
PI42 -1
PI42 -4
PI42 -2
PI6 -3
-4 -1
-2
VACUUM SWITCHING VALVES 3
PEDAL POSITION
6
38
II
II
39 E
55 E
EMS38 EM1BR (EM2BR)
BK
Fig. 01.5
B
EMS37 EM1AL (EM2AL)
B
I
Fig. 01.4
1
EL4 -1
MECHANICAL GUARD
-2
TPS THROTTLE MOTOR
ELS1
18 I
EMS36 EM1AR (EM2AR)
EL1-2
PEDAL POSITION AND MECHANICAL GUARD SENSORS
EL1-5
PW RW PY
EL1-4
ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (CONTINUED Fig. 04.6)
Fig. 01.1
1
EMS3
EM13-14
THROTTLE MOTOR POWER RELAY
1
BRD
D EM13-2
NG
OK PW RW PY N S Y B BG P O
C– EM10-27
CAN
S
EMS8 EM13-4
EM10-15
RH1-8
UP GY G R N U BY BY BP
D EM10-13
PARK, NEUTRAL (CIRCUIT CONTINUED)
EM1-10
EMS1
UW
SERIAL COMMUNICATION
RH1-9 RH1-10
G
O
03.1
EM1-4
UW
EM12-16
OK TO START
UW
BG
PARKING BRAKE SWITCH
BT2 -4 -5 -3
BG RG UW
PIS1 EM1-9
I EM10-14
EM2-13
EM11-16
PI1-6
EMS2
UW
FC19
EM11-15
I
EM24 -2
E
LF40-5
BY
OU
I
-1
44
E
R
EM1-8 EM10-10
EM11-10
I
BRAKE SWITCH OU
51
PI1 -5
K BRD
I
I
NOT USED
EM22 -2
B
FCS35
US
-20
B
AC13-3
US
BT5 -1 -2 -3
-2
THROTTLE ASSEMBLY
B
AC24-1
US
EM11-9
PI1 -19
EMS31
B
AC24-4
US
I
-2
BG BG
WR
II
GB
EM11-8
RG UW UY G U BG BY BG R K
-18
BG
WR
7
B
O
BG BG
PI1 -17
BRD
EM10-23
P
EM10-22
I
Y
EM10-21
I
PI1 -22 -23 -21
BRD
O
BG UW B BK
PI1 -25 -26 -24
O
EM10-20
-57
B BRD
O
-31
UP
EM14-3
EM11-7
WO
-4 -1
E
BY BY GY
E
EM23 -3
50
PI1 -56 -54 -52
B+
BG
WR
-2
LF52 -1
NOT USED
E
EM10-9
40
B
-4 -1
G
R
N
S
P
Y
W B
EM21 -3
BRD
46
O
PIS10
49
BRD
48
U
W
R
-2 PI27 -1
UY E
NO
74
LF3-8
PI1-27
47
BY BY
PI1-16
B+ EM10-5
B BRD
EM10-1
II
W
R
-2 PI26 -1
B+
WP
-3
-1
BRD PU
-2 PI17 -1
PI4 -2
BG
PI15 -1
W
-3
S
-4
W
PI35 -5 -2 -1
S
WP
RG
-1
BRD
WK
E
LF58 -2
UP
36
-2
BG
WR
PI32 -1
BY GY WU
39
-2
WU
RY
PI31 -1
WU
EM2AL (EMIAL)
PN
EMS43
EL1-3
NOTE: ELS1 – LHD Coupe and RHD Convertible only.
EM2AR (EM1AR)
Input
O
Output
D
Serial and Encoded Com m unications
Signal Ground (SG)
C
CAN (Netw ork)
S
SCP Netw ork
Fig. 02.1
V ARIAN T: AJ26 N / A ROW V ehicles V IN RAN GE: 024687 DATE OF ISSU E: FEBRU ARY 1998
➞
-1
BRD
IATS
KS
N
EM64-2
CKPS
U BRD UW BG
E
B
CMPS
BRD
A
B
MAFS
U
WY
55
HO2S EVAPP
BG RG UW
VVT SOLENOID VALVES
BG RG UW
ECM AND TCM COOLING FAN
Fig. 04.2
AJ26 N/ A ROW Engine M anagement: Part 1
WU
XK8 Range 1998
XK8 Range 1998
AJ26 N/A Engine M anagement: Part 2 CRUISE CONTROL SWITCH
KN BT11-10
I
EM11-4
I
EM11-5
I
EM12-5
I
EM12-6
I
EM12-8
I
EM12-9
O
EM12-10
O
EM13-1
O
EM13-3
O
EM13-16 EM13-22
O
EM13-23
O
EM13-24
O
EM13-25
O
EM13-26
O
EM13-31
O
EM13-32
O
EM13-33
O
EM13-34
O
EM15-4
O
EM15-5
O
EM15-6
O
EM15-7
O
EM15-15
O
EM15-16
O
EM15-17
O
EM15-18
PW
GP
PW
GO
PW
GR
PIS5
SG SW1 -3
SC3-3
SWS1 EM26 PI1-40
BO SW1 -6
FCS48
KW
SW3-2 RESUME
BO
CRUISE CONTROL SWITCHES
SW2-6
STEERING WHEEL
BK
CAUTION: The steering wheel contains two logic ground circuits that must remain separate. Do not connect or cross-switch the BO and BK circuits.
FC3BL
PW PI1-53
BO
CANCEL 430 Ω
SW3-1
SW2-3
EM27 -8
IGNITION MODULE 1
EM2 -15
PI1-42
PI1-41
PI1-39
EM27 -7
EM27 -12
1A
2B
3B
PI1-46
EM27 EM27 -11 -10
PI1-45
PI1-44
EM29 -8
EM29 -11
4A
EM29 -7
1B
EM27 EM27 EM27 EM27 EM27 EM27 -1 -2 -3 -6 -5 -9
EM29 -9
PI1-43
PW PW
GP
EM3-1
GO
SG
SG
RH2 -15
EM2 -9
PW
PW
680 Ω
KN SP KW W WU UB LGK LGO LGW LGU LGY LGR LGS LGP
EM13-15
O
BO
CASSETTE
SC3-12
WU YW SLG SG RY
EM13-9 O
EM3 -4
BO
SR WU SG
-1
PW
5
3
NW
UB
2
1
WP
EMS22
2A
3A
81 52 E
EM29 EM29 -12 -10
IGNITION COIL RELAY
IGNITION MODULE 2
4B
EM29 EM29 EM29 EM29 EM29 -1 -2 -5 -3 -6
EM1-13 EM2-12 EM1-3
LGY
EM11-1
PI25-2
LGO
I
EM3 -3
CASSETTE
KN
-1
PI20-2
LGW
EM10-11
-1
GR
I
PI19-2
LGP
EM10-4
-1
PI22-2
GB
I
-1
B
EM10-3
PI21-2
EM2-14
RLG
UG ULG UN UB RLG
AC13-9 AC12-19 AC12-12 AC12-14
EM2-6
EMS31
UG ULG UN UB RLG
NOTE: Refer to Fig. 07.1 and Fig. 07.2 for complete A/C circuits.
EM2AR (EM1AR)
AC4-7
I
AC3-1
O
AC4-9
O
AC4-17
I
AC1-1
I
AC12-13
AIR CONDITIONING CONTROL MODULE
B
I
UG ULG UN PG
EM3 -6
KW
RH1 -11
-1
SW3-4
LGU
EM10-2
KN
– 430 Ω
SW3-3
SW2-4
PI24-2
GW
TRUNK FUSE BOX
SW1 -4
SC3-4
4B
+
BT2 -15
BT2 -6
FUEL PUMP RELAY (#4)
O
EM3-2
SR
-1
PI23-2
B
II
680 Ω
CASSETTE
SR
-1
LGK
2
3A
II
GK
26
WU SP SR
2A
12
FC63 -8
ON / OFF
LGR
1
WG
FC63 -9
PI18-2
BT11-1
#7 20A
FC63 -7
GB
NY
5
WU
FCS71
AC13-16
BRAKE CANCEL SWITCH
PG 3
AC24-3
WU
1B
PW
AC24-2
AC13-15
1
WU
GW
PG
PW
II
4A
560 Ω
GK
KW
1
560 Ω
GS
SP
24A
FC63 -10
GS
2
10.2
3B
LGS
WG
UW
5
GU
3
2B
PW
NW
IGNITION COILS 1A
RLG
GU
67A
DIMMER OVERRIDE
PW
NOT USED (FUEL PUMP 2 RELAY)
Fig. 04.3
AJ26 N/ A Engine M anagement: Part 2
EM17
RLG
5
3
NLG
RY
2
1
WP
EMS26
77 54 E
BO BY BW BU BP BG BN BS
AIR CONDITIONING COMPRESSOR CLUTCH RELAY
OG LF9-2
W
W
WU LF9-9
LF40-6
PI1-30
PI1-32
PI1-33
PI1-34
PI1-35
PI1-36
PI1-37
NG LF9-3
LF9-5
ENGINE CONTROL MODULE
WU
RLG
RLG PI1-13
OY
PI1-38
45 E
LF9-8
B PI36-1
AIR CONDITIONING COMPRESSOR CLUTCH
70
WU LF9-7
LF40-7 EM5
NY
76
BT55-2
NY
3
BR
5
FUEL PUMP
37
WK
1
UB EMS31
PI7-2
-1
PI8-2
-1
PI9-2
-1
PI10-2
-1
PI11-2
-1
PI12-2
-1
PI13-2
-1
PI14-2
NLG
-1
LF12-2
WU
20 BAR
YW
12 BAR
REFRIGERANT 4-WAY PRESSURE SWITCH
69
RH RADIATOR FAN OY
BT2AL
1A
2A
3A
4A
1B
2B
3B
B LF13-2
4B
LF13-1
LH RADIATOR FAN
FUEL INJECTORS
LF2AL
NOTE: ECM power supplies and grounds shown on Fig. 04.4 and Fig. 04.5.
1
6
7
51
Fig. 01.2
Fig. 01.1
1 II
5 E
52
81
Fig. 01.3
6
38
II
II
39 E
55 E
I
Fig. 01.4
1 Fig. 01.5
18 I
Input
O
Output
D
Serial and Encoded Com m unications
Signal Ground (SG)
C
CAN (Netw ork)
S
SCP Netw ork
Fig. 02.1
BK LF2BL
V ARIAN T: AJ26 N / A V ehicles V IN RAN GE: 024687 DATE OF ISSU E: FEBRU ARY 1998
➞
BK
RG LF57-4
LF57-3
B
FUEL TANK
BK LF57-2
BTS50
BT55-3
2–30 BAR
LF57-1
YW LF40-11
LF12-1
B
NOT USED
WU
YW
OG
UB LF57-5
LF40-9
RADIATOR FAN CONTROL RELAY MODULE
BP
BR
BO
BR
BY
BR
BS
BR
BW
BR
BG
BR
BN
BR
EM2AR (EM1AR)
BR
WU
BU
FUEL INJECTION RELAY
UW BT55-4
UB LF3-6
LF2AR
B
B BT55-1
P LF9-1
PIS2
B
2
II
NOT USED
B
BR PI2-5
9A II
AJ26 SC ROW Engine M anagement: Part 1 HO2S KS
EM10-5
NO
75A
EM10-9 E
WO
7 II
B
GB
AC24-4
O
B+ EM14-3
US
AC24-1
EM11-7
WR
40
US
US
FCS35
AC13-3
US
I
EM11-8
I
EM11-9
I
EM11-10
I
EM11-11
O
EM11-12
I
EM11-13
EM1-8 EM10-10
EM11-14
BRAKE SWITCH
I
EM11-15
I
EM11-16
RG UW UY G U BG BY BG R K
PI1-6 EM1-9
EMS2
UW
EM1-4
PI1 -17
-18
PI1 -19
-20
44
E
E
PI1 -5
BG BG RG UW
PIS1
EM24 -2
RH1-9
RH1-8
UW EM12-1
EM10-14
EM12-2 EM12-3
PARKING BRAKE SWITCH
EM12-4
D
EM12-12
I
EM12-13
I
EM12-14
I
EM12-15
EM10-6
EM12-16 D
EM12-17
EM10-12 D
EM12-18
O
EM12-19
EM10-13
EM12-22
EMS8
I
EMS CONTROL RELAY (CIRCUIT CONTINUED)
EM13-4
PK
01.1
O EM10-16
SECURITY ACKNOWLEDGE
03.2
CAN
19.1
CAN
19.1
Y
D EM10-17
G
C– EM10-25
Y
C+ EM10-26
CAN
19.1
CAN
19.1
G
C–
O
EM13-11
O
EM13-12
O
EM13-13
I
EM13-17
I
EM13-18
I
EM13-19
I
EM13-20
I
EM13-27
I
EM13-28
EM10-27
EM13-29
Y
19.1
ENGINE CRANK
03.2
P
D EM11-3
GO
I EM11-6
ECM PROGRAMMING
W
19.1
D EM13-2
GY EM16
NG
78
3
GY
GY EMS20
WP
53
1
B+ EM14-1
5
B+ EM14-2
GR
2
E
BRD EMS3
PI1 -50 -49
O
I
EM14-4
O
EM14-5
O
EM14-6
I
EM14-7
I
EM14-8
I
EM14-9
I
EM14-10
O
EM14-11
O
EM14-12
O
EM15-1
O
EM15-2
O
EM15-3
I
EM15-11
I
EM15-12
I
EM15-22
1
6
R G
BK R R B B B B G G
7
51
Fig. 01.2
1 II
5 E
52
81
Fig. 01.3
38
II
II
39 E
55 E
-1
43
E
E
PI33 -2
EL2-2
EL3-2
1
2
EL2-1
EL3-1
PI33 -1
PI42 -5
PI42 -3
PI42 -1
PI42 -4
PI42 -2
PI6 -3
-4 -1
-2
VACUUM SWITCHING VALVES 3
EMS18
PS PU PN B B B
EL1-4
BK
EMS38 EM1BR (EM2BR)
B
EMS37 EM1AL (EM2AL)
B
EMS36 EM1AR (EM2AR)
I
Fig. 01.4
1 Fig. 01.5
PI1 -3 -4
PI2-6
EL1-2
6
R G
PI2-7
42
EMS19
ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (CONTINUED Fig. 04.8)
Fig. 01.1
-14
-12
PIS9
EM13-14
THROTTLE MOTOR POWER RELAY
-51
EMS9
C+ EM10-28
ECM PROGRAMMING
OK PW RW PY N S Y B BG P O
G
EM10-15
U BRD UW BG
G
05.2
UW
PARK, NEUTRAL (CIRCUIT CONTINUED)
BG
O
19.1
UW
SERIAL COMMUNICATION
O
BY
K
19.1
EL4 -1
PEDAL POSITION
-2
MECHANICAL GUARD
TPS
B
SERIAL COMMUNICATION
R
O
03.2
EM12-7
I
18 I
PW RW PY
EL1-5
THROTTLE MOTOR
PEDAL POSITION AND MECHANICAL GUARD SENSORS
B
OK TO START
I
EMS31
EL1-3
THROTTLE ASSEMBLY
B
EM2-13
YU YG YN YR UP UP GY G R N U BY BY BP
WR
FC19
I
K BRD
OU
WR
OU
EM2AR (EM1AR)
Input
O
Output
D
Serial and Encoded Com m unications
Signal Ground (SG)
C
CAN (Netw ork)
S
SCP Netw ork
Fig. 02.1
V ARIAN T: AJ26 SC ROW V ehicles V IN RAN GE: 024687 DATE OF ISSU E: FEBRU ARY 1998
➞
-1
-1
UP
-1
RH1-10
EM1-10
EMS1
EM22 -2
PI41 -2
BG BG BG
UY
PI1 -22 -23 -21
N
PI1 -25 -26 -24
NOT USED
BT5 -1 -2 -3
BT2 -4 -5 -3
LF40-5
51 OK
50
-2
OK
-4 -1
-2
WP
EM23 -3
B
W B
U
B -2
BRD PS
UY
R
N
BRD
S
BRD
P
Y
BRD
O
B BRD -57
BRD
PN
YU YG YN YR
BG BG BG
B+
-31
S
EM10-23
PI1 -56 -54 -52
BRD
I
-4 -1
E
P
EM10-22
E
Y
I
BG UW B BK
48A
BRD
EM10-21
E
W B
EM21 -3
LF52 -1
NOT USED
BY BY GY
II
B+
EM10-20
O
49
O
WK
36
O
E
UP
B+ EM10-1
E
BY BY
LF3 -8
54A 54B
B BRD
PI1 -8 -9 -10 -7
WR
NOT USED
G
-2
PIS10
WP
-2 PI27 -1
U
W
R
W
-2 PI26 -1
-1
BRD PU
-3
R
W
-2 PI17 -1
PI4 -2
BG
PI15 -1
S
W
S
-3
UP
WP
-4
PI35 -5 -2 -1
BG
-1
BY GY WU
LF58 -2
PN
-5
WP
-2
WP
YU YG YN YR
PI34 -4 -1 -6 -3
E
υ
λ
NOT USED
EM2AL (EMIAL)
39
λ
PI1 -15
UP
υ
υ EMS43
IATS 2
B
B
EM64-1
B
HO2S
A
BG
A
ECTS
BRD
IATS
KS
N
EM64-2
CKPS
BRD
B
E
CMPS
U
WY
55
MAFS
BG RG UW
EVAPP
BG RG UW
ECM AND TCM COOLING FAN
Fig. 04.4
AJ26 SC ROW Engine M anagement: Part 1
WU
XK8 Range 1998
AJ26 SC ROW Engine M anagement: Part 2 CRUISE CONTROL SWITCH
WG
BT2 -6
TRUNK FUSE BOX
EM11-1
I
EM11-4
I
EM11-5
I
EM12-5
I
EM12-6
I
EM12-8
I
EM12-9
O
EM12-10
O
EM13-1
O
EM13-3
GP
-1
KW
EM3 -6
RH2 -15
SP
EM3 -3
SR SW1 -4
SC3-4
EM3-2
SW2-4
BO 430 Ω
SW3-3
UB
2
1
WP
81 52
IGNITION COIL RELAY
PI1-53
SW3-4
PW PIS5
680 Ω
EM3 -4
CASSETTE
SG
SG
SG SW1 -3
SC3-3
EM3-2
SW2-3
BO 430 Ω
SW3-1
SW3-2
SWS1
EM31 PI1-40
PI1-42
PI1-41
PI1-39
PI1-46
PI1-45
PI1-44
PI1-43
PW PW
BO SW1 -6
SC3-12 FCS48
KN
SR WU SG
SW2-6
CRUISE CONTROL SWITCHES
KW BK
STEERING WHEEL
CAUTION: The steering wheel contains two logic ground circuits that must remain separate. Do not connect or cross-switch the BO and BK circuits.
FC3BL EM2 -9
BO
EM27 -8
EM27 -7
IGNITION MODULE 1
EM2 -15
EM27 -12
1A
2B
EM27 EM27 -11 -10
3B
EM29 -8
EM29 -11
4A
EM27 EM27 EM27 EM27 EM27 EM27 -9 -1 -2 -3 -6 -5
EM29 -7
1B EM29 -9
GP
BO
GO
CASSETTE
WU YW SLG SG RY
NW
EMS22
PW
PI25-2
PW
GO
GU
-1
2A
WB
5
3
RY
1
2
NW
72A
B
EM29 EM29 -12 -10
3A
4B
INTERCOOLER PUMP RELAY
IGNITION MODULE 2 WB
EM29 EM29 EM29 EM29 EM29 -1 -2 -5 -3 -6
B
EM75-2
LGY
I
PI20-2
LGO
EM10-11
-1
LGW
I
PI19-2
GR
EM10-4
-1
PI22-2
LGP
I
-1
GB
EM10-3
PI21-2
GW
I
-1
PI24-2
GK
EM10-2
RH1 -11
PG WU
BT2 -15
SR
LGU
O
KN UG ULG UN PG
3
680 Ω
SR
BT11-10
FUEL PUMP RELAY (#4)
5
CASSETTE
KN
2
-1
LGK
1
II
PI23-2
LGR
26
-1
PW
PI18-2
BT11-1
#7 20A
EM26
PW
E
NY
5
4B
II
GU
3
3A
12
FC63 -8
GR
FC63 -9
BRAKE CANCEL SWITCH 1
2A
PW
WU
FCS71
AC13-16
GB
WU
AC24-3
1B
PW
WU
AC24-2
GW
PG AC13-15
FC63 -7
PW
PG
4A
510 Ω
GK
KW
1
II
270 Ω
PW
2
SP
GS
WG
24A
UW
5
3B
GS
67A
3
FC63 -10
2B
LGS
NW
RLG
10.2
DIMMER OVERRIDE BT51
IGNITION COILS 1A
PW
FUEL PUMP 2 RELAY
Fig. 04.5
AJ26 SC ROW Engine M anagement: Part 2
PW
XK8 Range 1998
EM75-1
INTERCOOLER PUMP
B B
EM13-32 EM13-33
O
EM13-34
O
EM15-4
O
EM15-5
O
EM15-6
O
EM15-7
O
EM15-15
O
EM15-16
O
EM15-17
O
EM15-18
W
PI1-32
PI1-33
BN
BU
BR
BR
PI1-34
PI1-35
PI1-36
PI1-37
PI1-38
WU
1
2
IJ2-1
LF9-8
LF9-5
LF9-3
OY
45
NG
IJS1
-1
BR
IJ1-3
IJ4-2
-1
IJ1-4
IJ5-2
-1
IJ1-5
IJ6-2
IJ2-2
-1
IJ7-2
-1
IJ2-3
IJ8-2
-1
IJ2-4
RLG
IJ9-2
-1
IJ10-2
OG
-1
UB
UB NLG
LF12-2
WU
69
WU
1A
2A
3A
4A
1B
2B
3B
LF13-2
LH RADIATOR FAN
Fig. 01.3
38
II
II
39 E
55 E
I
Fig. 01.4
1 Fig. 01.5
18 I
Input
O
Output
D
Serial and Encoded Com m unications
Signal Ground (SG)
C
CAN (Netw ork)
S
SCP Netw ork
Fig. 02.1
20 BAR
12 BAR
YW
LF2BL
REFRIGERANT 4-WAY PRESSURE SWITCH LF2AL
V ARIAN T: AJ26 SC ROW V ehicles V IN RAN GE: 024687 DATE OF ISSU E: FEBRU ARY 1998
➞
BK
RG LF57-4
LF57-3
LF13-1
FUEL INJECTORS NOTE: ECM power supplies and grounds shown on Fig. 04.7.
BK LF57-2
WU
B
OY
4B
BK
LF57-1
YW
YW
2–30 BAR
UB LF57-5
LF3-6
LF40-11
6
B
P
RADIATOR FAN CONTROL RELAY MODULE
RH RADIATOR FAN
81
54
PI36-1
IJ2-5
B
52
WP
77
AIR CONDITIONING COMPRESSOR CLUTCH RELAY
LF40-9
Fig. 01.2
1
AIR CONDITIONING COMPRESSOR CLUTCH
LF12-1
51
RY
2
LF2AR IJ1-2
EM2AR (EM1AR)
IJ3-2
7
NLG
PI1-13
BTS50
Fig. 01.1
3
70
BT2AL
E
AIR CONDITIONING CONTROL MODULE
E
RLG
BT55-3
5
I
E
B
IJS2
FUEL PUMP 2
II
I
AC1-1
5
BR IJ1-1
FUEL INJECTION RELAY
BT55-4
1
O
AC4-17
RLG
LF9-1
BR
EMS31
B
6
AC4-9
WU
B
B
II
UW
LF9-9
BR
BN
WK
BR PIS2
PI2-5
BT55-1
1
O
LF9-7 5
BR
3
BU
NY
76 37
FUEL TANK
AC12-14
I
AC3-1
EMS26
LF9-2
EM5
B
AC12-12
AC4-7
EM25
PI1-30
FUEL PUMP 1
AC12-19
UG ULG UN UB RLG
AC12-13
OG
ENGINE CONTROL MODULE BT55-2
AC13-9
NOTE: Refer to Fig. 07.1 and Fig. 07.2 for complete A/C circuits.
BO BY BW BU BP BG BN BS
NY
EM2-14
UG ULG UN UB RLG
EM2-6
BP
O
RLG
BP
O
EM1-3
BR
EM13-31
BO
EM13-26
O
EM2-12
BO
O
EM1-13
BR
EM13-25
BY
EM13-24
O
BY
O
LF40-7
BR
EM13-23
BS
O
LF40-6
BS
EM13-22
BR
EM13-16
O
BW
O
EM2AR (EM1AR)
W WU
BW
EM13-15
BR
O
BG
EM13-10
BG
EM13-9
O
EMS31
B
BR
O
KN SP KW RY W WU UB LGK LGO LGW LGU LGY LGR LGS LGP
9A II
XK8 Range 1998
AJ26 N/A Automatic Transmission
Fig. 05.1
AJ26 N/ A Automatic Transmission
NOTE: Gear Selector Illumination Module – CAN ‘Listen only’ node for gear selector position indicators. TRANSMISSION ROTARY SWITCH
TRANSMISSION FLUID TEMPERATURE SENSOR
TURBINE SPEED SENSOR
PRESSURE REGULATORS
SOLENOID VALVES
L1
OUTPUT SPEED SENSOR
L2
L3
GEAR SELECTOR ILLUMINATION MODULE
L4
P, N
υ 2
3
4
5
1
2
–
3
EM46 -6
EM46 -5
EM46 EM46 -13 -14
EM46 EM46 EM46 EM46 EM46 EM46 -16 -2 -3 -7 -11 -15
EM46 EM46 EM46 EM46 -12 -8 -9 -4
EM46 -1
EM46 -10
S
RB
Y
W
N
+
G
BU
UY
RU OG
OU
OR
OK
OB
RY
YB
YP
YU
U
EM47 EM47 EM47 EM47 EM47 -E -A -B -C -D
+
BY NO
B+ EM7-26
WB
27 II
II
CAN
19.1
CAN
19.1
B+ EM7-55
G
C– EM7-82
Y G
19.1
C– EM7-85
CAN
Y
19.1
EM7-1
O
EM7-2
Y
W
O
EM7-4
O
EM7-5
I
EM7-6
I
EM7-8
I
EM7-9
I
EM7-12
I
EM7-13
RP US
I
EM7-14
N
EM7-15 EM7-16
BRD U
EM7-18
BS
C+ EM7-86
I
EM7-21 I
EM7-22
I
EM7-23
O
EM7-28
WR
BK
G
BY
EMS25
EM7-30
O
EM7-32
03.1
04.1
04.2
04.4
O
EM7-33
I
EM7-34
I
EM7-36
I
EM7-37
S Y
I
EM7-42
G
US
US
US
EM1-17
BY
FC83-1
BY FCS62
FC83-3
BY
AC12-11
NOTE: Circuit deleted VIN 024687 ➞.
KICKDOWN SWITCH (LHD)
BS
BS EM1-16
BS
BY BY
AC27
AC28
AC29
AC30
ACS12
ACS11
AC12-15
YU YP B
EM7-52
O
EM7-53
FC35 -7
R RG OB RY RU
560 Ω
6
7
51
Fig. 01.2
Fig. 01.1
FC35 -9
10Κ Ω
1 II
5 E
52
81
Fig. 01.3
38
II
II
39 E
55 E
I
Fig. 01.4 1 Fig. 01.5
18 I
Input
O
Output
D
Serial and Encoded Com m unications
Signal Ground (SG)
C
CAN (Netw ork)
S
SCP Netw ork
Fig. 02.1
II
RLG
10.2
DIMMER OVERRIDE
10Κ Ω
BK FC35 -2
FC35 -1
MODE SWITCH
6
20
FC35 -10
EM2AL (EM1AL)
1
WR FC35 -8
RG EM3-14
EMS43
MODE STATE
RP EM3-13
B
560 Ω
RS
RS
RG
TRANSMISSION CONTROL MODULE
BY
KICKDOWN SWITCH (RHD)
RP O
PARK, NEUTRAL (CIRCUIT CONTINUED)
04.5
D–4 SWITCH
EM3-11
EM7-51
CAN
BY
BS
O
19.1
EM1-18
BY OR YB
EM7-29
EM7-45
CAN
E
BU UY BRD
O
EM7-44
19.1
41
OK OG B RB W
O
I
CAN
FCS47
BS
I
19.1
BK
FC88 -6
G
CAN
FC3BR
C+ EM7-83
CAN
RB
FC88 -9
19.1
OU RS
O
B+ EM7-54
WB
28
S
Y
C
330 Ω
2
75
FC88 -8
330 Ω
3
EM47 EM47 -J -K
G
C
330 Ω
R
Y
C FC88 -4
–
G 4
N
G FC88 -3
330 Ω
D
B
II
C
330 Ω
N
19
FC88 -1
330 Ω
R
1
WR
B+
330 Ω
P
V ARIAN T: AJ26 N / A V ehicles V IN RAN GE: 018108 DATE OF ISSU E: FEBRU ARY 1998
➞
BK FCS47
FC3BR
XK8 Range 1998
AJ26 SC Automatic Transmission
Fig. 05.2
AJ26 SC Automatic Transmission
NOTE: Gear Selector Illumination Module – CAN “listen only” node for gear selector position indicators. NOTE: n2 and n3 are internal gear ratio speed sensors. TRANSMISSION
DUAL LINEAR SWITCH
O
B+
O
I
O
O
NOTE: Pressure regulators: MD – modulation pressure SD – shift pressure
O
n3 SPEED SENSOR
n2 SPEED SENSOR
O
FLUID TEMPERATURE SENSOR
SOLENOID VALVES
GEAR SELECTOR ILLUMINATION MODULE
PRESSURE REGULATORS
P
R FC100
RU
-4
-5
G
WR
-3
-2
-7
-6
-8
-1
SWITCH (NOT USED) OPEN – P, N
N
υ
B LGB LGU LGP LGN
A B 1-2,4-5 2-3
C 3-4
TCC
MD
SD
D
4
PARK, NEUTRAL
RU
03.2
PARK, NEUTRAL (CIRCUIT CONTINUED)
04.7
GB1 -7
GB1 -3
GB1 -1
GB1 -12
GB1 -4
GB1 -6
GB1 -13
GB1 -8
GB1 -9
GB1 -11
GB1 -2
GB1 -10
3
G
03.2
B
EM1-11
B
B
B
B
B
B
B
B
B
B
B
2
19 II
FC88 -1
330 Ω –
G
C FC88 -3
330 Ω +
C FC88 -4
330 Ω –
C FC88 -8
330 Ω +
C
Y G Y
FC88 -9
330 Ω
FC88 -6
19.1
CAN
19.1
CAN
19.1
CAN
19.1
CAN
BK
BK
330 Ω
WR
20A
WR
B+
330 Ω
FCS47
II FC3BR EM2 -2
EM1 -17
EM1 -18
EM3 -13
GB2 -7
EM3 -14
B LGB LGU LGP LGN
26A
WB
II
CAN
19.1
CAN
19.1
B+ EM73-29
G
C– EM72-L
Y
C+
I
EM73-2
I
EM73-3
I
EM73-25
I
EM73-26
I
EM73-27
I
EM73-28
I
EM73-30
BS RS LGB LGU LGP LGN B
BU
GB2 -3
GB2 -1
G
U
GB2 -12
GB2 -4
BY
UY
GB2 -6
RY
GB2 -5
GB2 -8
YB
YP
GB2 -9
YU
GB2 -11
GB2 -2
OG
OK
BS
GB2 -10
OB BS
EM1-16
BK
AC12-15
AC25-1
EMS43
O
EM72-13
O
EM72-14
O
EM72-15
O
EM72-16
O
EM72-17
O
EM72-33
I
EM72-34
I
EM72-35
O
EM72-36
O
EM72-37
O
EM72-38
G BU YB YU YP OG
FC35 -9
EM3-11
WR
7
51
Fig. 01.2
Fig. 01.1 1 II
5 E
52
81
Fig. 01.3
270 Ω
BK MODE STATE
BY UY U OK OB RY
MODE SWITCH
B
6
38
II
II
39 E
II
FC35 -10
EM2AL (EM1AL)
6
20
FC35 -8
510 Ω
RLG
TRANSMISSION CONTROL MODULE
1
BK FCS48
FC3BL
1000 Ω
RS EM72-12
BK AC12-11
KICKDOWN SWITCH
EM72-H
I
AC25-2
55 E
I
Fig. 01.4 1 Fig. 01.5
18 I
Input
O
Output
D
Serial and Encoded Com m unications
Signal Ground (SG)
C
CAN (Netw ork)
S
SCP Netw ork
Fig. 02.1
V ARIAN T: AJ26 SC V ehicles V IN RAN GE: 024687 DATE OF ISSU E: FEBRU ARY 1998
➞
FC35 -1
10.2
DIMMER OVERRIDE
BK FCS47
FC3BR
XK8 Range 1998
Gearshift Interlock
Gearshift Interlock
NOTE: Circuit deleted VIN 024687 ➞.
BRAKE SWITCH (LHD) WO
6 II
B
US
GB
AC26-4
AC26-1 ACS16
US
US
US FCS35
AC13-3
WO
7 II
B
I EM10-10
Y
US
GB
AC24-4
US EM1-8
C +
EM1-6
AC24-1
EM10-28
G
BRAKE SWITCH (RHD)
C –
EM1-7
EM10-27
ENGINE CONTROL MODULE
Y
C + FC88-4
G
C – FC88-3
Y
C + FC88-9
G
C – FC88-8
GEAR SELECTOR ILLUMINATION MODULE
Y
C + FC25-24
G
C – FC25-47 –
U
U
S
FCS11
FC25-20 +
S
S
S
FCS12
FC25-19
19.1
SCP
19.1
SCP
MAJOR INSTRUMENT PACK
15
NB
B+ (LOGIC) FC14-80
19
NY
B+ (SOLENOIDS) FC14-104 –
U
S FC14-84
5
WO
I
II
16
+
S
S
FC14-15
WN
FC14-85
I
I
OG
OG
O
FC14-32
RW
O FC14-51
BK FCS47
BK
SB
FC87-3
SB
FC86 -2
FCS46
FC2BR (FC4BR)
GEARSHIFT INTERLOCK SOLENOID
GEARSHIFT INTERLOCK CONTROL
BK
B
B FC86 -1
FC14-48
RW
B
SC1-1
B SC1-2
B FCS49
I
FC87-1
FC14-58
NOT-IN-PARK MICROSWITCH
KEYLOCK SOLENOID
FC4BR (FC2BR)
POWER
COLUMN SWITCHGEAR
FC3BR LOGIC
BODY PROCESSOR MODULE
1
6
7
51
Fig. 01.2
Fig. 01.1 1 II
5 E
52
81
Fig. 01.3
6
38
II
II
39 E
55 E
I
Fig. 01.4 1 Fig. 01.5
18 I
Input
O
Output
D
Serial and Encoded Com m unications
Signal Ground (SG)
C
CAN (Netw ork)
S
SCP Netw ork
Fig. 02.1
V ARIAN T: All V ehicles V IN RAN GE: 018108 DATE OF ISSU E: FEBRU ARY 1998
➞
Fig. 05.3
XK8 Range 1998
Anti-Lock Braking; Traction Control
Anti-Lock Braking; Traction Control
BRAKE FLUID RESERVOIR
72
NR
B+
34
LF37-1
WU
II
UO EM37-2
LF40-1
EM37-1
B+ LF37-20
71
UO
O
LF37-9
UB
I
NY LF37-25
UB LF40-2
LF37-13
B+
S
I
S
LF37-3 CAN
19.1
CAN
19.1
Y
C +
G
LF37-5
G
LF37-4
G
RH FRONT WHEEL SPEED SENSOR
FR1-2
LF42-2
FR1-1
LF42-1
C – LF37-15
NOTE: Circuit deleted VIN 024687 ➞.
BRAKE SWITCH (LHD)
6
WO
II
B
NOT USED LF1-13
C +
NOT USED LF37-10
C –
Y O
I
UP
Y LF60-5
LF37-6
O LF60-4
LF37-7
Y RH1-16
Y BT2-11
O RH1-15
O BT2-10
US
US
US FCS35
AC13-3
II
RR1-2
BT73-2
LF37-19
US LF60-1
I LF37-2
W
I
W
LF37-17
WO
RH REAR WHEEL SPEED SENSOR
RR1-1
O
AC26-1 ACS16
7
Y BT73-1
US
GB
AC26-4
NOT USED LF37-11
B
US
GB
AC24-4
R
AC24-1
LH FRONT WHEEL SPEED SENSOR
FL1-2
LF41-2
R
LF37-18
FL1-1
LF41-1
BRAKE SWITCH (RHD)
P
I
16
NR
RY FC55-9
STABILITY / TRACTION STATE
FC55-11
RY LF60-6
LF37-16
U
B FCS49
R FC55-16
FC55-12
R LF60-7
6
7
51
Fig. 01.2
Fig. 01.1 1 II
5 E
52
81
Fig. 01.3
6
38
II
II
39 E
55 E
LH REAR WHEEL SPEED SENSOR
BT72-1
RL1-1
B
ABS / TRACTION CONTROL CONTROL MODULE
I
Fig. 01.4 1 Fig. 01.5
BT2-13
RL1-2
U
LF37-24
CENTER CONSOLE SWITCH PACK
1
U
U RH1-18
P BT72-2
B
I
STABILITY / TRACTION CONTROL SWITCH
FC4BR (FC2BR)
P BT2-12
LF37-8
I LF37-14
P RH1-17
U LF60-3
LF37-22
I
B
P LF60-2
LF37-21
O
18 I
LF3AS
Input
O
Output
D
Serial and Encoded Com m unications
Signal Ground (SG)
C
CAN (Netw ork)
S
SCP Netw ork
Fig. 02.1
V ARIAN T: All V ehicles V IN RAN GE: 018108 DATE OF ISSU E: FEBRU ARY 1998
➞
Fig. 06.1
XK8 Range 1998
Climate Control: Part 1 AMBIENT TEMPERATURE SENSOR
ASPIRATOR ASSEMBLY IN-CAR TEMPERATURE SENSOR
SOLAR SENSOR
VENT ASSEMBLY
ASPIRATOR MOTOR
VENT SERVO
Fig. 07.1
Climate Control: Part 1
EVAPORATOR / HEATER MATRIX ASSEMBLY
DEFROST SERVO
EVAPORATOR TEMPERATURE SENSOR
HEATER MATRIX TEMPERATURE SENSOR
COOL AIR BYPASS SERVO
LH BLOWER AIR INTAKE
RH BLOWER AIR INTAKE
FRESH / RECIRCULATION SERVO
FRESH / RECIRCULATION SERVO
FOOT WELL SERVO
υ υ
NOTES: When the ignition switched ground input is interrupted during engine cranking, the A/CCM does not drive high power consuming components. The A/C Isolate Relay remains energized by the A/CCM for 30 seconds after the ignition is switched OFF to provide power for the A/CCM to ‘park’ the servos.
υ BW
OY
LF29 -2
LF29 -1
BW
UB
LGW
B
BW
OY
BW
RG
PR
SR
OR
RY
RU
P
P
O
KU
UG
BW
SU
UO
GU
UY UW
UR
P
FC12 -1
FC12 -2
FC12 -3
FC12 -4
LF60 -11
LF60 -10
FC44 -2
FC44 -3
FC44 -5
FC44 -4
FC44 -6
FC44 -8
FC44 -7
FC44 -9
FC52 -1
FC52 -2
AC7 -1
AC7 -10
AC7 -2
AC7 -3
AC7 -5
AC7 -4
AC7 -6
AC7 -8
AC7 -7
AC7 -9
BW
UB
LGW
BW
OY
BW
RG
PR
SR
OR
RY
RU
P
P
OP
KU
UG
BW
SU
UO
GU
UY UW
UR
P
AC15 -5
AC15 -12
AC15 -14
AC15 -13
AC15 -15
AC15 -17
AC15 -16
OY
RG
PR
SR
OR
RY
RU
AC15 -9
UB
AC12 -18
LGW
II
AC4-1
WN
17
WN
I
I AC4-3
NY
40
NY
B+ AC4-5
FC24
NY
41
4
3
5
2
1
GY
GY AC13-12
B
B
GW
FC4BR (FC2BR)
AC4-2
GW AC15-8
FCS49
B+
O AC4-15
AIR CONDITIONING ISOLATE RELAY
ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE (CIRCUIT CONTINUED) ENGINE SPEED (CIRCUIT CONTINUED) VEHICLE SPEED (CIRCUIT CONTINUED)
SG
SG
08.1
AC12-10
08.1
AC12-8
OU
08.1
19.1
SERIAL COMMUNICATION
19.1
O
AC1-7
O
AC1-8
O
AC1-9
O
AC1-12
O
AC1-13
O
AC1-19
O
AC1-20
O
AC1-21
O
AC1-22
O
AC1-25
O
AC1-26
I
AC2-1
I
AC2-2
I
AC2-3
I
AC2-5
I
AC2-10
I
AC2-11
I
I
AC2-13
I
O
AC3-2
D
AC3-3
I
AC3-5
I
AC3-6
AC4-6
OU AC12-9
SERIAL COMMUNICATION
AC1-6
AC5 -2
AC5 -6
AC5 -12
AC5 -7
P BW
YG
PY
Y
AC5 -1
P BW YW
RB
NR
AC6 -6
AC6 -12
AC6 -7
P BW YW
RB
NR
AC6 -1
AC6 -2
RY PR PY RB UW UO RU SR Y NR UR GU
BW AC15-11
ACS21
OP RG YW SU OR YG UY
AC2-6
PY
PY
O
Y
ACS4
BW B+
PY
P AC15-10
FCS34
WP
YG
OP FCS33
WP
P BW
AC15 -4
P
8
υ
I AC4-16
K
D AC4-10
O
D
D
AC3-7
O
AC3-8
I
AC3-11
I
AC3-12
O
AC4-4
O
AC4-8
O
AC4-12
I
AC4-13
O
AC4-14
O
AC4-18
O
AC4-19
I
AC4-20
S SG OY UG SY SR UB KU
S AC12-1
SG AC12-4
SY AC12-3
SR AC12-2
AC4-21
WU
WU P WR B B LGW BW BK
AC12-6
WR
RK
B
RLG
AC12-7
B FCS46
FC43 -7
B
AIR CONDITIONING CONTROL MODULE
FC43 -5
FC43 -6
FC43 -2
FC43 -3
FC43 -4
FC43 -1
FC43 -8
FC43 -9
B WR WU
SR
SY
SG
S
R
RG
I
D
D
I
I
I
CLOCK
DIMMER OVERRIDE
LOCATE ILLUMINATION
I B+
DATA
I B+
DATA
I
START
FC2BR (FC4BR)
FC3CS
CONTROL PANEL
1
6
7
51
Fig. 01.2
Fig. 01.1 1 II
5 E
52
81
Fig. 01.3
6
38
II
II
39 E
55 E
I
Fig. 01.4 1 Fig. 01.5
10.2
AC12-5
18 I
Input
O
Output
D
Serial and Encoded Com m unications
Signal Ground (SG)
C
CAN (Netw ork)
S
SCP Netw ork
Fig. 02.1
V ARIAN T: All V ehicles V IN RAN GE: 018108 DATE OF ISSU E: SEPTEM BER 1997
➞
10.2
DIMMER CONTROLLED LIGHTING
XK8 Range 1998
Climate Control: Part 2
Fig. 07.2
Climate Control: Part 2
EM45
NP
80
3
GK
5
B EM48-2
EM48-1
PS
2
WR
1
17 II
69
NLG
OG
LF12-2
OG LF9-2
LF12-1
W
W
RH RADIATOR FAN
WU LF9-9
LF40-6
RH WINDSHIELD HEATER
NOTE: Radiator cooling and Air Conditioning Compressor circuits are duplicated here for clarity. Refer to Fig. 04.3, Fig. 04.6 and Fig. 04.8.
45 E
LF9-8
EM1BL (EM1BS)
RH WINDSHIELD HEATER RELAY EM44
B
OY
OY
LF13-1
LF13-2
LF9-3
LF9-5
70 RLG
5
3
NLG
RY
2
1
WP
77
EM10-3 EM10-4
I
EM12-5
I
EM12-6
O
EM12-10
WR
1
EM49-2
18 II
LH WINDSHIELD HEATER
54
FC28
UG ULG UN
NS
8
3
RN
RN
5
RLG EMS26
RLG
B
PI1-13
LGR
2
WP
1
B
DD8-9
II
EM13-15
O
EM13-16
W WU EM1 -3
ULG UG
UN
UB
UB
RN
RN
DOOR MIRROR HEATER RELAY
WU
WU YW
AC13 -9
DP1-5
B
DP8-9
BK
BK
1
26
12 BAR
YW
BK
LF57-3
AC1-3
O
AC1-4
O
AC1-5
O
AC1-16
O
AC1-17
O
AC1-18
RLG
RLG EM2-6
AC12-13
9A
B
RH17
RH18
LGP
2
HEATED BACKLIGHT
BK
RH2S
HEATED BACKLIGHT RELAY (#2)
LFS25
LF57-4
NOTE: Circuit revised VIN 024687 ➞.
BT58-3
BT10-8
BK
RLG U UY PS LGR LGN RW LGP
BT13-3
II
TRUNK FUSE BOX
LF2BL
LGP
LGP
AC13-10
AC1-2
RH2-7
BT2-1
RG
II RHD
23
LHD
46
AC20
NU
3
5
UW
UW AC6-5
UY
2
1
WP
10 II
UB
RH BLOWER MOTOR RELAY
EM2-14
AC12-14 AC12-17
1
US
AC12-16
U 4
AC6-13
U I
AC2-7
O
AC2-8
I
AC2-15
O
AC2-16
O
AC3-1
I
AC4-7
O
AC4-9
I
AC4-17
B DP1-1 FC2AL (FC4AL))
UY
UY
5 #17 25A
20 BAR
WU
YW
3
1
LF57-2
REFRIGERANT 4-WAY PRESSURE SWITCH
O
B DPS1
DP8-11
PASSENGER MIRROR
LF57-1
LF40-11
AC12 -12
2–30 BAR
UB LF57-5
LF3-6
LF40-9
AC12 -19
O
FC4AL (FC2AL)
BT13-10 EM1 -13
ENGINE CONTROL MODULE
AC1-1
B DD1-1
P EM2 -12
I
B DDS1
DD8-11
DRIVER MIRROR
PS
AIR CONDITIONING COMPRESSOR CLUTCH
WU YW RY
DD1-5
7
AC15-19
PI36-1
RN
RN ACS1
AC13-4
RADIATOR FAN CONTROL RELAY MODULE
AC13-8 O
EM2BS (EM2BL)
LH WINDSHIELD HEATER RELAY
AIR CONDITIONING COMPRESSOR CLUTCH RELAY EM2-4
I
2
PS
LF2AR
I
PS
EMS24
LF9-1
EM10-2
B
GS
5
E
B
O
3
EM49-1
LF9-7
LF40-7
NG
79
EM17
WU
WU
LH RADIATOR FAN
LF2AL
NG
B
RW
B 2
AC6-8
US GO UK GP
G
GO
3
AC6-10 FC2AL
RH BLOWER MOTOR
ULG
EM2-5
LF60-18 RHD
UG UN UB
U
LHD
46 23
AC20
NW
8
10
UR
UR AC5-5
U
B
EM43-2
B
B
EM43-1
P
EMS31
Y
EM41-2
EM41-1
YW
YW LF7-2
LF3-1
RW
AIR CONDITIONING CONTROL MODULE
5
3
2
1
7
6
WP
9 II
38 II
LF5-5
HEATER VALVE
LGN
4
#15 10A
LH BLOWER MOTOR RELAY
HEATER PUMP HEATER PUMP RELAY (#1)
1
UK
4
AC5-13
ENGINE COMPARTMENT FUSE BOX
B
NOTE: A/CCM power supplies and grounds shown on Fig. 07.1.
U
B
B 2
AC5-8
GP
G AC5-10
EM2AR (EM1AR)
3
FC4AL
LH BLOWER MOTOR
1
6
7
51
Fig. 01.2
Fig. 01.1 1 II
5 E
52
81
Fig. 01.3
6
38
II
II
39 E
55 E
I
Fig. 01.4 1 Fig. 01.5
18 I
Input
O
Output
D
Serial and Encoded Com m unications
Signal Ground (SG)
C
CAN (Netw ork)
S
SCP Netw ork
Fig. 02.1
V ARIAN T: All V ehicles V IN RAN GE: 018108 DATE OF ISSU E: FEBRU ARY 1998
➞
XK8 Range 1998
Instrument Packs
RN
B+
NR
29
FC25-25
ILLUMINATION
WG
13
FC79-17
RY
O FC25-28
B+
II
B+
FC25-3
B+
FC79-8
10.2
DIMMER CONTROLLED LIGHTING
10.2
BATTERY VOLTAGE
RO
I
ILLUMINATION SUPPLY
I
DIMMER OVERRIDE
FC25-27
FC26-1
OIL PRESSURE
RLG FC26-21
RK
O
OW
O FC26-2
BATTERY VOLTAGE
SCP
19.1
SCP
19.1
BATTERY VOLTAGE
S
RG RS
O
BATTERY VOLTAGE
RB FC26-11
FC25-20
BATTERY VOLTAGE
Y
RU
O
C +
OIL PRESSURE
C –
OIL PRESSURE
C +
OIL PRESSURE
C –
OIL PRESSURE
16.1
16.2
16.3
OG FC26-18
UW
O
VEHICLE SPEED
O
ENGINE SPEED
O
ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE
I
BATTERY VOLTAGE GAUGE
I
BATTERY VOLTAGE GAUGE
I
OIL PRESSURE GAUGE
I
OIL PRESSURE GAUGE
I
OIL PRESSURE GAUGE
I
OIL PRESSURE GAUGE
FC79-9
O
FC25-48
RADIO / CASSETTE HEAD UNIT
OS FC26-17
G
19.1
BATTERY VOLTAGE GAUGE
FC79-19
O
FC25-23
CAN
OU FC26-15
Y
19.1
I
FC79-20
O
FC25-47
CAN
OB FC26-10
G
19.1
BATTERY VOLTAGE GAUGE
FC79-14
O
FC25-24
I
FC79-15
FC26-12
19.1
OIL PRESSURE WARNING
FC79-12
O
S –
I
FC79-13
FC26-9
FC25-19
U
BATTERY CHARGE WARNING
FC79-18
O
S +
I FC79-11
FC26-8
CAN
ILLUMINATION SUPPLY
FC25-2
DIMMER CONTROLLED LIGHTING
CAN
Fig. 08.1
Instrument Packs
FC79-10
FC26-20
A/CCM
PY
07.1
FC26-3
A/CCM
SG
07.1
FC26-4
A/CCM
OU
07.1
O
VEHICLE SPEED
O
VEHICLE SPEED
O
VEHICLE SPEED
BK
FC26-5
POWER ASSISTED STEERING CONTROL MODULE
11.1
ADAPTIVE DAMPING CONTROL MODULE
11.5
ADAPTIVE DAMPING CONTROL MODULE
11.5
(CIRCUITS CONTINUED)
BK FCS48
I FC79-16
FC3BL
UB
MINOR INSTRUMENT PACK
FC26-6
ON FC26-7
TRIP SELECT
SO
I
ADAPTIVE DAMPING WARNING
I
CHARGE WARNING
UY
I FC25-13
FC27-7
A/B (TRIP SELECT)
FC27-9
000 (RESET)
FC25-6
GENERATOR
03.2
SW
03.1
RESET
AIRBAG / SRS CONTROL MODULE
FC25-36
YW
17.1
I
BR
AIRBAG WARNING FC25-33
FC26-16
UR
NOTE: Circuit deleted VIN 024687 ➞. EM2-16
1 ΚΩ
FUEL LEVEL SENSOR
900Ω
RW 80Ω
F
E
BT2-18
BT7
MESSAGE
FC25-35
RW RH1-14
FC27-2
Y
I
FC26-24
RW
O
I
FC26-22
IMPERIAL; METRIC; U.S.A.
O
FC27-8
CLEAR
R
I FC25-14
FC27-1
MI / KM
FC26-14
TRIP COMPUTER SWITCH PACK
BT8
BW
BW BT2-17
BW RH1-13
I
FUEL LEVEL GAUGE
FC26-13
TRIP CYCLE
SU
I
P
FC25-10
OS CLOSES WITH PRESSURE
PI40-1
EM2-8
BK
BK SCS1
BK SC2-9
BK FCS48
TRIP CYCLE SWITCH
OS
OS PI1-48
SU SC2-5
I
OIL PRESSURE (ON / OFF)
FC3BL
FC26-19
COLUMN SWITCHGEAR
OIL PRESSURE SWITCH BK
BK
I
FCS48
FC25-1
BK
BK EMS38
OP EM55-1
OP
EM55-2
EM1-19
I FC26-23
LOW COOLANT WARNING
B
I
B FCS49
FC25-26
COOLANT LEVEL SWITCH
EM1BR (EM2BR)
FC4BR (FC2BR)
FC3BL
MAJOR INSTRUMENT PACK
1
6
7
51
Fig. 01.2
Fig. 01.1 1 II
5 E
52
81
Fig. 01.3
6
38
II
II
39 E
55 E
I
Fig. 01.4 1 Fig. 01.5
18 I
Input
O
Output
D
Serial and Encoded Com m unications
Signal Ground (SG)
C
CAN (Netw ork)
S
SCP Netw ork
Fig. 02.1
V ARIAN T: All V ehicles V IN RAN GE: 018108 DATE OF ISSU E: FEBRU ARY 1998
➞
XK8 Range 1998
Audible Warnings
NB
15
Audible Warnings
B+ FC14-80
NY
19
B+ FC14-104
RW
1
I FC14-41
SCP SOURCES: • DIRECTION INDICATORS; HAZARD WARNING; SIDE LAMPS – Fig. 09.1, Fig. 09.2 • VALET SWITCH; TRUNK RELEASE – Fig. 13.1 • MEMORY – Fig. 12.1 • CONVERTIBLE TOP MOVEMENT – Fig. 15.2 • KEY-IN-IGNITION SWITCH / DRIVER DOOR SWITCH – Fig. 13.1 • NOT-IN-PARK MICROSWITCH – Fig. 05.3 • SEAT BELT SWITCH – Fig. 12.1
WO
5 II
WN
16 I
SCP
I FC14-15
I FC14-32
U
19.1
AUDIBLE WARNING 1
O
AUDIBLE WARNING 2
O
GR
GR
FC14-82
SC1-10
GB
GB FC14-83
SC1-11
S – FC14-84
SCP
S
19.1
SPEAKER S +
FC14-85
COLUMN SWITCHGEAR AUDIBLE WARNING CONTROL
AUDIBLE WARNINGS: • DIRECTION INDICATORS • HAZARD WARNING • SIDE LAMPS ON • VALET MODE WARNING • GEAR SELECTOR IN PARK • MEMORY CHIME • SECURITY ARM / DISARM • CONVERTIBLE TOP MOVEMENT (CONVERTIBLE VEHICLES) • KEY-IN-IGNITION SWITCH / DRIVER DOOR AJAR (NAS VEHICLES ONLY) • SEAT BELT DISCONNECTED (NAS VEHICLES ONLY)
POWER LOGIC
BODY PROCESSOR MODULE
1
6
7
51
Fig. 01.2
Fig. 01.1 1 II
5 E
52
81
Fig. 01.3
6
38
II
II
39 E
55 E
I
Fig. 01.4 1 Fig. 01.5
18 I
Input
O
Output
D
Serial and Encoded Com m unications
Signal Ground (SG)
C
CAN (Netw ork)
S
SCP Netw ork
Fig. 02.1
V ARIAN T: All V ehicles V IN RAN GE: 018108 DATE OF ISSU E: FEBRU ARY 1998
➞
Fig. 08.2
XK8 Range 1998
Exterior Lighting: Front
Fig. 09.1
Exterior Lighting: Front
UB
SCP SCP
NOTE: ‘Crank’ input used with Daytime Running Lamps.
U
19.1
LF5-4
#19 10A
LF7-10
UW
5
1
4
S
19.1
3
4
#21 10A
UG
2 LF5-7
UY 15
MAIN BEAM RELAY (#3)
NB
B+ FC14-80
–
S
+
S
U
49
FCS11
FC25-20
1
FCS12
FC25-19
1
4
RW
LF6-8
#6 10A
LF6-4
UK
5
B+ FC14-79
S
3
4
NG
#8 10A
US
2 LF6-9
I
OB
FC14-41
5
WO
II
LIGHTING INDICATORS
DIP BEAM RELAY (#5)
I FC14-15
3
4
LF8-3
OW
5 LF8-10
#17 15A
U S
MAJOR INSTRUMENT PACK
1
38
S –
OG
2
II
FC14-84
OB
LF5-8
LF32-1
S +
NR
OG FC55-9
OG
O
FC55-18
FRONT FOG STATE
LH FRONT FOG LAMP UB
OG FCS37
FC14-20
LF1-7
MAIN
OR
OR BK
FC55-19
REAR FOG
LF31-1
PY
PW
B
LF31-5
LF31-6 DI
PW
FC55-3
LH FRONT LAMP UNIT
O FC14-96
HAZARD STATE FC4BR (FC2BR)
LF1-2
FC14-2
I FC14-59
B FC55-16
GY
GY
O
FC55-1
HAZARD
FC3BR
LF1-10
SIDE LAMP FC55-2
FCS49
DIP
RK
FC14-53
PY B
LF31-4
LF1-6
RK
O
B
LF31-2
FC14-45
I FC14-38
BK FCS47
UG
O
FC55-17
FRONT FOG
UY
LF1-5
FC14-68 FC55-20
LF31-3
US
O
REAR FOG STATE
LF32-2
FRONT FOG RELAY (#2)
FC14-85
ENGINE COMPARTMENT FUSE BOX 16
NOTE: Circuits revised VIN 024687 ➞.
B
RB
RB
O
LF1-9
FC14-54
CENTER CONSOLE SWITCH PACK LIGHTING CONTROL
GO
GO LF1-3
FC14-27
U
U
SC2-2
HEADLAMP FLASH
I
UB
SC2-6
B
LF4-1
LF4-2
YG
R
KG
YG
YG
KG
KG
SC2-7
LF2BR
I
B
LF22-1
I
LF22-2
FC14-88
SC2-8
DIRECTION INDICATOR
LFS9
FC14-14
OW
L
B
LH SIDE DI REPEATER (ROW)
FC14-30
UB
UB HEADLAMP MAIN BEAM
LF11-2
LH SIDE MARKER (NAS ONLY) O
U
B
LF11-1
RH FRONT FOG LAMP
I FC14-61
UW LF21-3
UY
DIP REAR VIEW MIRRORS: AUTO HEADLAMPS / MIRROR TINT
YU
11.4
UY
YU
UY
SC2-4
MAIN
I
UK
FC14-42
SC2-1
B
LF21-2
BK FCS48
BK
BK SCS1
SC2-9
B
DIP
SIDE
BK
LFS9
LF21-4
DIP
RY
SIDE
RY
RY SCS2
AUTO
SC2-3
RY FCS9
I FC14-16
LF2BR
RY
RY
O
LF1-11
FC14-1
LF21-1
SIDE LAMP
LIGHTING STALK
GK
GK
O
FC3BL
LF1-1
FC14-3
B
LF21-5
LF21-6 DI
COLUMN SWITCHGEAR DIMMER MODULE: SIDE LAMPS ON
10.2
RH FRONT LAMP UNIT
RY RW
RW
O
LF1-8
FC14-28
POWER
NOTE: DI bulb failure – BPM internal function. Daytime Running Lamps – BPM programmed function.
B
LF10-1
LF10-2
RH SIDE MARKER (NAS ONLY)
LOGIC
GR
O FC14-81
GR LF1-4
GR
GR LF40-8
EL1-6
B EL5-1
EL5-2
B ELS1
B EL1-5
7
51
Fig. 01.2
1 II
5 E
52
81
Fig. 01.3
6
38
II
II
39 E
55 E
I
Fig. 01.4 1 Fig. 01.5
18 I
Input
O
Output
D
Serial and Encoded Com m unications
Signal Ground (SG)
C
CAN (Netw ork)
S
SCP Netw ork
Fig. 02.1
LFS8 LF1AL
EM2AR (EM1AR)
NOTE: ELS1 – Cruise Control vehicles only.
Fig. 01.1
LF1AL
B
RH SIDE DI REPEATER (ROW)
6
LFS8
B EMS31
BODY PROCESSOR MODULE
1
B
V ARIAN T: All V ehicles V IN RAN GE: 018108 DATE OF ISSU E: FEBRU ARY 1998
➞
XK8 Range 1998
Exterior Lighting: Rear
NOTE: BTS5 – Adaptive damping only.
US
NOTE: Circuit deleted VIN 024687 ➞.
11.5
BT11-5
BRAKE SWITCH (LHD)
ADAPTIVE DAMPING
US
UG BT11-8
#8 5A
NK
52
NK
1
B+ (REVERSE LAMPS)
3
5
SCP
19.1
U
FCS11
U
1
2
SCP
19.1
S
FCS12
BT40-16
S
S BT40-8
#19 5A
BT40-5
1
LIGHTING CONTROL
CAN
Y
19.1
FC25-19
C + FC25-24
CAN
19.1
I
BK
BTS21
FC25-20
C –
1
R
I
1
2
US FCS35
US AC13-3
3
1
RW
B
BT27-1
LH SIDE MARKER (NAS ONLY)
OB
OB
OG
2 BT10-5
BTS3
BT31-7
YW BTS9
TRUNK FUSE BOX
BT31-6
REVERSE
S –
S
MAJOR INSTRUMENT PACK
RO
B
BT31-2
S +
NB
15
UB
B+ (LOGIC)
R
FC14-80
NY
19
BULB FAILURE SENSING
O
BT31-3
B+ (LIGHTING)
NG
WG
24
B+ (LIGHTING)
RW
1
II
RK
B+
DI
UP
FC14-41 II
BT31-4
BT18-17
BT18-24
I
WO
5
GY
BT18-16
FC14-79
NOTE: ‘Crank’ input activates general bulb failure output.
STOP
RY
BT18-25
FC14-104
49
LH TAIL LAMP UNIT
BT18-14
UO
I FC14-15
RU
BT18-15
RO
NR
LH TAIL; SIDE MARKER LAMPS
FC55-18
FRONT FOG STATE
OY FC55-20
REAR FOG STATE
BT18-18
RU
BL1-1
RU
BB1-2
REAR FOG
FC55-19
RG RU
HAZARD
FC55-1
UB
LH STOP LAMP
FC14-12
BK BTS21
BTS23
BT18-20
B
GK
LIGHTING CONTROL
FC3BR
B
BL5-2
RH NUMBER PLATE LAMP
UW
RH STOP LAMP
BT18-26
BB1-1
B BL5-1
BT18-19
BK
B
BLS2
BL1-2
BT18-22
I
BLS1
BTS40
RU
FC55-17
OP
BL4-2
LH NUMBER PLATE LAMP
RW BT18-23
O FC14-44
BK
B
B
BL4-1
BT18-21
RH TAIL; NUMBER PLATE LAMPS
FRONT FOG
BT31-1
TAIL
FC14-85
FC55-2
BT27-2
BT12-2
FC14-84
FCS47
MIRROR TINT
11.4
FOG
U
BK
7 II
AC24-4
BT11-7
II
LIGHTING INDICATORS
FC55-16
WO
B
BRAKE SWITCH (RHD)
REAR FOG RELAY (#1)
16
GB AC24-1
BT10-4
5
1
26
US ACS16
BT12-10
UO
TAIL LAMP RELAY (#3)
SECURITY AND LOCKING CONTROL MODULE
BT1AR
US RH12-1
RS
#15 10A
REVERSE GEAR
US BT1-9
RY
I
BK
US BTS5
BT10-7
BT41-1
BT40-14
FC25-47
5 #21 5A
BT40-13
U
S
–
G
BK
S
S
+
3
6 II
AC26-4
RK
STOP LAMP RELAY (#5)
YW
O
US BT11-9
BT40-7
S +
BT1-11
RH12-16
1
OG
O
WO
B
BT11-4
#6 5A
S –
BT1-10
RH12-15
S
U
GB AC26-1
UP
BT40-6
U
Fig. 09.2
Exterior Lighting: Rear
BT30-4
CENTER CONSOLE SWITCH PACK
BT3S
DI BT1AR
LAMP CONTROL MODULE
UW BT30-5
YG
L
YG SC2-7
KG SC2-8
DIRECTION INDICATOR
RS
O
FC14-88
KG
R
I
RH2-16
FC14-95
I FC14-61
GY
FC14-50
BT30-7
TAIL
BT1-2
YW
GK RH2-1
FC14-76
B
BT30-6
RH2-3
GK
O
RG
BT2-9
GY
O
STOP
RS
BT1-1
BT30-2
REVERSE
OB UY
DIP REAR VIEW MIRRORS: AUTO HEADLAMPS / MIRROR TINT
11.4
YU
YU
UY SC2-4
UG
I
(CONV.)
FC14-42
SC2-1
UG
SIDE
BK
BK FCS48
BK
BK
SIDE
DIP
SCS1
SC2-9
UG BB1-3
RY
RY
SCS2
AUTO
RY SC2-3
RY
FCS9
B
UG BL1-3
BL8-1 (CONV.) RH8-2 (COUPE)
UG
B
BT30-1
FOG
BLS1
(COUPE)
(COUPE) BT1-17
I
B (CONV.)
BL8-2 (CONV.) RH8-1 (COUPE)
B
RH TAIL LAMP UNIT BL1-1
B
FC14-16
RW
RHS2
B
POWER
FC3BL
LIGHTING STALK
B
COLUMN SWITCHGEAR 10.2
BTS23
HIGH-MOUNTED STOP LAMP
RY
B
BODY PROCESSOR MODULE BT3S
1
6
7
51
Fig. 01.2
Fig. 01.1 1 II
5 E
52
81
Fig. 01.3
6
38
II
II
39 E
55 E
I
Fig. 01.4 1 Fig. 01.5
18 I
Input
O
Output
D
Serial and Encoded Com m unications
Signal Ground (SG)
C
CAN (Netw ork)
S
SCP Netw ork
Fig. 02.1
B BT26-2
B BTS17
RH SIDE MARKER (NAS ONLY)
BB1-1 RH1S
LOGIC
DIMMER MODULE: SIDE LAMPS ON
BT26-1
V ARIAN T: All V ehicles V IN RAN GE: 018108 DATE OF ISSU E: FEBRU ARY 1998
➞
BT2AR
XK8 Range 1998
Headlamp Leveling
Headlamp Leveling
WR
33 II
FC55-5
31
0
WR
II 203 Ω
1
187 Ω
GS
2
GS
FC55-6
LF34-1
GS LFS6
LF60-15
SERVO AMPLIFIER
LH HEADLAMP LEVELING ACTUATOR
LF34-2
3
BK FC55-2
BK FCS47
LEVELING SWITCH LF34-3
FC3BR
CENTER CONSOLE SWITCH PACK
B LFS9
B LF2BR
32
WR
II
LF24-1
GS
SERVO AMPLIFIER
RH HEADLAMP LEVELING ACTUATOR
LF24-2
LF24-3
B LFS8
B LF1AL
1
6
7
51
Fig. 01.2
Fig. 01.1 1 II
5 E
52
81
Fig. 01.3
6
38
II
II
39 E
55 E
I
Fig. 01.4 1 Fig. 01.5
18 I
Input
O
Output
D
Serial and Encoded Com m unications
Signal Ground (SG)
C
CAN (Netw ork)
S
SCP Netw ork
Fig. 02.1
V ARIAN T: Headlam p Leveling V ehicles V IN RAN GE: 018108 DATE OF ISSU E: SEPTEM BER 1997
➞
Fig. 09.3
XK8 Range 1998
Interior Lighting
NB
15
Fig. 10.1
Interior Lighting
B+ (LOGIC) FC14-80
NY
19
NW
B+ (LIGHTING) FC14-104
RW
1
NOTE: ‘Crank’ input is used to switch off interior lamps during engine cranking.
I
WO FC14-15
WN
UR FC4-5
19.1 19.1
SCP
FC4-4
NW
NW
S
S FCS12
S
OY DD3-10
S +
BT56-1
LH TRUNK LAMP
FC14-85
INTERIOR LIGHTING CONTROL
PW RH2-6
PW
PW BTS25
BT1-5
RY
RY BT59-2
BTS26
BT59-1
RY
BT29-1
BT29
BT29-2
AC14 -9
AC14 -8
S
U
ILLUMINATION O ENABLE
PW FC14-101
B FC33
U
– S DD10-9
I DD11-4
DD3-11
B FCS46
FC34
FC2BR (FC4BR)
GLOVE BOX LAMP
DD11-12
KEY BARREL
U ACS5
DD1-6
S
+ S
S
PW
ACS6
DD1-3
DD10-16
BT46-1
BT46-2
TRUNK SWITCH
PW FCS36
BK
RY BTS6
RH TRUNK LAMP
I
OU
UNLOCK
DD3-12
RY BT56-2
U
RH1S
B+ DD10-1
NW
B RHS2
RH3-1
PW
S – FC14-84
PW
38
B RH3-2
REAR INTERIOR LAMP (COUPE ONLY) U
LOCK
FC2BR (FC2BL)
I RH2-5
FCS11
N
FCS46 (LHD) FCS50 (RHD)
FC32-1
RH FOOT WELL LAMP
FC14-67
U
25
B
B FC32-2
IGNITION SWITCH (KEY-IN SWITCH)
FC3BL
SCP
FCS1
FC14-24
FC14-32
BK FCS48
NW
NW
FADE 1 O
I
I
BK
FC4BL (FC4BR)
I
II
16
FCS50 (LHD) FCS46 (RHD)
FC31-1
LH FOOT WELL LAMP
FC14-41
5
B
B FC31-2
PW
PW
RFS2
BK
RF1-10
RF8-1
DRIVER DOOR LOCK SWITCHES
RF8-3
LH VANITY LAMP
BK
GY DD3-6
DD3-7
I
GW
O
DD11-20
BK
PW
DD10-14
RF7-1
DOOR LAMP CONTROL
DRIVER DOOR SWITCH
RF7-3
RH VANITY LAMP BK
BK
BK DDS7
DD1-2
B
I
LOGIC
I
POWER
DD10-8
B DD1-21
DD10-17
LH MAP LAMP SWITCH
DRIVER DOOR CONTROL MODULE
FC4AR (FC2AR)
PW RF10-5
RW
FADE 2 O
LH MAP LAMP
RW
FC14-74
RF1-12
RF10-4
BK N
47
U
– S
B+ DP10-1
DP10-9
DP10-16
GY DP3-6
DP3-7
BK
DP1-21
DP1-3
RH MAP LAMP SWITCH
PRINTED CIRCUIT BOARD
DOOR LAMP CONTROL
BK
I
ROOF CONSOLE
BODY PROCESSOR MODULE
GW
LOGIC
DP10-8
B DDS1
DD14-1
B DD1-1 FC4AL (FC2AL)
DRIVER DOOR PUDDLE LAMP
POWER
DP10-17
GW
PASSENGER DOOR CONTROL MODULE
FC2AR (FC4AR)
B DD14-2
I
FC3BR
GW
O
B
B
POWER
DP10-14
DPS7
DP1-2
BK RF1-3
RH MAP LAMP
LOGIC
DP11-20
BK RFS1
S
I
PASSENGER DOOR SWITCH BK
RF10-1
DP1-6
S
+ S
BK
U
B DP14-2
DP14-1
B DPS1
B DP1-1 FC2AL (FC4AL)
PASSENGER DOOR PUDDLE LAMP
1
6
7
51
Fig. 01.2
Fig. 01.1 1 II
5 E
52
81
Fig. 01.3
6
38
II
II
39 E
55 E
I
Fig. 01.4 1 Fig. 01.5
18 I
Input
O
Output
D
Serial and Encoded Com m unications
Signal Ground (SG)
C
CAN (Netw ork)
S
SCP Netw ork
Fig. 02.1
V ARIAN T: All V ehicles V IN RAN GE: 018108 DATE OF ISSU E: SEPTEM BER 1997
➞
BK BTS21 BT1AR
XK8 Range 1998
Dimmer-Controlled Lighting MINOR INSTRUMENT PACK
Fig. 10.2
Dimmer-Controlled Lighting
MAJOR INSTRUMENT PACK
AIR CONDITIONING CONTROL PANEL
RADIO
CENTER CONSOLE SWITCH PACK
FC25 -28
FC79 -8
BK RO
FCS48
ILLUMINATION SUPPLY
FC26 -21
RO
RLG
FC25 -26
IC10 -3
B
DIMMER OVERRIDE
DIMMER OVERRIDE
DIMMER OVERRIDE
ILLUMINATION SUPPLY
FC25 -27
HAZARD
IC10 -4
RU
RLG BRD
RG
LH SEAT HEATER
RH SEAT HEATER
FOG LAMPS
TRACTION
R
B
FC55 -10
FC55 -4
FC55 -16
B
FCS49
FCS49
B
BK
IC1 -6
FC4BR (FC2BR)
FC3BL
IC1 -5
FC43 -9
FC43 -8
RLG
RK
FC43 -7
RLG
B
RK
FC4BR (FC2BR)
CE2
RLG
RU
B RLG
RLG
FCS4
SC3-8
RU NP
50
B+
O
NP
B+
O
51
WN
RU
B FC62-9
FC62-7
LOCATE
CONVERTIBLE TOP SWITCH
FC23-5
G
O
SC3-11
RK
FC23-6
B
RY
FC59
SC11-3
DIMMER OVERRIDE
RU FCS73
FC23-7
I
SC3-10
SC11-6
MODE SWITCH (TRANSMISSION)
FC23-12
Y
G
RY
FC3BR
FC23-2
O
SC3-9
SC11-5
LOCATE
FCS72
RO
O
Y
FC42-1
RK
O
B
FCS3
FC23-8
FC4BR (FC2BR)
CIGAR LIGHTER RU
B
UY
FC63-5
FC63-1
LOCATE
SC2-4
RLG
DIP
BK FCS48
BK
SC2-9
BK
SIDE
SCS1
RY
RY SCS2
OFF
FC3BL
RY SC2-3
RY FC23-4
B
COLUMN SWITCHGEAR 14.1
09.2
CRUISE CONTROL ON / OFF SWITCH
RK I
FC23-9
AC15-7
RK
B FC27-3
FC27-4
LOCATE
FC2BR (FC4BR)
RY
09.1
B FCS46
DIMMER OVERRIDE
FC63-10
I
FCS9
LIGHTING STALK
BPM: SIDE LAMPS ON
RK
DIMMER MODULE
TRIP COMPUTER SWITCH PACK B
RK DD17-4
RK DDS5
DD17-5
RK ACS7
DD1-9
RK
FC41-2
LOCATE
LOCATE
DRIVER DOOR SWITCH PACK
TRUNK AND FUEL FILL RELEASE SWITCH RK
B
B
B DDS1
DD1-1
RK DD5-1
B
B DP1-1
FC88-10
LOCATE
LOCATE
DRIVER DOOR MEMORY SWITCH PACK
GEAR SELECTOR ILLUMINATION MODULE RK
B DPS1
B FC88-5
DP17-3
RK
DP17-4
DP1-9
RK
B FC67-9
FC67-5
LOCATE
LOCATE FC2AL (FC4AL)
6
7
51
Fig. 01.2
Fig. 01.1 1 II
5 E
52
81
Fig. 01.3
6
38
II
II
39 E
55 E
I
Fig. 01.4 1 Fig. 01.5
18 I
VALET SWITCH
PASSENGER DOOR SWITCH PACK
Input
O
Output
D
Serial and Encoded Com m unications
Signal Ground (SG)
C
CAN (Netw ork)
S
SCP Netw ork
Fig. 02.1
V ARIAN T: All V ehicles V IN RAN GE: 018108 DATE OF ISSU E: SEPTEM BER 1997
➞
FCS50
FC4BL (FC2BL)
DD5-9
FC4AL (FC2AL)
B
B FC41-4
1
FCS49
LOCATE
DIMMER CONTROL
BK
BK FCS47
FC23-3
UO
SC11-4
FC35-1
I
I
UO
FC35-5
FC23-1
FC23-11
14
BK
RO
FC23-10
G
A/CCM
DIMMER OVERRIDE
FC35-10
Y
07.1
RLG
RLG SC11-2
UO
HEADLAMP LEVELING
DIMMER OVERRIDE
FC79 -16
ILLUMINATION SUPPLY
ILLUMINATION SUPPLY
LOCATE ILLUMINATION LOCATE
XK8 Range 1998
Pow er Assisted Steering
WP
11 II
VEHICLE SPEED (CIRCUIT CONTINUED)
B+
R
O
FC16-6
UB
08.1
I
R EM2-7
FC16-2
S
O
FC16-4
B
I
FC16-8
R LL1-1
LL2-1
S EM2-1
FC16-5
Pow er Assisted Steering
S LL1-2
LL2-2
POWER ASSISTED STEERING CONVERTER
B FCS49
FC4BR (FC2BR)
POWER ASSISTED STEERING CONTROL MODULE
LHD
WP
11 II
VEHICLE SPEED (CIRCUIT CONTINUED)
B+
R
O
FC16-6
UB
08.1
FC16-2
I
R EM2-7
S
O
FC16-4
FC16-5
FC16-8
S EM2-1
B
I
EM18-1
EM18-2
POWER ASSISTED STEERING CONVERTER
B FCS49
FC4BR (FC2BR)
POWER ASSISTED STEERING CONTROL MODULE
RHD
1
6
7
51
Fig. 01.2
Fig. 01.1 1 II
5 E
52
81
Fig. 01.3
6
38
II
II
39 E
55 E
I
Fig. 01.4 1 Fig. 01.5
18 I
Input
O
Output
D
Serial and Encoded Com m unications
Signal Ground (SG)
C
CAN (Netw ork)
S
SCP Netw ork
Fig. 02.1
V ARIAN T: All V ehicles V IN RAN GE: 018108 DATE OF ISSU E: SEPTEM BER 1997
➞
Fig. 11.1
XK8 Range 1998
Steering Column M ovement
STEERING COLUMN MOTORS
NB
15
B+ (LOGIC) FC14-80
NY
42
FC14-102
RW
1
Fig. 11.2
Steering Column M ovement
TILT
REACH
B+ (COLUMN MOTORS)
I FC14-41
WO
5
I
II
FC14-15
WN
16
I
I
SCP
U
19.1
FC14-32
U
FCS11
S –
WU WG
K
N
FC60 -3
FC60 -1
YK
PN
R WU WG
U
G
S
FC61 -4
FC61 -1
FC61 -8
PU
PG
BS
FC14-84
SCP
S
19.1
S
FCS12
S + FC14-85
UR
BK
BK FCS48
FC4-5
FC60 -2
I
FC4-4
WU
FC14-67
IGNITION SWITCH (KEY-IN SWITCH)
FC3BL
FC60 -5
BG
O FC14-90
WU
O
FCS17
FC14-40
BK
BK FCS47
BK
SB
SB
I
FC87-1
FC87-3
FC14-93
FC14-58
PN
O
NOT-IN-PARK MICROSWITCH
FC3BR
YK
I
FC14-99
BR
O STEERING COLUMN MOVEMENT CONTROL
FC14-100
BW
O FC14-91
270 Ω
PU
I 100 Ω
UP
470 Ω
DOWN
820 Ω
FORE
FC14-66
PG
O
NP
20
NP SC3-5
SK
SC9-1
SK SC3-6
SC9-3
FC14-78
I FC14-87
BS
O FC14-52
AFT
COLUMN MOTOR
COLUMN JOY STICK
B
B
I FC14-25
FCS46
POWER
BK
BK
BK FCS48
SC2-9
BK
YB
SCS1 SC9-7
YB
SC9-5
AUTO TILT SWITCH
I
SC3-7
LOGIC
FC14-11
FC3BL
BODY PROCESSOR MODULE
FC2BR (FC4BR)
COLUMN SWITCHGEAR N
25
B+ DD10-1
U
U
U
U ACS5
AC14-8
S
S
35
DD10-9
S
S ACS6
AC14-9
S –
DD1-8
S + DD10-16
DD1-3
MEMORY 1
NW
UP
DD5-5
I
DD5-7
DD11-21
KS
MEMORY SET
I
DD5-10
DD11-6
UN
MEMORY 2
NOTE: Memory circuit – Driver Memory Seat vehicles only.
I
DD5-6
DD11-22
UG SET MEMORY STATUS
I
DD5-8
DD11-2
MIRROR CONTROL
DRIVER DOOR MEMORY SWITCH PACK BK
GY DD3-6
DD3-7
DRIVER DOOR SWITCH
BK
BK DD1-2
I DD11-20
BK
DDS7
I
LOGIC
I
POWER
DD10-8
B
B DD1-21
DD10-17
FC4AR (FC2AR)
DRIVER DOOR CONTROL MODULE
1
6
7
51
Fig. 01.2
Fig. 01.1 1 II
5 E
52
81
Fig. 01.3
6
38
II
II
39 E
55 E
I
Fig. 01.4 1 Fig. 01.5
18 I
Input
O
Output
D
Serial and Encoded Com m unications
Signal Ground (SG)
C
CAN (Netw ork)
S
SCP Netw ork
Fig. 02.1
V ARIAN T: All V ehicles V IN RAN GE: 018108 DATE OF ISSU E: SEPTEM BER 1997
➞
FC60 -6
FC61 -3
BR WU
FC61 -6
XK8 Range 1998
M irror M ovement
Fig. 11.3
M irror M ovement
U NB
15
S
FC14-80
RW
1
19.1
SCP
19.1
SCP
19.1
CAN
19.1
CAN
B+
I FC14-41
WO
5 II
WN
16 I
BK
BK
BK
FCS47
I
FC87-1
U S
Y
C FC25-24
S +
FCS12
FC14-85
+
FC25-20
S
+ S
G
– C FC25-47
FC25-19
LOGIC
I FC14-58
REVERSE GEAR
POWER
U
NOT-IN-PARK MICROSWITCH
FC3BR
S –
FCS11
FC14-84
I
SB
U
S
FC14-32
SB
FC87-3
–
FC14-15
S
DRIVER DOOR MIRROR MOTORS
VEHICLE SPEED
VERTICAL
BODY PROCESSOR MODULE AC14 -8
BK
BK
DDS7
DD1-2
GY DD3-6
DD3-7
U
–
U
S
U
DD10-9
UP
MEMORY 1 DD5-5
DD5-7
S
S
I DD11-6
UN
MEMORY 2 DD5-6
I
O
O
I
DD11-22
UG DD5-8
K
N
U
G
Y
WU WG
K
N
U
G
Y
ACS6
DD1-3
I
KS DD5-10
SET MEMORY STATUS
WU WG
S
DD11-21
MEMORY SET
NOTE: Memory circuit – Driver Memory Seat vehicles only.
ACS5
DD1-8
DD10-16
NW
S
I
+
35
AC14 -9
DD11-20
DRIVER DOOR SWITCH
FC4AR (FC2AR)
HORIZONTAL
B+ DD10-1
BK
VERTICAL
MAJOR INSTRUMENT PACK
N
25
PASSENGER DOOR MIRROR MOTORS
HORIZONTAL
DD8 -2
DD8 -6
DD8 -8
DD8 -3
DD8 -5
DD8 -10
DD8 -4
DP8 -2
DP8 -6
DP8 -8
DP8 -3
DP8 -5
DP8 -10
DP8 -4
WU
BK
PK
PN
PU
PG
BY
WU
BK
PK
PN
PU
PG
BY
WU DD10-20
PK DD10-22
DD11-2
PN
O
DRIVER DOOR MEMORY SWITCH PACK
DD10-4
MIRROR CONTROL
PU
I DD10-21
PG
O
NW
36
OB
DIRECTION
DD17-10
DD17-2
UP
DD11-1
OR
LH VERTICAL
YO
LH HORIZONTAL
BY
O DD10-2
I DD11-17
DD17-11
DOWN
DD10-3
I
I DD11-10
DD17-12
FOLD-BACK DD17-1
LEFT
SN
RH VERTICAL
BK DD1-2
DDS7
YN
RH HORIZONTAL
RIGHT
BK
BK
LOGIC
BK
I
I
POWER
DD1-2
B
I
B
DD10-17
DD1-21 FC4AR (FC2AR)
DRIVER DOOR CONTROL MODULE
MIRROR JOY STICK
BK
BK DDS7
DD10-8
DD11-9
DD17-14
DD17-20
FC4AR (FC2AR)
I DD11-3
DD17-13
DRIVER DOOR SWITCH PACK –
DRIVER DOOR CONTROL MODULE: FOLD-BACK MIRRORS
U
S
WG
11.4
U
DP10-9 +
DP1-8
S
S
S
DP10-16
N
47
WU
O
B+ DP10-1
DP1-3
DP10-20
PK
I DP10-22
MIRROR CONTROL
PN
O DP10-4
PU
I DP10-21
PG
O DP10-3
BY
O DP10-2
LOGIC
BK
I
POWER
I
B DP1-21 FC2AR (FC4AR)
PASSENGER DOOR CONTROL MODULE
6
7
51
Fig. 01.2
Fig. 01.1 1 II
5 E
52
81
Fig. 01.3
6
38
II
II
39 E
55 E
I
Fig. 01.4 1 Fig. 01.5
18 I
DP1-2
B DP10-17
1
BK
BK DPS7
DP10-8
Input
O
Output
D
Serial and Encoded Com m unications
Signal Ground (SG)
C
CAN (Netw ork)
S
SCP Netw ork
Fig. 02.1
V ARIAN T: All V ehicles V IN RAN GE: 018108 DATE OF ISSU E: SEPTEM BER 1997
➞
XK8 Range 1998
Interior and Exterior M irrors; Fold-Back M irrors
U 36
NW
DIRECTION
DD17-10
N
25
B+
–
U
S
DD10-1
UP
U
DD10-9
LH VERTICAL
+
S
S
LH HORIZONTAL
WG
I
U
S –
BK
BK
DDS7
DD10-8
BK
S +
NK
7
MIRROR JOY STICK
B+
–
DD17-20
U
CAN
–
C
19.1
CAN
MAJOR INSTRUMENT PACK
FCS11
S
SD5-9
19.1
G
REVERSE GEAR
SD1-3
S
S
DRIVER DOOR SWITCH PACK
BK
U SD5-10
Y
VEHICLE SPEED FC4AR (FC2AR)
S
SD5-5 +
C
FC25-47
DD1-2
DRIVER DOOR CONTROL MODULE
RH HORIZONTAL
+
FC25-19
RH VERTICAL
RIGHT
SCP
FC25-24
S I
19.1
S AC14-9
FC25-20
DD11-15
DD17-1
LEFT
S
MIRROR CONTROL
FOLD-BACK
SCP
S
U
ACS6
DD1-3
19.1
AC14-8
S
DD10-16
DOWN
U ACS5
DD1-8
Fig. 11.4
Interior and Exterior M irrors; Fold-Back M irrors
PB
FCS12
PB
PB
DD1-20
SD1-8
MIRROR TINT
DD8-12
MIRROR CONTROL
DDS7
R
O
BK
NOTE: Refer to Fig. 11.3 for mirror movement.
R
SD3-4
B
I
DD1-2
R
B SDS3
SD5-2
R
R
FCS6
SD1-7
AC16-4
R
R DDS3
DD1-6
DD8-1
B SD1-1
BK FC4AR (FC2AR)
–
NK
30
+
U
DD8-7
DRIVER DOOR MIRROR
U SP1-3
S
S
S
SP5-9
MIRROR CONTROL
S
SR DD1-14
SLIP MECHANISM
SP5-10
SP5-5
SR AC16-6
S
B+
SR
FC6L (FC5L)
DRIVER SEAT CONTROL MODULE
SLIP MECHANISM
SR
SP1-8 FCS7
R
O
AC13-20
S
SR DP1-14
DP8-7
SR
SP3-4
SP1-7
B
I
SR
B SPS3
SP5-2
B R
SP1-1
DP1-6
FC5S (FC6S)
PASSENGER SEAT CONTROL MODULE
R
R AC13-18
ACS9
PB
R
R DPS3
DP8-1
PB
PB
DP1-20
NK
52
B+
–
U
S
BT40-6
BT40-16 +
S
S BT40-8
LIGHTING CONTROL
U BT1-10
MIRROR TINT
DP8-12
PASSENGER DOOR MIRROR
U RH12-15
S BT1-11
S WR
16
RH12-16
II
YW
O
PB AC13-19
BT40-5
BK
I
YU
BTS9
BTS21
BT40-14
YW
YW BT1-19
YW BK RF1-3
BK RFS1
RF2-3
FC3BR
NB
15
B+
–
S
B+
+
S
NG
49
FC14-79
WO
5 II
UY
DIP
YU
YW S
I
UY
SC2-4
I FC14-42
SC2-1
SIDE
BK
BK FCS48
BK
SC2-9
BK
DIP
SCS1
SIDE
RY
RY
RY
RY
SCS2
AUTO
SC2-3
FCS9
I FC14-16
LIGHTING STALK COLUMN SWITCHGEAR
1
6
7
51
Fig. 01.2
Fig. 01.1 1 II
POWER LOGIC
FC3BL
5 E
52
81
Fig. 01.3
6
38
II
II
39 E
55 E
BODY PROCESSOR MODULE
I
Fig. 01.4 1 Fig. 01.5
18 I
09.2 REVERSE LAMPS
YW
FC14-85
FC14-15
UY
YU
INTERIOR REAR VIEW MIRROR
U FC14-84
FC14-80
AUTO HEADLAMPS
RF2-2
RF1-2
BK
BT1AR
SECURITY AND LOCKING CONTROL MODULE
YW
RH2-17
BK
MIRROR TINT RF2-5
RF1-11
BK
B+
RF2-4
RF1-14
YU
BT40-13
I
RF2-1
PB
PB
Input
O
Output
D
Serial and Encoded Com m unications
Signal Ground (SG)
C
CAN (Netw ork)
S
SCP Netw ork
Fig. 02.1
V ARIAN T: All V ehicles V IN RAN GE: 018108 DATE OF ISSU E: SEPTEM BER 1997
➞
09.2
XK8 Range 1998
Suspension Adaptive Damping
57
NS
B+
OB
O
BT69-27
25
WR
SERIAL COMMUNICATION
19.1
SERIAL COMMUNICATION
19.1
BT69-30 B+
II
OB
BT69-31
OB
OB
BT3-16
RH12-13
OW
O
BT69-11
O
Suspension Adaptive Damping
OW
OW
OW
BT3-15
LF43-A
LF1-19
RH12-14
LF43-B
LF1-18
LH FRONT DAMPER SOLENOID
D BT69-10
K
D
OG
OG
O
BT69-28
BT69-33
OG
RH12-11
OY
O
OG
BT3-18
BT69-14
OY
OY
OY RH12-12
BT3-17
LF44-A
LF60-19
LF44-B
LF60-20
RH FRONT DAMPER SOLENOID MAJOR INSTRUMENT PACK: FAULT WARNING (CIRCUIT CONTINUED)
08.1
MAJOR INSTRUMENT PACK: VEHICLE SPEED (CIRCUIT CONTINUED)
08.1
SO
SO
SO RH12-2
ON
BT3-10
ON
O BT69-1
ON
RH12-1
BT3-9
BT69-24
R
OR
O BT69-13
I
RL3-1
RL2-A
W
OK
O
OR
BT72-3
OK
BT72-4
BT69-32
RL2-B
RL3-2
LH REAR DAMPER SOLENOID NOTE: Circuit deleted VIN 024687 ➞.
R
OP
O
BRAKE SWITCH (LHD) B
WO
II
GB
AC26-4
BT73-4
B
WO
RR3-2
RR2-B
RH REAR DAMPER SOLENOID
AC26-1
US
US
GB
AC24-4
US FCS35
AC13-3
II
OU
US ACS16
7
RR2-A
W
BT69-34
6
RR3-1
OU
O
OP
BT73-3
BT69-15
US RH1-19
US BT1-9
US BTS5
I BT69-26
US
AC24-1
PB
I
BRAKE SWITCH (RHD)
PB
PB BT3-11
BT69-20
PB EM3-12
RH12-6
UW
EM59-1
UW EM3-10
U
LATERAL ACCELERATION GROUND
EM59-2
U EM3-9
B+ EM59-3
LATERAL ACCELEROMETER (FRONT)
UB
UB
I
BT3-14
BT69-21
UW
O
BT3-13
BTS27
BT69-25
FC7-1
UW
BT3-12
UW FCS84
RH12-8
U
U
U
O
UW
UW BTS28
BT69-3
UB RH12-7
GROUND FC7-2
U RH12-9
VERTICAL ACCELERATION
U FCS83
B+ FC7-3
FRONT VERTICAL ACCELEROMETER
RB
RB
I BT69-22
BT52-1
UW B
VERTICAL ACCELERATION GROUND
BT52-2
I
U
BT69-18
B+ BT52-3
BT2BL
REAR VERTICAL ACCELEROMETER
ADAPTIVE DAMPING CONTROL MODULE
1
6
7
51
Fig. 01.2
Fig. 01.1 1 II
5 E
52
81
Fig. 01.3
6
38
II
II
39 E
55 E
I
Fig. 01.4 1 Fig. 01.5
18 I
Input
O
Output
D
Serial and Encoded Com m unications
Signal Ground (SG)
C
CAN (Netw ork)
S
SCP Netw ork
Fig. 02.1
V ARIAN T: Adapt ive Dam ping V ehicles V IN RAN GE: 018108 DATE OF ISSU E: FEBRU ARY 1998
➞
Fig. 11.5
XK8 Range 1998
Driver Seat: M emory
NB
15
B+
–
I
+
WN
I
NR
BK
SEAT HEATER STATE
FC55-8 (LHD) FC55-15 (RHD)
Y
I
G
O
ON (LHD) OU (RHD)
SCP
19.1
SCP
19.1
CAN
19.1
CAN
POWER
I
R
OK
LOGIC
FC14-86 (LHD) FC14-35 (RHD)
B
SD19-1
R SD19-3
THERMOSTAT
SD17-1
SD17-3
HEATER
HEATER
FC55-2
FCS47
S
I
FC14-69 (LHD) FC14-17 (RHD)
FC55-7 (LHD) FC55-14 (RHD)
BK
19.1
FC14-32
OK (LHD) OS (RHD) FC55-9
FCS12
FC14-15
16 16
U
FC14-85
WO
II
S
S
FC14-41
5
FCS11
FC14-84
RW
1
U
S
FC14-80
Fig. 12.1
Driver Seat: M emory
BODY PROCESSOR MODULE SEAT HEATER SWITCH
DRIVER SEAT CUSHION
B
DRIVER SQUAB
FC3BR
CENTER CONSOLE SWITCH PACK
N
25
B+
–
35
MEMORY 1
NW DD5-5
I
S
S
S
OR SD14-3
S SOLENOID VALVE
AC14-9
OB
I I
–
O
DD5-8
DD11-2
BK
DDS7
DD1-2
DRIVER DOOR MEMORY SWITCH PACK
BK
BK
B
I I
DD10-17
FC4AR (FC2AR)
VEHICLE SPEED
LOGIC
POWER
C
–
C
DRIVER SEAT LUMBAR PUMP
FC25-19
DRIVER SEAT MOTORS
FC25-47
–
+
U S
S
S
SD1-8
SD5-9
G
SEAT BELT FASTENED
SEAT BELT SWITCH
SD8 -6
SD8 -2
SD8 -1
SD8 -3
SD7 -5
SD7 -6
SD7 -2
SD7 -1
SD7 -3
SD9 -5
SD9 -6
SD9 -2
SD9 -1
SD9 -3
W WY
PS
PO
WB WU WO
KS
KO
WN WP WR
US
UO
SD3-3
I SD5-8
SD8 -5
OK
O
SEAT RAISE / LOWER
SD1-3
SD5-10
SD5-5
SEAT FORE / AFT
MAJOR INSTRUMENT PACK U
S
B+
SD20-1
+
OR
O
WG
SD3-6
OB
O SD3-5
WG
O
GN
INFLATE
22
N
LUMBAR
SD11-3
SD3-13
SEAT
SD3-14
SD3-12
SD3-1
I
SD11-5
SD3-11
SD3-2
I
SD11-7
SD3-16
SD4-18
I
SD11-8
SD3-15
SD4-2
I
SD11-6
SD3-9
WO
I
UW
SD4-12
I
SD11-13
WU
O
UY
AFT
WB
O
GW
FORE
PO
O
GY
AFT
PS
O
KW
FORE
SEAT
SD4-11
I
SD11-12
WY
I
KY
LOWER
RECLINE
SD4-5
I
SD11-11
RAISE
W
O
GP
DEFLATE
SD11-9
SD4-1
I
SD3-10
KS
O SD3-7
KO
O
DRIVER SEAT SWITCH PACK
SD3-8
POWER
B
B SD1-1
B SDS3
WN
O SD4-6
I SD5-2
WP
O SD4-14
FC6L (FC5L)
WR
I SD4-10
US
O
B
B
I
SD1-6
SD5-1
**
SD5-3
UO
O SD5-4
FC6R (FC5R)
** NOTE: Module identification.
DRIVER SEAT CONTROL MODULE
1
6
7
51
Fig. 01.2
Fig. 01.1 1 II
5 E
52
81
Fig. 01.3
6
38
II
II
39 E
55 E
I
Fig. 01.4 1 Fig. 01.5
18 I
SDS3
B SD1-1
FC6L (FC5L)
S
SQUAB RECLINE FORE / AFT
NK
N
S
FC25-24
DRIVER DOOR CONTROL MODULE
7
+
DD10-8
B DD1-21
PRESSURE SWITCH
FC25-20
UG
SD14-2
U
S
DD11-22
B
B SD14-1
UN DD5-6
SD20-2
S ACS6
DD1-3
U AC14-8
DD11-6
MEMORY 2
21
U ACS5
DD1-8
DD10-16
KS DD5-10
SET MEMORY STATUS
+
DD11-21
DD5-7
U
DD10-9
UP
MEMORY SET
U
S
DD10-1
Input
O
Output
D
Serial and Encoded Com m unications
Signal Ground (SG)
C
CAN (Netw ork)
S
SCP Netw ork
Fig. 02.1
V ARIAN T: M em ory Seat V ehicles V IN RAN GE: 018108 DATE OF ISSU E: SEPTEM BER 1997
➞
XK8 Range 1998
Driver Seat: Non M emory
NB
15
B+ FC14-80
FC14-15
NR
16
BK
SEAT HEATER STATE
S
FCS12
19.1
SCP
OK
O
R
FC14-69 (LHD) FC14-17 (RHD)
ON (LHD) OU (RHD)
B
SD19-1
R SD19-3
THERMOSTAT
I
FC55-7 (LHD) FC55-14 (RHD)
BK
FCS47
FC55-8 (LHD) FC55-15 (RHD)
SCP
FC14-32
OK (LHD) OS (RHD) FC55-9
19.1
FC14-85
I
I
S
+ S
WN
16
U
FCS11
FC14-84
I
II
U
– S
WO
5
Fig. 12.2
Driver Seat: Non M emory
SD17-1
SD17-3
HEATER
HEATER
FC14-86 (LHD) FC14-35 (RHD)
DRIVER SEAT CUSHION
FC55-2
SEAT HEATER SWITCH
B
DRIVER SQUAB
POWER
FC3BR
OR
LOGIC
CENTER CONSOLE SWITCH PACK
SD14-3
SOLENOID VALVE
BODY PROCESSOR MODULE
OB
PRESSURE SWITCH
DRIVER SEAT MOTORS SQUAB RECLINE FORE / AFT
U
– S
NK
SD5-10
B+ SD5-5
SD5-9
N
21
G SD20-2
SD5-8
SEAT BELT FASTENED
SEAT BELT SWITCH
S SD1-8
SD8 -1
SD8 -3
SD7 -1
SD7 -3
SD9 -1
SD9 -3
PS
PO
KS
KO
US
UO
SD3-3
I
SD20-1
SEAT RAISE / LOWER
U
OK
O
SEAT FORE / AFT
SD1-3
S
+ S
OR
O SD3-6
OB
O SD3-5
GN
INFLATE
N
22
LUMBAR
I
SD11-3
SD3-13
GP
DEFLATE
SD11-9
I
SD11-11
SD3-14
KY
RAISE SEAT
I
SD11-12
SD3-12
RECLINE
SD3-11
SD3-2
I
SD11-7
PO
O
GY SD3-16
GW
AFT
I
SD11-8
SD3-15
UY
FORE SEAT
SD3-1
I
SD11-5
FORE
PS
O
KW
LOWER
I
SD11-6
SD3-9
UW
AFT
I
SD11-13
SD3-10
KS
O SD3-7
KO
O
DRIVER SEAT SWITCH PACK
SD3-8
B
B
B SDS3
SD1-1
I
POWER
SD5-2
FC6L (FC5L)
US
O
B
B
I
SD1-6
SD5-1
**
SD5-3
UO
O SD5-4
FC6R (FC5R)
** NOTE: Module identification.
DRIVER SEAT CONTROL MODULE
1
6
7
51
Fig. 01.2
Fig. 01.1 1 II
5 E
52
81
Fig. 01.3
6
38
II
II
39 E
55 E
I
Fig. 01.4 1 Fig. 01.5
18 I
Input
O
Output
D
Serial and Encoded Com m unications
Signal Ground (SG)
C
CAN (Netw ork)
S
SCP Netw ork
Fig. 02.1
SDS3
B SD1-1
FC6L (FC5L)
DRIVER SEAT LUMBAR PUMP
7
B
B SD14-2
SD14-1
V ARIAN T: N on M em ory Seat V ehicles V IN RAN GE: 018108 DATE OF ISSU E: SEPTEM BER 1997
➞
XK8 Range 1998
Passenger Seat: 3-Way M ovement
NB
15
B+ FC14-80
WO
5
NR
16
BK
SEAT HEATER STATE
SCP
S
FCS12
19.1
SCP
FC14-85
OK
O
R
FC14-17 (LHD) FC14-69 (RHD)
OU (LHD) ON (RHD)
B
SP19-1
R SP19-3
THERMOSTAT
I
FC55-14 (LHD) FC55-7 (RHD)
BK
FCS47
FC55-15 (LHD) FC55-8 (RHD)
19.1
FC14-32
OS (LHD) OK (RHD) FC55-9
S
+ S
I
I
U
FCS11
FC14-84
FC14-15
WN
U
– S
I
II
16
Fig. 12.3
Passenger Seat: 3-Way M ovement
SP17-1
SP17-3
HEATER
HEATER
FC14-35 (LHD) FC14-86 (RHD)
PASSENGER SEAT CUSHION
FC55-2
SEAT HEATER SWITCH
B
PASSENGER SQUAB
POWER
FC3BR
OR
LOGIC
CENTER CONSOLE SWITCH PACK
SP14-3
SOLENOID VALVE
BODY PROCESSOR MODULE
OB
PRESSURE SWITCH
PASSENGER SEAT MOTORS SQUAB RECLINE FORE / AFT
U
– S
NK SP5-5
SEAT BELT SWITCH WIRING
N
43
G
NOT USED SP5-8
S SP1-8
OK
O
SEAT RAISE / LOWER
U
S
+ S
SEAT FORE / AFT
SP1-3
SP5-9
SP20-1
SP20-2
SP5-10
B+
SP8 -1
SP8 -3
SP7 -1
SP7 -3
SP9 -1
SP9 -3
PS
PO
KS
KO
US
UO
SP3-3
OR
O SP3-6
OB
O SP3-5
GN
INFLATE
N
44
LUMBAR
I
SP11-3
SP3-13
GP
DEFLATE
SP11-9
I
SP11-11
SP3-14
KY
RAISE SEAT
I
SP11-12
SP3-12
KW
LOWER SP11-5
RECLINE
PO
O SP3-2
I
SP11-7
SP3-16
GW
AFT
I
SP11-8
SP3-15
UY
FORE SEAT
SP3-1
SP3-11
GY
FORE
PS
O I
I
SP11-6
SP3-9
UW
AFT
I
SP11-13
SP3-10
KS
O SP3-7
KO
O
PASSENGER SEAT SWITCH PACK
SP3-8
B
B
B SPS3
SP1-1
I
POWER
SP5-2
FC5S (FC6S)
US
O
B
NOT CONNECTED
I
SP1-6
SP5-1
**
SP5-3
UO
O SP5-4
** NOTE: Module identification.
PASSENGER SEAT CONTROL MODULE
1
6
7
51
Fig. 01.2
Fig. 01.1 1 II
5 E
52
81
Fig. 01.3
6
38
II
II
39 E
55 E
I
Fig. 01.4 1 Fig. 01.5
18 I
Input
O
Output
D
Serial and Encoded Com m unications
Signal Ground (SG)
C
CAN (Netw ork)
S
SCP Netw ork
Fig. 02.1
SPS3
B SP1-1
FC5S (FC6S)
PASSENGER SEAT LUMBAR PUMP
30
B
B SP14-2
SP14-1
V ARIAN T: 3-W ay M ovem ent V ehicles V IN RAN GE: 018108 DATE OF ISSU E: SEPTEM BER 1997
➞
XK8 Range 1998
Passenger Seat: 2-Way M ovement
NB
15
B+ FC14-80
WO
5
WN
NR
16
BK
FC55-15 (LHD) FC55-8 (RHD)
SEAT HEATER STATE
FCS47
S
FCS12
19.1
SCP
19.1
SCP
FC14-85
FC14-32
OK
O
R
FC14-17 (LHD) FC14-69 (RHD)
OU (LHD) ON (RHD)
B
SP19-1
R SP19-3
THERMOSTAT
I
FC55-14 (LHD) FC55-7 (RHD)
BK
S
+ S
I
OS (LHD) OK (RHD) FC55-9
U
FCS11
FC14-84
FC14-15
I
U
– S
I
II
16
Fig. 12.4
Passenger Seat: 2-Way M ovement
SP17-1
SP17-3
HEATER
HEATER
FC14-35 (LHD) FC14-86 (RHD)
PASSENGER SEAT CUSHION
FC55-2
SEAT HEATER SWITCH
B
PASSENGER SQUAB
POWER
FC3BR
OR
LOGIC
CENTER CONSOLE SWITCH PACK
SP14-3
SOLENOID VALVE
BODY PROCESSOR MODULE
OB
PRESSURE SWITCH
PASSENGER SEAT MOTORS SQUAB RECLINE FORE / AFT
U
– S
NK SP5-5
SEAT BELT SWITCH WIRING
N
43
SP20-2
SP5-10
B+
SP5-9
G
NOT USED
SP20-1
SP5-8
U S SP1-8
OK
O
SEAT FORE / AFT
SP1-3
S
+ S
SP8 -1
SP8 -3
SP7 -1
SP7 -3
PS
PO
KS
KO
SP3-3
OR
O SP3-6
OB
O SP3-5
GN
INFLATE
44
N
LUMBAR
I
SP11-3
SP3-13
GP
DEFLATE
SP11-9
I
SP11-11
SP3-14
SP11-12
PS
O SP3-1
SP11-5
RECLINE
SP3-2
I
SP11-7
SP3-16
GW
AFT
I
SP11-8
SP3-15
UY
FORE SEAT
PO
O
GY
FORE
I
SP11-6
SP3-9
UW
AFT
I
SP11-13
SP3-10
KS
O SP3-7
KO
O
PASSENGER SEAT SWITCH PACK
SP3-8
B
B
B SPS3
SP1-1
I
POWER
SP5-2
FC5S (FC6S)
B
NOT CONNECTED
I
SP1-6
SP5-1
** ** NOTE: Module identification.
PASSENGER SEAT CONTROL MODULE
1
6
7
51
Fig. 01.2
Fig. 01.1 1 II
5 E
52
81
Fig. 01.3
6
38
II
II
39 E
55 E
I
Fig. 01.4 1 Fig. 01.5
18 I
Input
O
Output
D
Serial and Encoded Com m unications
Signal Ground (SG)
C
CAN (Netw ork)
S
SCP Netw ork
Fig. 02.1
SPS3
B SP1-1
FC5S (FC6S)
PASSENGER SEAT LUMBAR PUMP
30
B
B SP14-2
SP14-1
V ARIAN T: 2-W ay M ovem ent V ehicles V IN RAN GE: 018108 DATE OF ISSU E: SEPTEM BER 1997
➞
XK8 Range 1998
Central Door Locking
U NB
15
19.1
SCP
19.1
SCP
B+
S
FC14-80
RW
1
WO
5
I
II
FC14-15
RG
8
I
II
BK
UR FC4-5
I
FC4-4
B+ BT40-15
U
S
–
FC14-67
U S
S – BT40-16
BT1-10
S
FCS12
FC14-85
U
RH2-11
S
S
+
U
FCS11
FC14-84
IGNITION SWITCH (KEY-IN SWITCH)
FC3BL
NY
61
FC14-33
BK FCS48
S
RH2-12
RH7 -1
S +
BK
SB
FC87-3
SB
BRD S
U
BK BTS21
NOT-IN-PARK MICROSWITCH
FC41-10
TRUNK
SW FC41-3
FC41-6
FUEL FILL
BK
I
AC14 -9
AC14 -8
I
S
U
RY
BK
BT46-2
BT46-1
BT1AR
RY BTS6
RH20-2
I
BT41-5
RH20-1
TRUNK SWITCH
BRD RH20-2
YR
I BT41-19
BT2-7
YP
I
FC14-31
BT41-7
TRUNK AND FUEL FILL RELEASE SWITCH
FC3BR
RHS3
W
I
FC14-5
BK
FCS47
B
RH20-1
FC14-58
SO
W
I
I
FC87-1
RH7 -2
BT40-8
BT1-11
LOCK CONTROL
BK
KEY FOB ANTENNA (COUPE)
KEY FOB ANTENNA (CONVERTIBLE)
I FC14-41
NOTE: Ignition switched ground via Inertia Switch activates emergency unlock.
BT2-16
OR
O
B BT43-2
BT40-1
B
B FCS50
SP FC67-5
BK
I
FC67-4
FC14-55
SR
O
TRUNK RELEASE SOLENOID
I
BK
BTS21
I
OB
O
BT40-14
OB
BT40-2
IC4-3
YP
BT1AR
RH2-14
B+
U
S
–
DD10-1
37
NW
LGU DD3-13
DD3-5
DD10-9
I
NW
DD10-16
I
DD3-10
ACS5
DD1-3
LOCK STATUS
YR (LHD) YP (RHD)
S ACS6
Y
YR
AC13-6 (LHD) AC13-17 (RHD)
BK DD3-9
DD1-16
DD3-6
I
O
BK
DD3-1
DD10-6
I
B
I
DD1-21
LOGIC
B 31
POWER
NR
32
NR
DRIVER DOOR CONTROL MODULE
B+
NW
LGU DP3-13
DP3-5
DP10-9
I DP11-5
9
FC24
10
8
SG
BK
PASSENGER DOOR LOCK SWITCH
GY DP3-6
DP3-7
DP10-16
7
ACS2
SR
DOOR LOCKING RELAY
U S
YP (LHD) YR (RHD)
DP1-3
I
LOCK STATUS
Y
YP
SY
O
DP3-3
SG I
DP1-21
DP1-2
BK DP3-1
DP10-6
POWER
DP10-17
PASSENGER DOOR LOCK ACTUATOR
FC2AR (FC4AR)
PASSENGER DOOR CONTROL MODULE
7
51
Fig. 01.2
Fig. 01.1 II
5 E
52
81
Fig. 01.3
6
38
II
II
39 E
55 E
I
Fig. 01.4 1 Fig. 01.5
18 I
BK
DP3-2
SU
SU
O I
SG DP1-19
LOGIC
DP10-8
B
DP3-8
SY
DP10-5
BK
BK DP3-9
DP1-16
DPS7
DP11-20
DPS7
B
6
AC13-17 (LHD) AC13-6 (RHD)
PASSENGER DOOR SWITCH
BK
SG
DP1-8
S
S
+
DOOR LOCK CONTROL
EXTERIOR HANDLE
DP1-2
B
FC2BR (FC4BR)
U
S
–
DP10-1
BK
FCS46
AC15-1
FC4AR (FC2AR)
N
FC4AR (FC2AR)
DRIVER DOOR LOCK ACTUATOR
DD10-17
47
BK
SU
DD10-8
B
DD1-2 DD3-2
SU
DOOR LOCK CONTROL
DDS7
DD1-2
SG DD1-19
DRIVER DOOR SWITCH
BK
BK
SG
DD11-20
BK
DD3-3
DD10-5
DD11-4
GY
DD3-7
1
DD3-8
SY
I
BK
DRIVER DOOR LOCK SWITCHES
6
BT1AL
RH2-2
SY
O
DD11-12
OU
UNLOCK DD3-11
1
B
DDS7
OY
KEY BARREL
33
BTS20
U DD1-8
S
S
+
DD11-5
LOCK
DD3-12
B IC4-4
FUEL FILL FLAP SOLENOID
YR
EXTERIOR HANDLE
38
IC24-1
SECURITY AND LOCKING CONTROL MODULE
BODY PROCESSOR MODULE N
B IC24-2
BK
LOGIC
25
BT43-1
BT40-13
FC14-71
POWER
VALET SWITCH
FC4BL (FC2BL)
Fig. 13.1
Central Door Locking
Input
O
Output
D
Serial and Encoded Com m unications
Signal Ground (SG)
C
CAN (Netw ork)
S
SCP Netw ork
Fig. 02.1
V ARIAN T: All V ehicles V IN RAN GE: 018108 DATE OF ISSU E: SEPTEM BER 1997
➞
FC2AR (FC4AR)
XK8 Range 1998
Wash / Wipe System
Fig. 14.1
Wash / Wipe System
3
4
#7 30A 1
4
B
YR
5 LF6-1
LF25-2
LF25-1
YS
2 LF6-10
POWERWASH PUMP
POWERWASH RELAY (#4)
ENGINE COMPARTMENT FUSE BOX NB
15
YS
O FC14-80
FC14-18
NY
19
WO
II
LF1-17
FC14-6
I
YW
YW
I FC14-104
5
YS
LF27-3
LF1-15
YG
O
FC14-15
FC14-26
FLUID LEVEL
YG
B LF27-2
LF1-16
LF27-1
LFS7
B WINDSHIELD WASH PUMP AND FLUID LEVEL SENSOR
WO
2
WO
II
LGR WASH
SC1-9
LGR
I FC14-37
SC1-8
LGK
LGK
LGO
LGO
FC14-94
LGU
LGU
FLICK WIPE
KG
5
1
2
NU
9
NU
BLG
B
FC14-9
WIPER RUN / STOP RELAY
INTERMITTENT WIPE
LF3BS
BLG
BLG
O FC14-43
LF60-16 LF49
560 Ω
KG 1.3 ΚΩ
WASH / WIPE CONTROL
11
2.7 ΚΩ
NU
5.1 ΚΩ
U R
4
3
5
1
2
WLG
WIPER FAST / SLOW RELAY
11 ΚΩ
WLG
O FC14-19
WLG LF60-17
51 ΚΩ
FAST
WASH / WIPE STALK
B
B LFS18
B LF3-5
N
SLOW
BW BR
EM51-4 (LHD) EM51-2 (RHD)
11.4
YU
YU
LF3BS
WIPER MOTOR
SIDE
BK
BK FCS48
BK
BK
DIP
SCS1
SC2-9
FC3BL
SIDE
RY
RY SCS2
AUTO
RY SC2-3
RY
I
FCS9
RY
I
FC14-16
FC14-60
RY LF1-14
LIGHTING STALK POWER
COLUMN SWITCHGEAR DIMMER MODULE: SIDE LAMPS ON
10.2
LOGIC
RY BODY PROCESSOR MODULE
1
6
7
51
Fig. 01.2
Fig. 01.1 1 II
5 E
52
81
Fig. 01.3
6
38
II
II
39 E
55 E
I
Fig. 01.4 1 Fig. 01.5
18 I
Input
O
Output
D
Serial and Encoded Com m unications
Signal Ground (SG)
C
CAN (Netw ork)
S
SCP Netw ork
Fig. 02.1
V ARIAN T: All V ehicles V IN RAN GE: 018108 DATE OF ISSU E: SEPTEM BER 1997
➞
U
U LF3-3
RY EM51-3
SC2-4
SC2-1
LF3-4
EM51-2 (LHD) EM51-4 (RHD)
PARK SWITCH
R
R EM51-1 (LHD) EM51-5 (RHD)
NLG UY
DIP REAR VIEW MIRRORS: AUTO HEADLAMPS / MIRROR TINT
10
LFS18
I
SC1-7
DELAY
B
4
3
I
SC1-5
SLOW WIPE
LF48
I FC14-34
SC1-6
FAST WIPE
LF1AR
RY LF3-2
XK8 Range 1998
Window Lifts S U
CONVERTIBLE TOP CONTROL
NOTE: BPM Convertible Top control – Convertible vehicles only.
–
U
S
U
FCS11
FC14-84 +
19.1
SCP
19.1
SCP
S – FC25-20
S
S
Fig. 15.1
Window Lifts
S
FCS12
FC14-85
S + FC25-19
REMOTE WINDOW CONTROL
S
S U
U
MAJOR INSTRUMENT PACK TRANSIT ISOLATION DEVICE (CIRCUIT CONTINUED)
01.1
DRIVER SIDE FUSE BOX
01.2
NO
NO
26
NO BT2-8
NO
BODY PROCESSOR MODULE
RH2-8
U NO
NO FCS81
NO
AC16-1 (LHD) AC15-20 (RHD)
N
N
25
RH2-11
B+
DD1-22
S
DD10-1 RH2-12
WINDOW LIFT CONTROL
BO DD10-18
NW
36
BG DD17-10
I
BR RH WINDOW UP
DD17-6
RH WINDOW DOWN
DD17-7
–
DD10-10
DD17-17
LH WINDOW DOWN
AC14 -9
AC14 -8
S
U
U
S DD10-9
I
DD10-16
PB DD10-11
I
DD16-2
DD11-7
PO
BK
DD16-6
DD10-15
DD16-1
DD10-7
OY
NW
38
I DD11-4
DD3-11
BK
BK
DRIVER DOOR LOCK SWITCHES NY
NY
48
NY BT2-2
BK DDS7
DD1-2
01.1
DRIVER WINDOW LIFT
DD11-12
OU
KEY BARREL
TRANSIT ISOLATION DEVICE (CIRCUIT CONTINUED)
DD16-3
I
DD3-10
UNLOCK
DD3-12
FC4AR (FC2AR)
MOVEMENT SENSOR
OB
O LOCK
BK DD1-2
OU
O
DRIVER DOOR SWITCH PACK
BK
DDS7
PW DD10-12
WINDOW LIFT SWITCHES
DD16-4
DD16-5
I
DD17-20
FC4AR (FC2AR)
SECURITY AND LOCKING CONTROL MODULE
ACS6
DD1-3
I
BK DDS7
REMOTE WINDOW CLOSE
ACS5
DD10-13
BK
S + BT40-8
S
O
DD1-2
S BT1-11
U DD1-8
S
+ S
DD10-19
BP
BK
S – BT40-16
I
DD17-16
LH WINDOW UP
U BT1-10
I
LOGIC
I
POWER
DD10-8
B
B
SW
DD10-17
DD1-21
FC14-63
NY
FC62-6
SR
FC4AR (FC2AR)
FC62-1
FC14-10
DRIVER DOOR CONTROL MODULE
LGR
RH2-13 FC14-89
PASSENGER SIDE FUSE BOX
01.2
NY
NY FCS82
NY
AC15-20 (LHD) AC16-1 (RHD)
N
N
47
DP1-22
DP10-1
BO
S
+
S
34
DP1-2
DPS7
GB
DP10-10
GP
PB
BK
DP10-13
DP10-12
DP1-2
DPS7
I
B
B DP1-21
BK
BODY PROCESSOR MODULE
DP1-2
POWER
FC2AR (FC4AR)
NOTE: Coupe vehicles only – Convertible Top fascia harness wiring not used.
DP16-1
OB
O I
MOVEMENT SENSOR
DP16-6
DP10-15
LOGIC
DP10-8
BK
OU
O
BK
DPS7
DP10-7
DP16-3
DP10-17
PASSENGER WINDOW LIFT
FC2AR (FC4AR)
PASSENGER DOOR CONTROL MODULE
1
6
7
51
Fig. 01.2
Fig. 01.1 1 II
5 E
52
81
Fig. 01.3
6
38
II
II
39 E
55 E
I
Fig. 01.4 1 Fig. 01.5
18 I
RF1-13
RH12-15
WINDOW LIFT SWITCHES PASSENGER DOOR SWITCH PACK
DP16-4
DP16-5
PW
I
BK
RH12-17
FC14-77
DP16-2
PO
O
DP17-8
BK
RH12-16
FC14-98
DP1-3
OLG WINDOW LIFT CONTROL
FC2AR (FC4AR)
S
I
DP17-7
RF1-6
FC14-36
DP1-8
S
I
BK
BK
LGW
DP10-11
BG
DP17-1
LOCAL WINDOW DOWN
BK
DP10-18
U
U
DP10-16
I
DP17-2
LOCAL WINDOW UP
RF1-5
FC14-62 –
DP10-9
NW
RF1-4
LGU
B+
Input
O
Output
D
Serial and Encoded Com m unications
Signal Ground (SG)
C
CAN (Netw ork)
S
SCP Netw ork
Fig. 02.1
V ARIAN T: All V ehicles V IN RAN GE: 018108 DATE OF ISSU E: SEPTEM BER 1997
➞
XK8 Range 1998
U
S
–
U
DD10-9
S
S
U
FCS11
S
ACS6
DD1-3
S
FCS12
19.1
SCP
19.1
SCP
19.1
CAN
AC14-9
Y
WINDOW LIFT CONTROL
B 66
G
19.1
NB
15
Y
B+
U
U
S
II
DP1-3
DP10-16
RG
WINDOW LIFT CONTROL
I
PASSENGER DOOR CONTROL MODULE
BK FCS47
+
S
U
S
S
FC14-84
BTS37
S – FC25-20
FC14-85
SW
S +
RH5-3
GB
2
RH33-2
LH QUARTER LIGHT LIFT
67 VEHICLE SPEED
54
B
NR
RH33-1
BT74
10
8
GR
6
7
GP
RH5-1
BT1BR
LH QUARTER DOWN RELAY
MAJOR INSTRUMENT PACK
FC14-63
GB
O FC14-98
CONVERTIBLE TOP SWITCH
GB
GB
RH2-11
BTS33
BT3-3
B 62
NU
4
BT76
5
GY
3
GY BT3-7
LGR RF4-2
LGR RF1-4
I
BK
BK
LGU RF4-1
RF4-3
LGU RF1-5
BTS35
63
OLG RF1-13
LGW RF4-5
RF4-4
LGW RF1-6
O RH6-3
GB
2
RH34-2
RH QUARTER LIGHT LIFT
I FC14-62
56 OLG
1
RH QUARTER UP RELAY
TOP LATCH CLOSED SWITCH
FC3BR
NK
CONVERTIBLE TOP CONTROL
BK RFS1
RF1-3
55
FC14-89
TOP CLOSED SWITCH
U
GR BT3-5
B
NK
9
FC25-19
I
FC62-6
O
GW
C –
FC14-10
FC62-10
DOWN
I
U
GW
3
LH QUARTER UP RELAY
I
FC62-1
FC3BR
S
FC14-32
SR BK
–
FC14-33
WN
16 UP
I
BT74
1
FC25-47
FC14-15
8
NK
C +
G
I
II
S
S
+
WO
5
DP1-8
DP10-9
4 5
FC25-24
FC14-80
S
NR
BT3-4
CAN
53
DRIVER DOOR CONTROL MODULE
–
Fig. 15.2
Convertible Top
AC14-8
S
DD10-16
U
U ACS5
DD1-8
S
+
Convertible Top
B
NU
8
GU
6
7
GP
GU
U RH6-1
BTS34
I
BT1BL
FC14-36
TOP READY-TO-LATCH SWITCH
RH34-1
BT76
10
BT3-8
B
NK
9
POWER
GP
O LOGIC
FC14-77
RH QUARTER DOWN RELAY
GP RH2-15
GP
BT3-6
OLG RH12-15
BODY PROCESSOR MODULE
B 64
LGO –
TOP RAISED SWITCH
NK
52
U
S BT40-16
B+ BT40-6
+
RHS2
B
LGY
RH29-1
LGY
LGY
RH29-2
BT3-1
S
S
I
U
B
B
3
B
2
UG
1
S RH12-16
CONVERTIBLE TOP PUMP
TOP UP RELAY
UG BT40-3 BTS18
TOP DOWN SWITCH
RH1S
BT16
5
RH12-15
S BT1-11
O
BT41-3
U BT1-10
BT40-8
B
4
BT15-2 RH29-3
B
NO
65
B
NO
4 5
BT17
W
W
3
BT15-1
CONVERTIBLE TOP CONTROL
NOTE: RHS2 – Coupe only.
B
BTS20
B BT1AL
2
UO
1
B BT2BL
TOP DOWN RELAY
UO
O BT40-10
GW
O BT40-4
BK
B BT53-2
BT53-1
LATCH CONTROL VALVE
I BT40-13
BTS21
BK
I
B
GR
O
BT40-14
BT40-9
BT54-2
BTS20
BT54-1
B
BK BT1AR
1
6
7
51
Fig. 01.2
Fig. 01.1 1 II
5 E
52
81
Fig. 01.3
6
38
II
II
39 E
55 E
SECURITY AND LOCKING CONTROL MODULE
I
Fig. 01.4 1 Fig. 01.5
18 I
BT1AL
MAIN CONTROL VALVE
Input
O
Output
D
Serial and Encoded Com m unications
Signal Ground (SG)
C
CAN (Netw ork)
S
SCP Netw ork
Fig. 02.1
V ARIAN T: Convert ible V ehicles V IN RAN GE: 018108 DATE OF ISSU E: SEPTEM BER 1997
➞
XK8 Range 1998
Standard In-Car Entertainment: Convertible
PASSENGER DOOR FULL RANGE
RADIO ANTENNA Y
19.1
CAN
C +
NP
45
B+
FC25-24
IC10-10
G
19.1
CAN
B LGB
LGB
IC10-5
MAJOR INSTRUMENT PACK
LGB RH1-7
IC2-14
LGB BT1-20
BT19-6
OP OG
B
BT19-4
OP
OP
BT1AL
FCS67
IC1-12
OG FCS68
10.2
RLG
RLG
RADIO TELEPHONE
16.4
PK
16.4
RADIO TELEPHONE
PR
16.4
RADIO TELEPHONE
16.4
UY
IC2-4
IC10-13
MODE
SW4-1 3.3 Κ Ω
SW2-2
PY
PY
PY
SC3-2
IC2-6
RH27-1
RH1-5
IC1-18
IC10-9
BY
BY
RH27-2
RH1-6
IC1-19
IC10-8
SW1-2
IC1-7
KP
KP
VOLUME +
SW4-2
SWS1
BO
BO SW2-6
AC14-2
UG
BO SW1-6
SC3-12
BK
CD LINK LEAD
FCS27
UG
UG
G DD1-23
UP
UP AC14-11
IC1-15
IC7
K DD1-11
AC14-12
UP
IC8
P DD1-17
O
FC3BL
STEERING WHEEL
FCS28
IC1-14
FCS48
O DD1-12
PK
PK IC1-10
IC10-7
CASSETTE
RADIO CONTROL SWITCHES
PO AC14-1
IC1-9
PK
20 Κ Ω
RH1-3
PO
PO IC10-6
BO
IC8-1
IC7-1
UP
UG
IC7-2
FC39 -1
FC39 -2
W IC8-2
R
CAUTION: The Steering Wheel contains two logic ground circuits that must remain separate. Do not connect or cross-switch the BO and BK circuits.
IC8-3
DD18 -1
DD18 -2
NOT USED
DD19 -1
DD19 -2
IC7-3
NOT USED
G IC8-4
NOT USED
IC7-4
B IC8-5
IC7-5
U IC8-6
DRIVER DOOR FULL RANGE
IC7-6
Y IC8-7
IC7-7
B IC8-8
IC7-8
CD AUTO-CHANGER
BRD
RADIO / CASSETTE HEAD UNIT
1
6
7
51
Fig. 01.2
Fig. 01.1 1 II
5 E
52
81
Fig. 01.3
6
38
II
II
39 E
RH25 -2
RH1-4
IC1-8 6.8 Κ Ω
DRIVER SIDE REAR QUARTER FULL RANGE
BS
BS
I IC10-2
SEEK
VOLUME -
RH25 -1
KB
KB
KB
IC2-5
RADIO TELEPHONE CIRCUIT
CASSETTE
PASSENGER SIDE REAR QUARTER FULL RANGE
IC10-12
LGY
BY
PY
RH26-2
RH1-12
IC1-17
IC10-19
RH26-1
BG
BG
BG IC10-16
KW RH1-20
IC1-16
IC10-20
UY
LGY RT20-9
BW RH1-2
KW
KW
IC2-3
RT20-7
KG RH1-1
BW
PR
UY
LGY
O DP1-12
IC1-4
IC10-15
IC2-2
RT20-1
RADIO TELEPHONE
AC14-3
KG
PK
PK
PR
K
IC10-14
IC2-1
RT20-2
G
PO*
PO* RT20-3
DP18 -2
DP1-11
IC1-3 IC10-4
PO
RH24 -2
DP1-23
SO
SO
* NOTE: Color code changed to P VIN 024687 ➞.
16.4
OG
AC14-4
IC1-2
IC10-17 IC10-3
RADIO TELEPHONE
RH24 -1
P
SK
IC1-1
SO
DIMMER OVERRIDE
DP19 -2
DP1-17
AC14-14
SK
SK IC10-18
RU
OP AC14-13
OG IC1-13
RU
DP18 -1
BTS20
ANTENNA MOTOR
10.2
DP19 -1
FC38 -2
NOT USED
IC10-1
O
DIMMER CONTROLLED LIGHTING
NOT USED
BT19-3
I
IC1-11
FC38 -1
NG
58
UW
FC26-20
NOT USED
NO CODE
IC10-11
UW
VEHICLE O SPEED
IC12
B+
I
FC25-47
IC13
WY
22
C –
Fig. 16.1
Standard In-Car Entertainment: Convertible
55 E
I
Fig. 01.4 1 Fig. 01.5
CE2
18 I
Input
O
Output
D
Serial and Encoded Com m unications
Signal Ground (SG)
C
CAN (Netw ork)
S
SCP Netw ork
Fig. 02.1
V ARIAN T: Convert ible V ehicles V IN RAN GE: 018108 DATE OF ISSU E: FEBRU ARY 1998
➞
XK8 Range 1998
Standard In-Car Entertainment: Coupe
Fig. 16.2
Standard In-Car Entertainment: Coupe
* NOTE: Coupe Connector code changed to RH30 VIN 024687 ➞.
RADIO ANTENNA CAN
19.1
CAN
19.1
Y
C +
45
C –
22
NP
FC25-24
IC10-10
G
VEHICLE SPEED
NO CODE
58
UW
FC26-20
IC12
B+
NG
IC1-11
NOT USED BT19-3
I
B
IC10-1
LGB
O
LGB
IC10-5
MAJOR INSTRUMENT PACK
LGB RH1-7
IC2-14
LGB
BT19-6
B
FC38 -2
BT1AL
OP OG
FCS67
DIMMER OVERRIDE
10.2
RU
OG FCS68
IC10-18
IC10-4
IC10-17
RLG
RLG
SO
KG
PO*
PO
16.4
RADIO TELEPHONE
PK
16.4
PK
PR
16.4
UY
16.4
BW
BW RH1-2
KW
KW BG
UY
BG
IC10-12
LGY
LGY IC2-5
RT20-9
KB
IC10-13
KB
MODE
SW4-1 3.3 Κ Ω
SW2-2
PY SC3-2
SW1-2
PY IC2-6
IC1-7
IC10-8
I
BO SW4-2
BO
SWS1
BO
BO SW2-6
FCS28
SW1-6
AC14-12
UP
BK
CD LINK LEAD
FCS48
SC3-12
IC8
IC8-1
UP
UP AC14-11
UP
UG
FC39 -1
FC39 -2
IC7-1
W IC8-2
CAUTION: The Steering Wheel contains two logic ground circuits that must remain separate. Do not connect or cross-switch the BO and BK circuits.
G DD1-23
P DD1-17
IC7
O
FC3BL
STEERING WHEEL
FCS27
IC1-15
K DD1-11
UG
UG
IC1-14
CASSETTE
RADIO CONTROL SWITCHES
AC14-2
UG
VOLUME -
O DD1-12
PK
PK IC1-10
IC10-7
20 Κ Ω
PO AC14-1
IC1-9
PK
VOLUME +
RH1-3
PO
PO IC10-6
6.8 Κ Ω
KP
IC1-8
IC10-9
SEEK
RH1-4
KP
KP
IC10-2
BS
BS
BS PY
RH27-2
RH1-6
IC1-19
CASSETTE
NOT USED
BY
BY
RADIO TELEPHONE CIRCUIT
RH27-1
RH1-5
IC1-18
PY
NOT USED
RH26-2
RH1-12
IC1-17
IC2-4
RH26-1
RH1-20
IC1-16 IC10-16
UY
LGY
16.4
KG RH1-1
IC1-4
IC10-19
IC10-15
IC2-3
RT20-7
RADIO TELEPHONE
DP1-12
KG
PR
PR RT20-1
RADIO TELEPHONE
O
SO AC14-3
PK IC2-2
RT20-2
RADIO TELEPHONE
IC10-14
K DP1-11
IC1-3
BW
PO* IC2-1
RT20-3
*RH30 *RH30 -1 -2
DP18 -2
DP1-23
AC14-4
IC1-2
IC10-20
RADIO TELEPHONE
RH24 -2
G
OG SK
IC1-1
SO
* NOTE: Color code changed to P VIN 024687 ➞.
RH24 -1
DP1-17
AC14-14
SK
SK IC10-3
DP19 -2
P
OP AC14-13
OG IC1-13
RU
DP18 -1
OP
OP IC1-12
10.2
DP19 -1
NOT USED
BT19-4
BT1-20
FC38 -1
BTS20
ANTENNA MOTOR
DIMMER CONTROLLED LIGHTING
PASSENGER SIDE REAR QUARTER FULL RANGE
IC10-11
UW
O
IC13
WY
I
FC25-47
PASSENGER DOOR FULL RANGE
B+
IC7-2
DD18 -1
DD18 -2
NOT USED
*RH31 *RH31 -1 -2 DD19 -1
DD19 -2
RH25 -1
RH25 -2
R IC8-3
NOT USED
IC7-3
G IC8-4
IC7-4
B IC8-5
IC7-5
DRIVER DOOR FULL RANGE
U IC8-6
IC7-6
Y IC8-7
IC7-7
* NOTE: Coupe Connector code changed to RH30 VIN 024687 ➞.
B IC8-8
IC7-8
CD AUTO-CHANGER
BRD
RADIO / CASSETTE HEAD UNIT
1
6
7
51
Fig. 01.2
Fig. 01.1 1 II
5 E
52
81
Fig. 01.3
6
38
II
II
39 E
55 E
1 Fig. 01.5
CE2
I
Fig. 01.4 18 I
DRIVER SIDE REAR QUARTER FULL RANGE
Input
O
Output
D
Serial and Encoded Com m unications
Signal Ground (SG)
C
CAN (Netw ork)
S
SCP Netw ork
Fig. 02.1
V ARIAN T: Coupe V ehicles V IN RAN GE: 018108 DATE OF ISSU E: FEBRU ARY 1998
➞
XK8 Range 1998
Premium In-Car Entertainment
Fig. 16.3
Premium In-Car Entertainment
* NOTE: Coupe Connector code changed to RH30 VIN 024687 ➞.
RADIO ANTENNA CAN
19.1 19.1
B+
WY
22
G
B+
I
C –
PASSENGER SIDE SQUAWKER (FASCIA)
IC12
IC13
IC10-10
C + FC25-24
CAN
NP
45
Y
NO CODE
PASSENGER DOOR TWEETER
PASSENGER DOOR MID-BASS
PASSENGER SIDE REAR QUARTER MID-RANGE
IC10-11
FC25-47
NG
58 UW
UW
O
VEHICLE SPEED
IC1-11
FC26-20
BT19-3
B
I IC10-1
LGB
O IC10-5
LGB IC2-14
LGB RH1-7
LGB
BT19-6 BT19-4
BT1-20
10.2
DIMMER OVERRIDE
10.2
RU
RU
RLG
RLG
NG
B+
IC18-6
60
NG
B+
IC18-16
RADIO TELEPHONE
16.4
RADIO TELEPHONE
16.4
RADIO TELEPHONE
16.4
RADIO TELEPHONE
16.4
PO
PO*
PK IC2-2
RT20-2
PR
B
UY IC2-4
RT20-7
Y
IC10-12
LGY
LGY
I
R
SW4-1 3.3 Κ Ω
MODE
SW1-2
SW2-2
PY
SC3-2
IC2-6
IC18-7
IC18-17
RH1-12
IC1-17
RH26-1
RH26-2
RH26-2
RH27-1
RH27-1
RH27-2
RH27-2
IC10-2
CD LINK LEAD
VOLUME +
IC8
20 Κ Ω
RH1-5
IC1-18
BY
BY
BY
6.8 Κ Ω
KB
KB
KB IC18-8
IC18-18
RH1-6
IC1-19
IC7
DRIVER SIDE REAR SUB-WOOFER (CONVERTIBLE)
O IC8-1
CASSETTE
BO
RADIO CONTROL SWITCHES
RH26-1
BG
BG
BG
BRD
I
SEEK
VOLUME -
RH1-20
IC1-16
I IC17-1
IC14-5
CASSETTE
KW
KW
KW
I IC17-6
IC14-4
PY
PASSENGER SIDE REAR SUB-WOOFER (CONVERTIBLE)
IC17-3
U
RADIO TELEPHONE CIRCUIT
PY
BW RH1-2
IC1-4
G
IC10-13 IC14-3
PY
KG RH1-1
IC17-7
IC14-2
IC2-5
RT20-9
O DP1-12
BW
BW IC18-3
SW4-2
BO
BO
SWS1
SW2-6
SW1-6
IC7-1
W
BK
BO FCS48
SC3-12
IC8-2
IC18-2
IC8-3
FC3BL
IC8-6
IC8-7
UG
UG
FCS27
UP
UP AC14-11
IC1-15
G DD1-23
AC14-12
UP
UP IC18-5
IC8-8
FCS28
IC1-14
IC7-7
B
P DD1-17
IC7-8
B IC17-4
CD AUTO-CHANGER
BRD
B
CE2
B
UP
UG
B
FC39 -1
FC39 -2
IC4-6
IC17-11
RADIO / CASSETTE HEAD UNIT
UG
UG IC18-15
K DD1-11
AC14-2
IC1-10
IC7-6
Y
PK
PK
PK IC18-12
O DD1-12
AC14-1
IC1-9
IC7-5
U
PO
PO
PO IC18-4
IC8-5
RH1-3
IC1-8
IC7-4
B
KP
KP
KP IC18-10
IC8-4
CAUTION: The Steering Wheel contains two logic ground circuits that must remain separate. Do not connect or cross-switch the BO and BK circuits.
RH1-4
IC1-7
IC7-3
G
REAR SUB-WOOFER (COUPE)
BS
BS
BS
IC7-2
R
STEERING WHEEL
RH24 -2 RH30 -2
K
SO
IC1-3
I IC17-2
IC14-1
(CONV.) RH24 -1 * (COUPE) RH30 -1
G
KG
KG IC18-11
DP18 -2
DP19 -2
DP1-11
AC14-3
IC1-2
I IC18-1
IC10-16
UY
LGY
IC14-6
IC2-3
RT20-1
UY
O
IC10-15
PR
PR
IC18-13
DP18 -1
DP19 -1
DP1-23
SK
SO
SO
IC10-14
PK
B
P
OG
AC14-4
IC1-1
R
DP1-17
AC14-14
SK
IC18-14
IC2-1
RT20-3
PK
OG FCS68
IC1-13
SK
PO*
OP AC14-13
OG
OG
IC17-12
16.4
FCS67
IC1-12
IC17-5
IC10-4
* NOTE: Color code changed to P VIN 024687 ➞.
OP
OP
OP 59
FC38 -2
OP OG
IC10-3
RADIO TELEPHONE
FC38 -1
BT1AL
ANTENNA MOTOR
MAJOR INSTRUMENT PACK DIMMER CONTROLLED LIGHTING
B BTS20
DD18 -1
DD18 -2
R
B
DD19 -1
DD19 -2
(CONV.) RH25 -1 * (COUPE) RH31 -1
RH25 -2 RH31 -2
IC4-5
POWER AMPLIFIER BT1CS
DRIVER SIDE SQUAWKER (FASCIA)
DRIVER DOOR TWEETER
DRIVER DOOR MID-BASS
DRIVER SIDE REAR QUARTER MID-RANGE * NOTE: Coupe Connector code changed to RH31 VIN 024687 ➞.
1
6
7
51
Fig. 01.2
Fig. 01.1 1 II
5 E
52
81
Fig. 01.3
6
38
II
II
39 E
55 E
I
Fig. 01.4 1 Fig. 01.5
18 I
Input
O
Output
D
Serial and Encoded Com m unications
Signal Ground (SG)
C
CAN (Netw ork)
S
SCP Netw ork
Fig. 02.1
V ARIAN T: Prem ium ICE V ehicles V IN RAN GE: 018108 DATE OF ISSU E: FEBRU ARY 1998
➞
XK8 Range 1998
Radio Telephone
TELEPHONE ANTENNA
* NOTE: Color code changed to P VIN 024687 ➞.
NP
39
NP
NP
BT20-8
LG
I
PK
RT5-10
LG
LG
PR
RT5-11
UY
RT5-16
LGY
RT4-11
RT4-10
BRD
RT3-1
RT4-12
16.2
16.3
ICE (CIRCUIT CONTINUED)
16.1
16.2
16.3
ICE (CIRCUIT CONTINUED)
16.1
16.2
16.3
ICE (CIRCUIT CONTINUED)
LGY
16.1
16.2
16.3
ICE (CIRCUIT CONTINUED)
RT20-9
RT5-8
B
B
RT6-2
16.1
U
U
RT6-1
BRD
ICE (CIRCUIT CONTINUED)
RT20-7
RT5-15
W
16.3
RT20-1
UY
RT7
16.2
RT20-2
PR
B+ RT2-2
16.1
RT20-3
PK
B+
RT20-10
PO*
RT5-5
RT2-3
21
PO
B+ RT2-10
RTS2
NP
RT4-6
RT3-2
RT5-13
W
R RT4-2
RT3-3
RT5-7
BRD RT5-1
SR
Y RT4-3
RT3-4
RT5-4
SO
O RT4-4
RT3-5
RT5-3
SY
N RT4-5
RT3-6
RT2-8
W
G RT4-1
RT3-7
RT5-12
SK
W RT4-9
RT3-10
RT5-14
G
P RT4-7
BRD
RT3-8
RT2-6
B BRD S
RT5-6
O
RT4-8
RT3-9
RT2-1
HANDSET Y RF9-1
Y RF1-17
RF9-2
Y RT20-4
BRD
RT2-11
BRD RF1-18
BRD RT20-5
RT2-12
MICROPHONE
B RT2-4
B RTS3
RT2-9
B
TELEPHONE TRANSCEIVER RT20-6
RADIO TELEPHONE CIRCUIT
B FC2CS (FC4CS)
1
6
7
51
Fig. 01.2
Fig. 01.1 1 II
5 E
52
81
Fig. 16.4
Radio Telephone
Fig. 01.3
6
38
II
II
39 E
55 E
I
Fig. 01.4 1 Fig. 01.5
18 I
Input
O
Output
D
Serial and Encoded Com m unications
Signal Ground (SG)
C
CAN (Netw ork)
S
SCP Netw ork
Fig. 02.1
V ARIAN T: All V ehicles V IN RAN GE: 018108 DATE OF ISSU E: FEBRU ARY 1998
➞
XK8 Range 1998
SERIAL COMMUNICATION
Airbag System
R
19.1
Airbag System
D FC29-6
WG
15
NOTE: This symbol represents a shorting bar used to short terminals together when the connector is separated.
B+
II
FC29-7
RW
13
O FC30-7 FUSE BLOW
O
KN
FC30-3
SO SW10-3
SW11-3 CASSETTE
FUSE BLOW SWITCH
DRIVER SIDE AIRBAG
CAUTION: Do not substitute another fuse value for the Airbag System 10A Battery fuse.
RP
O
R
FC30-2
SW10-1
SW11-1 CASSETTE
RW
14
I FC30-8
STEERING WHEEL SAFING SENSOR
O
RG
FC30-5
RG FC74-1
RW
12
PASSENGER SIDE AIRBAG
DEPLOYMENT POWER ENERGY RESERVE
RW
KP
O
KP
FC30-4
FC40-1
RS
FC74-3
O FC30-11
FC40-2
YW FC40-4
BK FC40-3
AIRBAG INTERROGATION CONNECTOR
MAJOR INSTRUMENT PACK: AIRBAG FAILURE (CIRCUIT CONTINUED)
FC29-12
YW
08.1
YW
FC30-10
O
FCS64
LF51-2
LF2-5
FC29-9
BK
KU OP
OP
I
LF51-1
LF2-4
KU
I
FC29-5
ON
ON
I
RH IMPACT SENSOR
LF51-4
LF2-6
I FC29-4
YU
I FC29-11
BK
FCS45
I
KG
I FC30-9
FC30-12
LF50-1
KG LF50-2
LF2-2
OW
I
BK
YU LF2-1
FC29-8
OW LF50-4
LF2-3
FC1S
AIRBAG / SRS CONTROL MODULE
1
6
7
51
Fig. 01.2
Fig. 01.1 1 II
5 E
52
81
Fig. 01.3
6
38
II
II
39 E
55 E
I
Fig. 01.4 1 Fig. 01.5
18 I
Input
O
Output
D
Serial and Encoded Com m unications
Signal Ground (SG)
C
CAN (Netw ork)
S
SCP Netw ork
Fig. 02.1
LH IMPACT SENSOR
WARNING: DO NOT ATTEMPT TO REPLACE THE AIRBAG SYSTEM 10A BATTERY FUSE UNLESS THE AIRBAG SYSTEM HAS BEEN DEACTIVATED. WARNING: DO NOT ATTEMPT TO MEASURE THE RESISTANCE THROUGH THE AIRBAG ASSEMBLY. DOING SO MAY TRIGGER AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT AND POSSIBLY RESULT IN PERSONAL INJURY.
V ARIAN T: All V ehicles V IN RAN GE: 018108 DATE OF ISSU E: SEPTEM BER 1997
➞
Fig. 17.1
XK8 Range 1998
Ancillaries
NB
15
YB
B+ FC14-80
HP1
#11 10A
LF14
B GU
SW2-1
GU
SW1-1
LFS8
FC14-4
4
3
5
1
2
YW #13 10A
CASSETTE
BK
BK
HP3
SW2-5
BK
4
BK
BK
SCS1
SW1-5
LF7-5
RH HORN
GS
HORN RELAY (#6)
HORN SWITCHES
FC3BL
GS
O
STEERING WHEEL
YW
23
B
WU
B
I
LF16
ENGINE COMPARTMENT FUSE BOX
FC14-70
FC42-2
B LFS9
LF60-14
FC42-1
CIGAR LIGHTER
LF17
LF2BR
POWER
CAUTION: The steering wheel contains two logic ground circuits that must remain separate. Do not connect or cross-switch the BO and BK circuits.
LF15
LF1AL
LF6-6
HORN CONTROL
FCS48
SC2-9
B
I
SC3-1
GU HP2
YB
LF7-1
CASSETTE
GU
Fig. 18.1
Ancillaries
LH HORN LOGIC
BODY PROCESSOR MODULE
CIGAR LIGHTER
HORNS
NLG
27
BT25-1
PN #11 10A
PN
BT12-1
BTS38
BT25-3
B 1
3
5
2
1
NR
17
RF10-2
RF11-1
RF10-1
RF11-2
BT25-2 #13
1
TRUNK ACCESSORY CONNECTOR
BT12-5
BT2BR
WN
13 I
BT11-6
ACCESSORY CONNECTOR RELAY (#6)
TRUNK FUSE BOX
BK NLG
28
BK
RFS1
FC51-1
PN
PN BT58-1
PN FC51-3
RH14-1
B
FASCIA ACCESSORY CONNECTOR
RF1-3
GARAGE DOOR OPENER
BK
FC51-2 FC2BL (FC4BL)
FC3BR
ROOF CONSOLE
GARAGE DOOR OPENER
ACCESSORY CONNECTORS
1
6
7
51
Fig. 01.2
Fig. 01.1 1 II
5 E
52
81
Fig. 01.3
6
38
II
II
39 E
55 E
I
Fig. 01.4 1 Fig. 01.5
18 I
Input
O
Output
D
Serial and Encoded Com m unications
Signal Ground (SG)
C
CAN (Netw ork)
S
SCP Netw ork
Fig. 02.1
V ARIAN T: All V ehicles V IN RAN GE: 018108 DATE OF ISSU E: SEPTEM BER 1997
➞
B FCS49
FC4BR (FC2BR)
XK8 Range 1998
+
C
–
C
Y LF37-5
Y LF40-3
G LF37-15
C +
+
C
C –
–
C
EM7-83
Y
AJ26 N/A
Y
G
AJ26 N/A
G
EM7-82
C +
+
C
C –
–
C
Y
EM10-26
EM7-86
G LF40-4
Netw orks; Serial Data Links
EM10-28
EM1-6
EM10-27
C +
+
C
C –
–
C
FC88-9
G
WU
6
FC25-24
II
C –
WN
I
ABS / TRACTION CONTROL CONTROL MODULE
TRANSMISSION CONTROL MODULE: AJ26 N/A
ENGINE CONTROL MODULE
FC53-8
WO
4
GEAR SELECTOR ILLUMINATION MODULE
II +
FC53-1
Y
C
Y
C + FC53-6
FC25-23 +
Y
C LF37-5
–
Y
G
C LF37-15
Y
AJ26 SC
–
G
G
G
C – FC53-14
FC25-48
CONTROLLER AREA NETWORK (CAN)
AJ26 SC
EMS52
LF40-4
G
C
EMS53
LF40-3
B+ FC53-9
18
FC25-47
FC88-8
B+ FC53-16
C +
G
FC88-3
EM1-7
NY
24
Y
FC88-4
G
EM10-25
EM7-85
Y
Fig. 19.1
Netw orks; Serial Data Links
ABS / TRACTION CONTROL CONTROL MODULE
+
Y
C
U
EM72-H –
G
C
S – FC25-20
S
S + FC25-19
EM72-L
TRANSMISSION CONTROL MODULE: AJ26 SC
MAJOR INSTRUMENT PACK NOTE: Circuit introduced VIN 024687 ➞.
–
U
S FC14-84
+
S
S
U
FC14-85
S – FC53-10
S
BODY PROCESSOR MODULE
–
U
S
U
BT40-16
U
BT1-10
S
+ S
U SP1-3
S
BT1-11
U
FCS11
RH2-11
S
BT40-8
S
S
FCS12
RH2-12
S –
S
+
S
SP1-8
S + SP5-9
PASSENGER SEAT CONTROL MODULE
U
U
DP10-9
U
ACS5
U
U
S
S
ACS6
S
S
+
S
P
EM11-3
EM13-2
D FC53-12
EM1-5
W
D
S –
S
W
D FC53-13
EM1-20
S + ENGINE CONTROL MODULE
SD5-9
SD1-8
PASSENGER DOOR CONTROL MODULE
S
P
D
SD5-10
SD1-3
AC14-9
DP1-3
FCCP
VFP
U
AC14-8
DP1-8
S DP10-16
–
NOTE: FCCP – Flash Communication Control Port; VFP – Voltage, Flash Programming
SP5-10
SECURITY AND LOCKING CONTROL MODULE
–
S + FC53-2
DRIVER SEAT CONTROL MODULE
U
SERIAL OUTPUT
U
DD10-9
STANDARD CORPORATE PROTOCOL NETWORK (SCP)
S
DD10-16
D FC53-3
FC29-6
DD1-8
S
R
D
DD1-3
AIRBAG / SRS CONTROL MODULE
DRIVER DOOR CONTROL MODULE
K
D FC53-15
O
D FC53-7
K
K
D BT69-28
O
O
BT2-20
BT69-10
O
FCS16
RH12-5
D
K
K
EM10-12
O
D
K
EM10-13
O
O AC14-6
7
51
Fig. 01.2
Fig. 01.1 II
5 E
D AC4-21
SERIAL DATA LINK
ENGINE CONTROL MODULE
1
D
O
EM1-2
52
81
Fig. 01.3
6
38
II
II
39 E
55 E
1 Fig. 01.5
AIR CONDITIONING CONTROL MODULE
I
Fig. 01.4 18 I
FC3BL
AC4-10
AC14-5
FC53-5
BK
K
EM1-1
BK
FCS48
KEY TRANSPONDER MODULE
D
6
FC53-4
FC22-6
ADAPTIVE DAMPING CONTROL MODULE
1
BK
NOTE: Serial Data Link: K wire – serial input O wire – serial output O wire only – Bidirectional Serial Communication
FCS15
RH12-4
BT2-19
O
D
K
Input
O
Output
D
Serial and Encoded Com m unications
Signal Ground (SG)
C
CAN (Netw ork)
S
SCP Netw ork
Fig. 02.1
V ARIAN T: All V ehicles V IN RAN GE: 018108 DATE OF ISSU E: FEBRU ARY 1998
➞
DATA LINK CONNECTOR
CONTROL
MODULE
PIN OUT INFORMATION
BODY PROCESSOR MODULE ‘;i Pin Description I FC14~15 IGNITION SWITCHED GROUND SUPPLY 1 FCi432 IGNITION SWlTCHED GROUND SUPPLY 0 FC14-97 RELAY COILDR,“E
COMPONENTS Active GROUND GROUND
Inactive GROUND
Component BATTERY
Location I Access TRUNK,RlGHTHANDSlDE
BODYPROCESSOR MCIDIJLE FUSEBOX- DRl”ERSlDE
PASSENGER SIDEFASCIA,AIRBAG BRACKET F*sCIA!DRlVER SlDE
Color / Stripe BROWN BROWN BRCJWN BRcwm BROWN HARNESS-TO-HARNESS Connector
Connector BUS BUS BUS BUS BUS
/ Color
Location I Access PASSENGER SlDEFUSEBOX ENGlNE MANAGEMENT FUSEBOX DRi”ERSIDEFUSEBOX ENGINE CclMPARTMENT FUSEBOX TRUNKFUSEBOX
CONNECTORS
Type / Color
Location / Access TRUNK,ABOVE RGHTHANDREARWHEEL ARCH TRANSMlSSlON TUNNEL ENGINE COMPARTMENT, FALSE BULKHEAD. RlGHTHANDSIDE TRANSMlSSiON TUNNEL TRANSMiSSlON TUNNEL TRANSMISSIDN TUNNEL REAROFCENTER CONSOLE ASSEMBLY ENGINE CCJMPARTMENT, FALSE B”LKHEAD, RIGHTHANDSIDE
GROUNDS Location I Type BATERYGROUND STUD EYELET (PAIR,- RIGHTHANDLEG/TRUNK,RIGHTREAR EYELET WNGLEI/TRUNK,RIGHTREAR
Ground ST68 BTZBR BTlBS CONTROL
MODULE
PIN OUT INFORMATION
(FOLD OUT PAGE1
+
The following
symbols
are used to represent
I Input 0 output SG Signal Ground CAUTION: The information REFERENCE ONLY.
D C S
values for Control
Serial and encoded CAN (Network) SCP Network
communications
on this data page is furnished
NOTE: The values listed are approximately components connected and fitted. “Active”
Module
Pin Out data: B+ V Hz
Battery voltage Voltage (DC) Frequency
to aid the user in understanding
circuit operation.
KHz MS MV
Frequency x 1000 Milliseconds Millivolts
THIS INFORMATION
SHOULD BE USED FOR
those that can be expected at the control module connector pins with all circuit connections made and all means a load is applied or a switch is ON; “Inactive” means a load is not applied or a switch is OFF.
REFER TO THE FRONT OF THE BOOK FOR ILLUSTRATIONS DETAILING THE LOCATION AND IDENTIFICATION CONNECTORS, HARNESSES, GROUNDS, VEHICLE CONTROL MODULES AND CONTROL MODULE PINS. DATE
OF ISSUE:
FEBRUARY
1998
OF COMPONENTS,
RELAYS.
COMPONENTS Component FUSEBOX- ILlRIVER SlDE
Connector / Type / Color FE/ IO~WAY UT A. FUSEBOX I NATURAL KS, IO-WAY u T A. FUSEBOX! BLACK FC90,EYELET FC92,EYELET
Location / Access FASClA,DRIVER SlDE
FUSE BOX- PASSENGER SIDE
FC20 /lo-WAY FC21 I l&WAY FC90 ‘EYELET
FASClA, PFISSENGER SIDE
HARNESS-TO-HARNESS
“.T A. FUSEBOX, WT A. FUSEBOX,
NATVRAL BLACK
CONNECTORS
Connector AC12 AC13 AC14 ACli AC16 BE BT58 DD1 DP1 IC2
Type I Color zo-WAYMULTILOCK 070I WHITE Z&WAYMULTlLOCK 070/YELLOW 14-WAY MULTILOCK 070,GREY ?O-WAY M”LTlLOCK 070,GREY G~WAY MULTILOCK 070‘YELLOW ZO-WAY MtJLTlLOCK 070:WHlTE I-WAYECONOSEAL 111 tic, BLACK 23WAYAMP FORD,BLACK X-WAYAMP- FORD,BLACK 14~WAY MVLTlLOCK 070/WHITE
Location / Access FASCIATOP CONNECTOR MOUNTING BRACKET, RIGHTHANDSIDE FASCIA BOTTOM CONNECTOR MOUNTlNG BRACKET, RIGHTHANDSIDE FASCIA BOTTOM CONNECTOR MOUNTlNG BRACKET! RIGHTHANDSIDE FASCIA BOTTOM CONNECTOR MOLJNTlNG BRACKET! RIGHTHANDSlDE LEFTHAND’KPOSTCONNECTOR MOUNTlNG BRACKET,‘NPOSTTRlM TRUNK/ABOVERIGHTHANDREARWHEEL ARCH TRUNK/ABOVERIGHTHANDREARWHEEL ARCH DRIVER SlDE‘N POSTMOUNTING BRACKET/APOSTTRlM PASSENGER SIDE’NPOSTI’WPOSTTRlM
iF1
PO-WAY MULTILOCK
070,
GREY
LEFT HAND
RF,
18.WAY
070,
YELLOW
RlGHT
RH14
?-WAY
RH2
*o-WAY
SD1
B-WAY MULTILOCK
070:
SP1
*-WAY
070 iYELLOW
MULTILOCK ECONOSEAL MULTILOCK MULTILOCK
BELOW
CENTER HAND
CONSOLE
GLOVE
‘K POST CONNECTOR ‘K POST CONNECTOR
BOX MOUNTING MOUNTING
/II HC, BLACK
REAR OF CENTER
CONSOLE
ASSEMBLY
070 /WHITE
REAR OF CENTER
CONSOLE
ASSEMBLY
YELLOW
BELOW
DRIVER SEAT
BELOW
PASSENGER
BRACKET! BRACKET,‘K
‘fl
POST TRIM POSTTRlM
SEAT
REFER TO THE FRONT OF THE BOOK FOR ILLUSTRATIONS DETAILING THE LOCATION AND IDENTIFICATION CONNECTORS, HARNESSES, GROUNDS, VEHICLE CONTROL MODULES AND CONTROL MODULE PINS. DATE
OF ISSUE:
FEBRUARY
1998
OF COMPONENTS,
RELAYS,
COMPONENTS Component
Connector
I Type I Color
Location
/ Access
FUSE BOX-ENGINE
COMPARTMENi
ENGlNE COMPARTMENT,
LEFT FRONT
FUSE BOX-ENGINE
MAIN*GEMENT
ENGINE COMPARTMENT,
CONTROL MODULE ENCLOSURE
FUSE BOX-TRUNK
HARNESS-TO-HARNESS Connector iC4
CONNECTORS
Type / Color 4-WAYM”LT,LOCK 070,WHITE
Location
/ Access
TRUNKiLEFTOFANTENNAASSEMBLY
REFER TO THE FRONT OF THE BOOK FOR ILLUSTRATIONS DETAILING THE LOCATION AND IDENTIFICATION CONNECTORS, HARNESSES, GROUNDS, VEHICLE CONTROL MODULES AND CONTROL MODULE PINS. DATE
OF ISSUE:
FEBRUARY
1998
OF COMPONENTS,
RELAYS,
COMPONENTS Component
Connector/Type
/ Color
FUSE BOX-DRIVER
SlDE
FC5,lO-WAY ” T A. FUSEBOX, RX, 10.WAY ” T A. FVSEBOX FC90, EYELET FC!3Z, EYELET
FUSE BOX - ENGlNE
COMPARTMENT
LF5,lO~WAY”TA FUSEBOX’NATURAL LF6: IO-WAY “.T A F”SEBOX,‘BLACK LF7/10-WAY ” T A FUSEBOX! GREEN LFB! 10.WAY “.T.A FUSEBOX, BL”E iF70, EYELET
Location
NATURAL ! BLACK
FASCIA,
ENGlNE
FUSE BOX - PASSENGER SIDE
BTIO BTlt BT12 BT13 *Tel,
HARNESS-TO-HARNESS
SIDE
COMPARTMENT,
I_10.WAY i ?&WAY I_10.WAY i IO-WAY EYELET
L. T A. U T A. U T A. U.T.A.
FUSEBOX, FUSEBOX, FUSEBOX FUSEBOX
NATURAL BLACK I GREEN ! BLUE
TRUNK
i ELECTRICAL
Location
/ Access
FASCIA
BOTTOM
ENGINE
COMPARTMENT
CONNECTOR
GLOVE
BRACKET,
TO RIGHT HAND
BELOW
CENTER
COMPARTMENT,
LEFT HAND
ENCLOSURE
ENGINE
COMPARTMENT
i LEFT HAND
ENCLOSURE
RIGHT
CONSOLE
MOUNTING
I ADJACENT
ENGINE
LEFT HAND
‘N POST CONNECTOR
COMPARTMENT, HAND’K
BRACKET
POST CONNECTOR
RIGHT
HAND
SlDE
ENCLOSURE
BOX
MO”NTlNG
BRACKET,‘K
POSTTRlM
ON TOP OF TRANSMlSSlON MOUNTING
BRACKET,‘N
POSTTRIM
REFER TO THE FRONT OF THE BOOK FOR ILLUSTRATIONS DETAILING THE LOCATION AND IDENTIFICATION CONNECTORS, HARNESSES, GROUNDS, VEHICLE CONTROL MODULES AND CONTROL MODULE PINS. OF ISSUE:
FEBRUARY
CARRIER
CONNECTORS
Type / Color
ENGINE
DATE
LEFT FRONT
FASCIA, PASSENGER SIDE
FUSE BOX-TRUNK
Connector
I Access
DRl”ER
1998
OF COMPONENTS,
RELAYS,
COMPONENTS Component FUSE BOX-ENGINE
Connector MANAGEMENT
EM19, IO-WAY EM20,10-WAY EM70, EYELET
HARNESS-TO-HARNESS
I Type / Color U.T.A. “.T.A
FUSEBOX, FUSEBOX,
Location
NATURAL BLACK
ENGINE
/ Access
COMPARTMENT/CONTROL
Type / Color
LF3
1%WAY
ECONOSEAL
Lw.0
13WAY
PI,
57.WAY
B-WAY ECONOSEAL
Location 111LC, BLACK
/ Access
ENGINE
COMPARTMENT,
RIGHT HAND
111LC, WHITE
ENGINE
COMPARTMENT,
LEFT HAND
ENCLOSURE
ENCLOSURE
ECONOSEAL
111LC, BLACK
ENGINE
COMPARTMENT,
LEFT HAND
ENCLOSURE
SUMITOMO,
BLACK
ENGINE
COMPARTMENT,
BRACKETON
TOP OFTRANSMlSSlON
REFER TO THE FRONT OF THE BOOK FOR ILLUSTRATIONS DETAILING THE LOCATION AND IDENTIFICATION CONNECTORS, HARNESSES, GROUNDS, VEHICLE CONTROL MODULES AND CONTROL MODULE PINS. OF ISSUE:
ENCLOSURE
CONNECTORS
Connector EL1
DATE
MODULE
FEBRUARY
1998
OF COMPONENTS,
RELAYS,
COMPONENTS Component ,GNlTlON INERTlA
SWITCH
Connector (KEY-IN
SWlTCHj
FC4,8
SWITCH
FC46 /SWAY
HARNESS-TO-HARNESS
Location
/ Type / Color
WAY MULTILOCK
070,
ECONOSEAL
STEERING
WHITE
ADJACENTTO
111LC i BLACK
/ Access COLUMN LEFT HAND
FASCIA
FVSE BOX
CONNECTORS
Connector AC13
Type / Color 2O~WA:y MVLTiLOCK
070 / YELLOW
FASCIA
BOTTOM
BT1
ZO-WAY MVLTlLOCK
070,
TRUNK
ABOVE
LFSO
2O~WAY MVLTILOCK
070! WHITE
LEFT HAND
RH2
20.WAY
070,
REAR OF CENTER
MULTiLOCK
Location WHlTE WHITE
/ Access CONNECTOR RIGHT
HAND
MOUNTlNG REAR WHEEL
‘A’ POST CONNECTOR CONSOLE
MOUNTlNG
BRACKET,
RIGHT
HAND
SIDE
ARCH BRACKET:‘A’POSTTR,M
ASSEMBLY
GROUNDS Ground
Location
FC3BL
EYELET
/ Type
(PAIR) - LEFT HAND
LEG i TRANSMISSION
TUNNEL.
LEFT HAND
SIDE
REFER TO THE FRONT OF THE BOOK FOR ILLUSTRATIONS DETAILING THE LOCATION AND IDENTIFICATION CONNECTORS, HARNESSES, GROUNDS, VEHICLE CONTROL MODULES AND CONTROL MODULE PINS. DATE
OF ISSUE:
FEBRUARY
1998
OF COMPONENTS,
RELAYS,
CONTROL
MODULE
PIN OUT INFORMATION
BODY PROCESSOR MODULE ‘J Pin Description I FC14~7 NEUTRAL SWITCH STATVS D
FC14-39
SECURITY
COMPONENTS Inactive BTiP,R.D,4.3,21
Active GROUND
ACKNOWLEDGE
(Ni
ENCODED
Component
Connector
BATTERY
BT66, BT67,
COMMUNlCATlDNS
Location
/ Type I Color
TRUNK.
EYELET EYELET
/ Access
RlGHT
HAND
SIDE
I
FC14-4,
STARTER
ENGAGE
GROUND
CRANKING)
BL
BODY PROCESSOR
MODULE
FC,4,104-WAYAMPEEEC,GREY
PASSENGER
0
FC14-73
STARTER
RELAY ACTIVATE
GROUND
,CRANKlNG,
EL
ENGINE
MODULE
ENGINE
COMPARTMENT/CONTROL
1
FC14~80
BATTERY
SUPPLY
B+
B+
D
FC14-92
ENCODED
EM10,28-WAY EMI1 ,16-WAY EM,2,22-WAY EM13,34-WAY EM,4,12-WAY EM15,22-WAY
ENGINE
COMPARTMENT,
Active
Inactive GROUND
REOUEST VOLTAGE
CONTROL
COMMUNICATIONS
ENGINE CONTROL MODULE 3 Pin Description D EM10-6 OKTO STARTENCODED
GENERATOR
HlGH POWER PROTECTION
COMMUNlCATlONS
I D
EM10-15 EM10-17
PARK ’ NEUTRAL CONFIRMATION SECURlTYACKNOWLEDGE
B+ IP, Nl ENCODED
/
EM,,-6
ENGINE
GROUND
COMMUNICATIONS ,GNlTlDN
CRANK
B+
,CRANKlNGi
SWITCH
v
MODULE
Pin
Description
D
FCZ2-9
GLASS
D
FCZ2-16
OK TO START
D
X22-17
SECURlTYACKNOWLEDGE
OK TO START
(ENCODED
IENCODED
Inactive
STARTER
FC89,
J-WAY
MULTILOCK
ST2, ST3, ST,0
MOTOR
AN3,
MODULE
STEERING
070 /WHITE
MVLTILOCK
P150, S-WAY SUMlTOMO
(GENERATOR)
SUPPRESSlON
MULTILOCK
FC22 IZO-WAY
COMMUNICATION)
COMMUNICATION, (ENCODED
FC4, E-WAY
SWITCH,
MODULE
SWlTCH
REGULATOR
Active
BREAKAGE,
(KEY-IN
KEYTRANSPONDER
TRUNK,ADJACENTTO
BT60, EYELET BTB, , EYELET BT62, EYELET BT63! EYELET
MODULE
~R.D.4.3.21
NEUTRAL
KEY TRANSPONDER
MULTILOCK 040, GREY MULTlLOCK 010,GREY MULTILOCK 040,GREY MULTlLOCK 040, GREY MULTlLOCK 47,WHlTE MULTlLOCK47IWHITE
SlDE FASCIA,
040, 070, 0902,
P-WAY ECDNOSEAL
RIGHT
ENCLOSURE
FRONT
DRIVER SIDE FUSE BOX
GEAR SELECTOR
BLACK
ENGINE
COMPARTMENT,
ENGINE
BLOCK
REARWARD
111LC, RED
MODULE
BATTERY
GREY
EYELET EYELET , EYELET
BRACKET
COLUMN
ADJACENTTO
GREEN
AlRBAG
ASSEMBLY GENERATOR
OF RIGHT FRONT
HEADLAMP
COMMUNICATION)
RELAYS Relay
Color / Stripe
Connector
STARTERRELAY
BROWN
EMX,
HARNESS-TO-HARNESS
Location
I Color
/ Access
RH ENCLOSURE
BROWN
RELAYS
CONNECTORS
Connector
Type / Color
Location
BT80
EYELET
ENGlNE
COMPARTMENT,
I Access
EM1
PO-WAY MULTILOCK
070,
WHITE
ENGINE
COMPARTMENT,ADJACENTTO
FALSE
BULKHEAD,
RIGHT
HAND
RlGHTHAND
SIDE
ENCLOSURE
EM2
18-WAY
MULTiLOCK
070,
YELLOW
ENGlNE
COMPARTMENTIADJACENTTO
RlGHT
HAND
ENCLOSVRE
EM3
14.WAY
MVLTILOCK
070,
GREY
ENGINE
COMPARTMENTiADJACENTTO
RIGHT
HAND
ENCLOSURE
EM60
Z-WAY
ENGlNE
COMPARTMENT,
BEHIND
PI,
57~WAY SUMITOMO,
ENGiNE
COMPARTMENT,
BRACKET
ST1
EYELET
ENGINE
COMPARTMENT,
FALSE
ECONOSEAL
111HC, BLACK BLACK
LEFT INNER
FENDER
HEAT SHIELD
ON TOP OF TRANSMlSSlON
BULKHEAD,
RIGHT
HAND
SIDE
GROUNDS Ground
Location
BTSB
BATTERY
FCSBR
EYELET
CONTROL
MODULE
I Type
GROUND
STUD
(PAIR) - RIGHT
HAND
LEG /TRANSMISSION
PIN OUT INFORMATION
TUNNEL,
LEFT HAND
SIDE
(FOLD OUT PAGE)
+
The following
symbols
are used to represent
I Input 0 output SG Signal Ground CAUTION: The information REFERENCE ONLY.
D C S
values for Control
Serial and encoded CAN (Network) SCP Network
on this data page is furnished
NOTE: The values listed are approximately components connected and fitted. “Active”
Module
communications
Pin Out data: B+ V Hz
Battery voltage Voltage (DC) Frequency
to aid the user in understanding
circuit operation.
KHz MS MV
Frequency x 1000 Milliseconds Millivolts
THIS INFORMATION
SHOULD BE USED FOR
those that can be expected at the control module connector pins with all circuit connections made and all means a load is applied or a switch is ON; “Inactive” means a load is not applied or a switch is OFF.
REFER TO THE FRONT OF THE BOOK FOR ILLUSTRATIONS DETAILING THE LOCATION AND IDENTlFlCATlON CONNECTORS, HARNESSES, GROUNDS, VEHICLE CONTROL MODULES AND CONTROL MODULE PINS. DATE
OF ISSUE:
FEBRUARY
1998
OF COMPONENTS.
RELAYS,
CONTROL
MODULE
PIN OUT INFORMATION COMPONENTS
BODY PROCESSOR MODULE rCr Pin Description 1 FC14-7 NEUTRAL SWITCH STATUS D
FC14-39
SECURITY
Active GROUND
ACKNOWLEDGE
iN1
ENCODED
Inactive
Component
Connector
E+ IP. R. D. 4.3. 21
BATTERY
BT66, EYELET BT67 i EYELET
COMMUNICATIONS
I
FC14-41
STARTER
ENGAGE
GROUND
iCRANKING
B+
BODY PROCESSOR
0
FC14-73
STARTER
RELAY ACTIVATE
GROUND
(CRANKING1
E+
DUAL
/
FC14~80
BATTERY
SUPPLY
B+
B+
ENGlidE
D
FC14-92
ENCODED
Active
Inactive
GENERATOR
RECIUEST VOLTAGE
FClOO-4
NEUTRAL
0
FC100-5
PARKi
SWITCH
NEUTRAL
SWITCH
COMMON
GROUND
SUPPLY
OK TO START-
iNi
GROUND
CONFIRMATION
B+ (P. R. D. 4. 3. 21 GROUND
MODVLE
B- IP. Nl
HlGH POWER PROTECTION
SWITCH
(KEY-IN
KEYTRANSPONDER
Active
Inactive
B+ iP, Nl
GROUND
REGULATOR STARTER
COMMUNlCATiONS
CONFIRMATION
ACKNOWLEDGE
ENCODED
CRANK
GROUND
MODULE
IR. D. 4. 3. Zi ,GN,TlON
ENCODED
PARK i NEUTRAL
ENGINE
CONTROL
GROUND
GROUND
STATUS
ENGINE CONTROL MODULE v Pin Description
SECURITY
MODULE
SWITCH
COMMUNlCATlONS
DUAL LINEAR SWITCH 77 Pin Description FC100~2 TCM! DUAL LINEAR 0
LINEAR
AMP EEEC,
GREY
MULTTILOCK
070,
12.WAY
PASSENGER LEFT HAND
GREY
SIDE
SIDE FASC,A,AIRBAG
BRACKET
S\DE OF GEAR SELECTOR,
CENTER
COMPARTMENT,
CONTROL
AN, I EYELET AN*, EYELET ST, 1 , EYELET
ENGINE
COMPARTMENT!
RIGHT FRONT
BT60 BT61 BTGZ 8163
TRUNK,
ADJACENT
i EYELET 1 EYELET 1 EYELET ! EYELET
AN3,
MODULE
HAND
ENGlNE
MULTILOCK
WHITE
STEERING
040 I GREEN
ADJACENT
070,
MULTILOCK SUMITOMO
0902,
BLACK
ST2, EYELET ST3, EYELET STlO , EYELET
MOTOR
I Access
RlGHT
EMlO, Z-WAY MVLTlLOCK 040, GREY EM,,, ,S-WAYM”LTlLOCK040,GREY EM12 I Z-WAY MULTILOCK 040, GREY EM,3!34-WAY M”LTlLOCK040,GREY EM14 I 12.WAY MULTILOCK 47 i WHlTE EMIS I 22.WAY MVLTILOCK 47, WHITE
P,50,3WAY
iGENERATOR
SUPPRESSION
FC14 I,01-WAY
FC22 i 20.WAY
IR.D.4.3.21
COMMUNICATIONS
TRUNK,
FC,OO!
FC4,8~WAY
SWITCHI
MODULE
Location
I Type I Color
Z-WAY
ECONOSEAL
CONSOLE ENCLOSURE
TO BATTERY
COLUMN TO DRIVER
SIDE FUSE BOX
ENGlNE
COMPARTMENT/GENERATOR
ENGlNE
BLOCK
REARWARD
111LC: RED
MODULE
OF RIGHT FRONT
HEADLAMP
Bi
iCRANKING)
RELAYS KEY TRANSPONDER v D
Pin FC22~9
MODULE
Relay
Description GLASS
BREAKAGE
D
FCZZ-16
OK TO ST*RT
D
FCZZ-17
SECURITY
Inactive
Active ,OKTO
(ENCODED
ACKNOWLEDGE
STARTIENCODED
ST*.RTER
RELAY
Color / Stripe
Connector
BROWN
EM50,
Location
/ Color
/ Access
RH ENCLOSURE
BROWN
RELAYS
COMM”NlCATlON,
COMMUNICATION) (ENCODED
HARNESS-TO-HARNESS
COMMUNlCATlONi
CONNECTORS
Connector
Type / Color
Location
8180
EYELET
ENGlNE
COMPARTMENT,
EM,
*O-WAY
070 i WHITE
~iuGmE
C~MP*RTMENT,ADJ*CENTTO
RIGHT
EM2
18~WAY MULTILOCK
070,
YELLOW
ENGINE
COMPARTMENT,
EM3
14.WAY
070,
GREY
ENGINE
C~MP*RTMENT/ADJ*CENTTO
EM60
Z-WAY
ENGINE
COMPARTMENT,
BEHlND
PI1
57.WAY
ENGlNE
COMPARTMENT,
BRACKET
ST1
EYELET
ENGINE
COMPARTMENT,
FALSE BULKHEAD,
MULTILOCK MULTILOCK ECONOSEAL
111HC , BLACK
SUMITOMO,
BLACK
I Access FALSE
BULKHEAD,
ADJACENTTO
RlGHT
HAN0
SlDE
HAND
ENCLOSURE
RIGHT
HAND
ENCLOSURE
RIGHT
HAND
ENCLOSURE
LEFT ,NNER
FENDER
HEAT SHIELD
ON TOP OF TRANSMISSION RIGHT HAND
SIDE
GROUNDS Ground
Location
BTBB
BATTERY
EMlAL
EYELET
(PAIR) - LEFT HAND
LEG,
ENGINE
COMPARTMENT,
RIGHT
EMZAL
EYELET
(PAIR) - LEFT HAND
LEG,
ENGINE
COMPARTMENT.
LEFT HAND
CONTROL
The following
symbols
are used to represent
I Input 0 output SG Signal Ground CAUTION: The information REFERENCE ONLY.
D C S
values for Control
Serial and encoded CAN (Network) SCP Network
communications
on this data page is furnished
NOTE: The values listed are approximately ComPonents connected and fitted. “Active”
Module
MODULE
/ Type
GROUND
ST”0
PIN OUT INFORMATION
HAND
ENCLOSURE ENCLOSURE
(FOLD OUT PAGE)
Pin Out data: B+ V Hz
Battery voltage Voltage (DC) Frequency
to aid the user in understanding
circuit operation.
KHz Frequency x 1000 MS Milliseconds MV Millivolts THIS INFORMATION
SHOULD BE USED FOR
those that can be expected at the control module connector pins with all circuit connections made and all means a load is applied or a switch is ON; “Inactive” means a load is not applied or a switch is OFF.
REFER TO THE FRONT OF THE BOOK FOR ILLUSTRATIONS DETAILING THE LOCATION AND IDENTIFICATION CONNECTORS, HARNESSES, GROUNDS, VEHICLE CONTROL MODULES AND CONTROL MODULE PINS. DATE
OF ISSUE:
FEBRUARY
1998
OF COMPONENTS.
RELAYS,
CONTROL
MODULE
ENGINE CONTROL
PIN OUT INFORMATION MODULE
COMPONENTS
Description IGNITION SWiTCHED POWER SUPPLY IGNITION SWITCHED POWER SVPPLY OKTOSTART-ENCODED COMM”NlCATlONS BA”ERYPOWER SUPPLY
Active E+ B+
Inactive 0” B+
B+
BRAKE SWITCH SERIAL COMM”NlCATlONS SERIAL COMM”NlCAT,ONS PARKING BRAKE SWITCH PARK, NEUTRAL CONF,RMAT,ON EMS CONTROLLED RELAYACTlVATE SECURITY ACKNOWLEDGE WTS I ECTS :TPS, MECHANICAL GUARD POSlTlON PEDAL POSITION COMMON REFERENCE GROUND MECHANICAL GUARD POSlTlON, PEDAL POSlTlON! TPS COMMON REFERENCE VOLTAGE GROUND GROUND CAN NETWORK CAN NETWORK CAN NETWORK CAN NETWORK
GROUND
B+ B+
ECM PROGRAMMING ENGINE CRANK FUEL TANK PRESSURE SENSOR FEEDBACK MECHANICAL GUARD POSITION, PEDAL POSlTlON, TPS COMMON REFERENCE VOLTAGE ECT FEEDBACK TPS FEEDBACK TPS FEEDBACK lATS,ECTS,TPS/MECHANlCALG”ARDPOSlTlDN, PEDAL POSITION COMMON REFERENCE GROUND MECHANICAL GUARD POSITION FEEDBACK MECHANICAL GUARD POSITiON / PEDAL POSITION PEDAL POSITION FEEDBACK PEDAL POSITION FEEDBACK
GROUND
/
symbols
I Input 0 output SG Signal Ground CAUTION: The information REFERENCE ONLY.
D C S
GROUND GROUND
B+ GROUND (CRANKING1 4.9” = LOW PRESSURE,
E+ E+ 0 2 ” = HIGH PRESSURE
5v
5v 0.41 V @ 195.F (DECREASING 0.5 v = IDLE. 4.75 V = WOT 0.5 V = IDLE; 4.75 V = WOT GROUND
WITH TEMPERATURE)
GROUND
0.5 V = IDLE. 4.75 V = WOT GROUND 0.5” = IDLE; 4.75 V = WOT 0 5 V = IDLE; 4.75” = WOT
iI -PS SHIELD
GROUND
LF58,
EVAPORATIVE
GROUND GROUND GROUND GROUND GROUND 0 KHz = NO KNOCK, 2 -20 0 KHz = NO KNOCK, 2 - 20 5” @ 1000 RPM = 556 HZ; 5 Hz @ IDLE GROUND 5 V @ 1000 RPM = 566 Hz: GROUND
‘B’ BANK ‘A’ BANK
Serial and encoded CAN (Network) SCP Network
Module
communications
on this data page is furnished
P115, Z-WAY
ECONOSEAL
111HC, BLACK
‘B’ BANK
P14, Z-WAY
VALVE
-A
UPSTREAM
EM21,
HOZS: HEATED
OXYGEN
SENSOR
-B
UPSTREAM
EM23,
KS KNOCK
SENSOR
- B
MASS
025:
OXYGEN
SENSOR-A
OX:
OXYGEN
SENSOR
PARKING
AIR FLOW SENSOR - B DOWNSTREAM
AND MECHANICAL
THRO”LE
MOTOR
THRO”LE
POSITION
GUARD
WHITE
E J2, GREY
ECONOSEAL
REARWARD
OF ROAD WHEEL
CYLINDER
HEAD,
REAR
ENGlNE
COMPARTMENT,
CONTROL
ENGiNE
COMPARTMENT,
REAR OF ENGINE
ENGiNE
COMPARTMENT,
CONTROL
TRUNK
OUARTER,
i FUELTANK
090 II, GREY
‘N BANK
REARWARD
MODULE
CONVERTER
CATALYTIC
CONVERTER
FLANGE
SUMITOMO
090 II, GREY
‘B’ BANK
ECONOSEAL
111LC, BLACK
ENGlNE
“EE,
UNDER
INTAKE
MANIFOLD
P127, Z-WAY
ECONOSEAL
111LC, BLACK
ENGlNE
“EE,
UNDER
INTAKE
MANIFOLD
P135,5-WAY
YAzAKlO902,
ENGlNE
COMPARTMENT,
&WAY
Z-WAY
BLACK
SUMITOMO
090 A TYPE,
‘X BANK
GREY
REARWARD
CATALYTIC
CONVERTER
CATALYTIC
CDNVERTER
OF AIR CLEANER
EM24,2-WAYSUMlTOMO09OATYPE,GREY
‘8’ BANK
FC19,
BELOW
PARKING
ENGlNE
COMPARTMENT/THROTTLE
ASSEMBLY
ENGINE
COMPARTMENT/
THROTTLE
ASSEMBLY
ENGlNE
COMPARTMENT,
THROTLE
ASSEMBLY
BEHlND
RIGHT HAND
LUCAR
RIGHT ANGLE YAZAKI
0902, CLIP,
BLACK BLACK
W/4-WAY
SUMITOMO
- 1
ELZ, Z-WAY
SUMITOMO
090 DC INHIBIT
1, BLUE
090 DC INHIBIT
1 , BROWN
“AC”“,,,
SWlTCHlNG
VALVE
VACUUM
SWITCHING
VALVE
-2
EL3,2-WAY
SUMlTOMO
VACUUM
SWITCHING
VALVE
- 3
EL4,
YAZAKI
*-WAY
TS090,
090,
BLACK
GREY
BRAKE
ARCH LINER
BEHIND
RIGHT HAND
WHEEL
ARCH LINER
BEHIND
RIGHT HAND
WHEEL
ARCH LINER
VALVE:
VARIABLE
VALVE TIMING
SOLENOID
VALVE -A
P131, P-WAY AMP JUNIOR
POWER TIMER,
BLACK
ENGlNE
COMPARTMENTI’K
VVT SOLENOID
VALVE:
VARIABLE
VALVE TiMlNG
SOLENOID
VALVE -B
P132,lWAY
POWER TIMER,
BLACK
ENGlNE
COMPARTMENT,
AMP JUNIOR
LEVER
WHEEL
VVI SOLENOID
ENCLOSURE
OF ROAD WHEEL
EVAPORATIVE
CATALYTIC
ENCLOSURE TOP HOSE
MODULE
Z-WAY
P133, P-WAY TWIN SENSOR
QUARTER!
REAR OF BED PLATE
LH FRONT
BLACK
,,I LC I BLACK
SUMITOMO
P142, I-WAY
SENSORS
J2,
ECONOSEAL
a-WAY
EM22,
DOWNSTREAM
BRAKE SWITCH
PEDAL POSITION
Z-WAY
PIEi
MAFS
070,
ECONOSEAL
BT5,3WAY
SENSOR
SENSOR
SENSOR-A
MULTlLOCK
EM,O,ZB-WAY MULTlLOCK 040,GREY EM,, ,16-WAY MULTiLOCK 040, GREY EM12 122.WAY MULTiLOCK 040, GREY EM,3,34-WAY MULTILOCK040,GREY EM,4:,2-WAYMULTILOCK47,WHlTE EM15,22-WAY MULTlLOCK47,WHlTE
OXYGEN
KS: KNOCK
*-WAY
090,
BANKCYLINDER ‘B’ BANK
CYLiNDER
HEAD,
FRONT
HEAD,
FRONT
GROUND GROUND GROUND
B+ B+ B+ Bt B+ KHz = KNOCK KHz = KNOCK 2000 RPM = 1132 Hz
MOTOR
POWER
RELAY
HARNESS-TO-HARNESS
Color / Stripe
Connector
BROWN
EMIGIBROWN
Location
I Color
CONTROL
ENCLOSURE
RELAYS
CONNECTORS
Connector AC13
Type / Color
BT2
Location
I Access
070 iYELLOW
FASClA
BOTTOM
PO-WAY MULTILOCK
070,
TRUNK,
ABOVE
EL,
B-WAY ECONOSEAL
111LC, BLACK
ENGINE
COMPARTMENT/RIGHT
EM1
X-WAY
MULTlLOCK
070 /WHITE
ENGINE
COMPARTMENTIADJACENTTO
LF3
,3-WAY
ECONOSEAL
11, LC, WHITE
ENGlNE
COMPARTMENT,
LEFT HAND
ENCLOSURE
111LC, BLACK
ENGlNE
COMPARTMENT,
LEFT HAND
ENCLOSURE
20.WAY
I Access MODULE
M”LT,LOCK
WHITE
CONNECTOR RIGHT
HAND
MO”NT,NG
BRACKET,
REAR WHEEL HAND
RIGHT
RIGHT
HAND
ENCLOSURE
1%WAY
ECONOSEAL
PI,
57.WAY
SUMlTOMO,
BLACK
ENGINE
COMPARTMENT,
BRACKET
ON TOP OF TRANSMISSION
PI2
13.WAY
ECONOSEAL
111LC, BLACK
ENGlNE
COMPARTMENT,
BRACKET
ON TOP OF TRANSMISSION
RH,
Z&WAY
MULTILOCK
BEHIND
GLOVE
GREY
SIDE
ENCLOSURE
LF40
070,
HAND
ARCH
BOX
GROUND 2000 RPM = ,132 Hz GROUND
GROUNDS
GROUND GROUND GROUND GROUND GROUND GROVND GROUND GROUND GROUND GROUND GROUND GROUND
Ground
Location
EM,AL
EYELET
(PAIR) - LEFT HAND
EMlAR
EYELET
,PA,R, - RiGHT
EMlBR
EYELET
(PAIR,
EM2AL
EYELET
(PAIR, - LEFT HAND
/ Type LEG,
ENGINE
COMPARTMENT,
RIGHT
HAND
ENCLOSURE
HAND
LEG,
ENGINE
COMPARTMENT,
RlGHT
HAND
ENCLOSURE
RIGHT HAND
LEG,
ENGINE
COMPARTMENT,
RIGHT
HAND
ENCLOSURE
LEG,
ENGINE
COMPARTMENT,
LEFT HAND
ENCLOSURE
EMlAR
EYELET
(PAIR) - RIGHT HAND
LEG i ENGINE
COMPARTMENT,
LEFT HAND
ENCLOSURE
EM2BR
EYELET
(PAIR) - RIGHT
LEG,
COMPARTMENT,
LEFT HAND
ENCLOSURE
CONTROL
MODULE
HAND
ENGINE
PIN OUT INFORMATION
(FOLD OUT PAGE)
GROUND GROUND (VALVE
B+ E+ B+
OPEN)
GROUND GROUND GROUND
AT THE REAR OF THIS BOOK FOR CAN AND SCP NETWORK values for Control
ENGlNE,
EM64,
Relay
GROUND GROUND GROUND GROUND GROUND GROUND GROUND GROUND
CONTROL
PRESSURE
111LC, BLACK
HEATED
~02%
THROTTLE
B+ GROUND GROUND
EMISSION
FUEL TANK
LH FRONT
ECONOSEAL
RELAYS
B+ B+ B+ GROUND B+ B+ GROUND GROUND GROUND GROUND GROUND
NOTE: The values listed are approximately connected and fitted. “Active”
components
EVAPP
BLACK
i 3.WAY
P,,,
GROUND
0.98” @ ,O*C, DECREASING WITH TEMPERATURE 1 2” @ IDLE, INCREASING WITH RPM INCREASE 0.1 - 0.9 V Q IDLE ISWING) 0.t - 0.9 ” 0 IDLE iSWlNGi 0.1 0.9 V C IDLE (SWING, 0.1 - 0.9” 6 iDLE (SWING, GROUND GROUND GROUND
are used to represent
LF5.2, Z-WAY YAZAKI
CDMMUNlCATlONS
GROUND GROUND
THROT7LE MOTOR POWER SUPPLY THROTTLE MOTOR POWER SUPPLY IGNITION SWITCHED POWER SUPPLY GROUND THROTTLE MOTOR POWER SUPPLY THROT7LE MOTOR POWER SUPPLY GROUND GROUND GROUND GROUND THROTTLE MOTOR POWER SUPPLY THROTTLE MOTOR POWER SUPPLY
The following
TOP OF BRAKE PEDAL
(R.D.4.3.21
5V
I Access
Connector I Type I Color AC24!4-WAYM”LTlLOCK 070,WHITE
FTP SENSOR:
ECM PROGRAMMING CANISTER CLOSE VALVE ACT,“ATE VACUUM SWITCHING VALVE #3 ACT,“ATE VACUUM SWITCHING VALVE #, ACTIVATE VACUUM SWITCHING VALVE #2 ACTIVATE THROTTLE MOTOR POWER RELAY ACTIVATE ‘B’ BANK KNOCK SENSOR FEEDBACK ‘A’BANK KNOCK SENSOR FEEDBACK CKPS SIGNAL CMPS SIGNAL CMPS/ CKPS, KNOCK SENSORS COMMON SHlELD CKPS SIGNAL CMPS SIGNAL GROUND
NOTE: REFER TO THE APPENDIX
GROUND B+
5”
IATS FEEDBACK MAFS FEEDBACK UPSTREAM ‘B’ BANK H02S UPSTREAM ‘N BANK HOZS DOWNSTREAM ‘B’ BANK 025 DOWNSTREAM ‘N BANK 0% MAFS REFERENCE GROUND MAFS REFERENCE GROUND 025, HOZS COMMON SHlELD
UPSTREAM ‘B’ BANK HOZS HEATER UPSTREAM ‘A’ BANK H02S HEATER E”AP VALVE ACTlVATE VARIABLE VALVE TIMING SOLENOlD VARIABLE VALVE TIMING SOLENOID GROUND GROVND GROUND
B+
IAPPLIED)
E+ IP. Ni GROUND ENCODED GROUND
Location
Component BRAKE SWlTCH CC”.CANlSTER CLOSE VALVE CKPS. CRANKSHAFT POSITiON SENSOR CMP%CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR Em!ANDKM COOLING FAN EC-ISENGINE COOLANTTEMPERAT”RE SENSOR ENGlNE CONTROL MODULE
MESSAGES.
Pin Out data: B+ V Hz
to aid the user in understanding
Battery voltage Voltage (DC.1 Frequency circuit operation.
KHz Frequency x 1000 MS Milliseconds MV Millivolts THIS INFORMATION
SHOULD BE USED FOR
those that can be expected at the control module connector pins with all circuit connections made and all means a load is applied or a switch is ON; “Inactive” means a load is not applied or a switch is OFF.
REFER TO THE FRONT OF THE BOOK FOR ILLUSTRATIONS DETAILING THE LOCATION AND IDENTlFlCATlON CONNECTORS, HARNESSES, GROUNDS, VEHICLE CONTROL MODULES AND CONTROL MODULE PINS. DATE
OF ISSUE:
FEBRUARY
1998
OF COMPONENTS.
RELAYS,
CONTROL
MODULE
ENGINE CONTROL
PIN OUT INFORMATION MODULE
COMPONENTS
Description IGNITION SWITCHED POWER SUPPLY IGVITION SWlTCHED POWER SUPPLY OK To START- ENCODED COMM”NICAT10NS BRAKE SWITCH - NOT USED BA”ERY POWER SUPPLY BRAKE SWITCH SERIAL COMM”NICAT,ONS SERlALCOMM”NICAT,ONS PARKING BRAKE SW,TCH PARK ’ NEUTRAL CONFIRMAT,ON EMS CONTROLLED RELAY ACTIVATE SECURITY ACKNOWLEDGE IATS ECTS, TPS ’ MECHA\UICAL GUARD PosITIOI\: PEDAL POSITION COMMON REFEREYCE GRO”ND MECLIANICAL GUARD POSITION! PEDAL POSlTlON TPS COMMOV REFERENCE VOLTAGE GROUND GROUND CAN NETWORK CAN NETWORK CAN NETWORK CAN NETWORK
:
CKPS
CRANKSHAFT
CMPS’
CAMSHAFT
BGROUND
B+ B-
EC,,, AND TCM COOLING
FAN
ECTS
TEMPERATURE
BGROUND B-
Bi GROUND
GROUND GROUYD Hi HZ Hz HZ
,CRANK,NGl
0.41 V Q 195F (DECREASING 0 5 V = IDLE; 4.75 ” = WOT 0.5 V = IDLE: 4 15 ii = WOT GROUND
on this data page is furnished
SENSOR
MAE:
MASS
REAR OF ENGINE
ENGlNE
COMPARTMENT;
CONTROL
2~WAY ECONOSEAL
J2 / BLACK
LH FRONT
OUARTER
I REARWARD
SUMITOMO
OX II: GREY
‘N BANK
CATALYTIC
CONVERTER
UPSTREAM
EM*3
i&WAY
CATALYTIC
CONVERTER
GUARD
090 II I GREY
‘B’ BANK
111LC I BLACK
ENGINE
“EE,
UNDER
INTAKE
MANIFOLD
P127,2
111LC, BLACK
ENGINE
“EE,
UNDER
INTAKE
MANIFOLD
P135 1 s-WAY
YAZAK,
FC19 : LUCAR
RlGHT
0902 ! BLACK
ENGlNE
COMPARTMENT:
ANGLE
BELOW
PARKING
PI%,*
WAY TWIN
0902 ’ BLACK
ENGlNE
COMPARTMENT/THROTTLE
ENGINE
COMPARTMENT
P16: a-WAY
ENGlNE
COMPARTMENT,
CLIP,
BLACK
SUMITOMO
TSO9O / BLACK
REARWARD
BRAKE
OF AIR CLEANER
LEVER ASSEMBLY
!THRO”LE THROTTLE
ASSEMBLY ASSEMBLY
VALVE
- 1
EL*,
Z~WAY SUMlTOMO
090 DC INHIBIT
1, BLUE
BEHlND
RlGHT
HAND
WHEEL
ARCH
LINER
SWITCHING
VALVE
- 2
EL3,
*-WAY
0911 DC INHIBIT
1, BROWN
BEHIND
RIGHT
HAND
WHEEL
ARCH
LINER
5”
VACUUM
SWlTCHlNG
VALVE
-3
EL4,
P-WAY YAZAKI
BEHIND
RIGHT HAND
WHEEL
ARCH LINER
“VT SoLENOlD
“AL”E.
“VT SOLENOlD
VALVE: VARIABLE
“ARABLE
B+ B+ BBI 2 - 20 KHz = KNOCK 2 - 20 KHz = KNOCK
SUMlTOMO 090,
GREY
TlMlNG
SOLENOID
VALVE - A
P131, P~WAY AMP JUNIOR
POWER TIMER
I BLACK
ENGlNE
COMPARTMENT,
VALVE TIMING
SOLENOID
VALVE
P132, Z~WAY AMP JUNIOR
POWER TIMER,
BLACK
ENGlNE
COMPARTMENTj’B’
“ALVE
B
ENCLOSURE
OF ROAD WHEEL
SUMITOMO
WAY ECONOSEAL
ENCLOSURE TOP HOSE
MODULE
P126, P-WAY ECONOSEAL
PI42 i B-WAY YAZAKI
SENSORS
MODULE
SWITCHING
‘A’ BANK
CYLlNDER
HEAD,
FRONT
BANK
CYLINDER
HEAD,
FRONT
RELAYS Relay MOTOR
POWER
RELAY
Color I Stripe
Connector
BROWN
EM16,
Location
I Color
CONTROL
BROWN
I Access MODULE
ENCLOSURE
RELAYS
CONNECTORS Location
/ Access
Connector
Type / Color
AC13
*O-WAY
MULTILOCK
OX,
YELLOW
FASCIA
BT2
*O-WAY
MULTILOCK
070,
WHITE
TRUNK/ABOVE
BOTOM
CONNECTOR RIGHT
HAND
MOUNTING
BRACKET/RIGHT
REAR WHEEL
EL1
B-WAY ECONOSEAL
111LC, BLACK
ENGlNE
COMPARTMENT
EM,
Z&WA,’
MULTILOCK
070 , WHITE
ENGlNE
COMPARTMENT!ADJACENTTO
LF3
73.WAY
ECONOSEAL
111LC,WHITE
ENGlNE
COMPARTMENT,
111LC, BLACK
ENGlNE
COMPARTMENT,
LEFT HAND
ENG,NE
COMPARTMENT!
BRACKET
ON TOP OF TRANSMlSSlON
ENGlNE
COMPARTMENT,
BRACKET
ON TOP OF TRANSMISSION
BEHIND
GLOVE
LF40
13~WAY ECONOSEAL
PI,
57~WAY SUMlTOMO
PI2
13.WAY
ECONOSEAL
RHI
*O-WAY
MULTILOCK
i BLACK II/ LC, BLACK OX,
GREY
I RiGHT
HAND
LEFT HAND
HAND
SIDE
ARCH
ENCLOSURE RIGHT HAND
ENCLOSURE
ENCLOSURE ENCLOSURE
BOX
GROUNDS
GROUND GROUND GROUND GROUND
GROUND GROUND GROUND GROUND GROUND GROUND GROUND GROUND GROUND
(VALVE
COMPARTMENT
I4~WA.y
- B
AND MECHANICAL
ENGiNE
L&B
AIR FLOW SENSOR
MOTOR
040 / GREY ‘GREY 040 ’ GREY 040 1 GREY 47 I WHITE 47 ‘WHITE
REAR CONTROL
EM*,
VALVE
BRAKE SWITCH
THROTTLE
MULTILOCK M”LTILOCK040 MULTILOCK MULTILOCK MULTiLOCK MULTILOCK
HEAD,
COMPARTMENT!
VACUUM
GROUND GROUND
Ground
Location
EMlAL
EYELET
(PAIR) - LEFT HAND
EMlAR
EYELET
,PA,R) - RlGHT
EMiBR
EYELET
~PAIR) - RIGHT HAND
EM*AL
EYELET
,PA,R, -LEFT
EM**R
EYELET
(PAIR) - RIGHT HAND
LEG 1 ENGINE
COMPARTMENT.
LEFT HAND
ENCLOSURE
EMZBR
EYELET
(PA,R, -RIGHT
LEG,
COMPARTMENT,
LEFT HAND
ENCLOSURE
CONTROL
MODULE
/ Type HAND HAND HAND
LEG, LEG,
ENGlNE
COMPARTMENT.
RIGHT HAND
ENCLOSURE
ENGlNE
COMPARTMENT,
RIGHT
HAND
ENCLOSURE
LEG 1 ENGINE
COMPARTMENT,
RIGHT
HAND
ENCLOSURE
LEG,
ENGINE ENGINE
PIN OUT INFORMATION
COMPARTMENT,
LEFT HAND
ENCLOSURE
(FOLD OUT PAGE)
GROUND GROUND BL B+
OPEN,
BGROUND GROUND GROUND
AT THE REAR OF THIS BOOK FOR CAN AND SCP NETWORK
communications
KS- KNOCK
HARNESS-TO-HARNESS
Bd Bt GROUND GROUND GROUND GROUND GROUND B-
Serial and encoded CAN (Network) SCP Network
SENSOR-B
THROTTLE
a, B+ BGROUND
Module
OXYGEN
E J2 : GREY
CYLlNDER
ENG,NE
VACUUM
GROUND
5”@lOoORPM=566Hz;2000RPM=1132H* GROUND
values for Control
HOZS. HEATED
SENSOR-A
-A
‘B’ BANK
BLACK WHITE
UPSTREAM
CONTROL
SENSOR
070,
PEDAL
: REAR OF BED PLATE
SENSOR
GROUND
‘B’ BANK ‘A’ BANK
EMlSSlON
ENGINE
111HC
ECONOSEAL
EMlO ‘28.WAY EM,, ,&WAY EM,* Z-WAY EM13 34.WAY EM14 12.WAY EM15 /**-WAY
OXYGEN
111LC! BLACK
2~WAY MULTILOCK
P14 : %WAY
SENSOR
TOP OF BRAKE
POSITION
GROUND
GROUND GROUND GROUND 0 KHz = NO KNOCK, 0 KHz = NO KNOCK,
EMS4
HEATED
KS KNOCK
ECONOSEAL
P,,5 1 Z-WAY ECONOSEAL
SENSOR
MODULE
EVAPP- E”ApORATI”E ~02s
II 3.WAY
I Access
070 /WHITE
THRo”LE
GROUND
GROUND
P,,,
SENSOR
Location
/ Type / Color MULTlLOCK
EB+
WITH TEMPERATURE)
0 5 V = IDLE; 4.75” = WO, GROUND 0.5 V = IDLE. 4 75 ” = WOT 0.5 V = IDLE; 4.75” = WOT
GROUND GROUND GROUND GROUND GROUND GROUND GROUND GROUND
COOLANT
PEDAL POSITION
5”
GROUND GROUND
POSITION
CONTROL
PARKING
GROUND
NOTE: The values listed are approximately components connected and fitted. “Active”
ENGINE
POSlTlON
IR.D.4.3.2,
GROUND
GROUND GROUND
are used to represent
CAUTION: The information REFERENCE ONLY.
B-
0.98 V @ 10°C. DECREASING WITH TEMPERATURE 1 2 V @ IDLE, INCREASING WITH RPM INCREASE 0 1~ 0 9 V @ IDLE iSWING, 0.1 -0.9V@ IDLE (SWING)
UPSTREAM ‘B’ BANK Hozs HEATER UPSTREAM ‘A’ BANK HOZS HEATER EVAP VALVE ACTIVATE VARIABLE VALVE TIMING SOLENOlD VARIABLE VALVE TlMlNG SOLENOlD GROUND GROUND GROUND
D C S
AC24 i4WAY
GROUND GROUND 15 1500 15 1500 15 1500 15 - 1500
THROTTLE MOTOR POWER SUPPLY THROTTLE MOTOR POWER SUPPLY IGNITION SWITCHED POWER SUPPLY GROUND THROTTLE MOTOR POWER SUPPLY THROTTLE MOTOR POWER SUPPLY GROUND GROUND GROUND GROUND THROTrLE MOTOR POWER SUPPLY THROTTLE MOTOR POWER SUPPLY
symbols
Connector
BRAKE SWITCH
5v
ECM PROGRAMMING NOT USED VACUUM SWlTCHlNG VALVE #3 ACTIVATE VACUUM SWITCHING VALVE #I ACTlVATE VACUUM SWITCHING VALVE #2 ACTIVATE THROTTLE MOTOR POWER RELAY ACTIVATE ‘B’ BANK KNOCK SENSOR FEEDBACK ‘A’ BiWK KNOCK SENSOR FEEDBACK CKPS SIGNAL CMPS SIGNAL CMPS, CKPS, KNOCK SENSORS COMMON SHlELD CKPS SIGNAL CMPS SIGNAL GROUND
The following
Component
GROUND (APPLIED, BT IP, NI GROUND ENCODED COMMUNlCATloNS GROUND
IATS FEEDBACK MAFS FEEDBACK ‘B’ BANK HO% ‘A’ BANK HOZS NOT USED NOT USED MAFS REFERENCE GROUND MAFS REFERENCE GROUND HOE COMMON SHIELD
I Input 0 output SG Signal Ground
Inactive 0”
ENGlNE
ECM PROGRAMMING ENGlNE CRANK NOT USED MECHANICAL GUARD POSITION I PEDAL POSITION, TPS COMMON REFERENCE VOLTAGE ECT FEEDBACK TPS FEEDBACK TPS FEEDBACK IATS 1 ECTS I TPS 1 MECHANICAL GUARD POSITION, PEDAL POSITION COMMON REFERENCE GROUND MECHANICAL GUARD POSITION FEEDBACK MECHANICAL GUARD POSITION 1 PEDAL POSlTlON i TPS SHIELD PEDAL POSITION FEEDBACK PEDAL POSITION FEEDBACK
NOTE: REFER TO THE APPENDIX
Active B+ Bi
MESSAGES.
Pin Out data: B+ V Hz
Battery voltage Voltage (DC) Frequency
to aid the user in understanding
circuit operation.
KHz MS MV
Frequency x 1000 Milliseconds Millivolts
THIS INFORMATION
SHOULD BE USED FOR
those that can be expected at the control module connector pins with all circuit connections made and all means a load is applied or a switch is ON; “Inactive” means a load is not applied or a switch is OFF.
REFER TO THE FRONT OF THE BOOK FOR ILLUSTRATIONS DETAILING THE LOCATION AND IDENTIFICATION CONNECTORS, HARNESSES, GROUNDS, VEHICLE CONTROL MODULES AND CONTROL MODULE PINS. DATE
OF ISSUE:
FEBRUARY
1998
OF COMPONENTS.
RELAYS,
CONTROL
MODULE
ENGINE CONTROL ‘;r 0 I 1 I
Pin EM,O-2 EM10-3 EM104 EMlO-
PIN OUT INFORMATION MODULE
COMPONENTS
Description A,CCMLOADINHIBIT A!CCMELECTRICAL LOADSIGNAL ArCCM COMPRESSOR CLUTCH REOUEST BRAKE SWITCH
Inactive B+
Component AIRCONDlTlDNlNG
COMPRESSOR
C-WAY REFRIGERANT SWITCH HIGHPRESSURE 4~WAY REFRlGERANT SWlTCH HIGHPRESSURE IGNITION
MODULE
2 SWlTCHlNG
FEEOBACK
1
iM,Z-9
IGNITlOY
MODULE
2 SWITCHING
FEEDBACK
0
EM,Z-10
AIR CONDITIONING
COMPRESSOR
0
FUEL PUMP RELAY ACTIVATE
0
CRUISE CONTROL
ON STATUS
/ Access
COMPARTMENT:&‘C
A/C UNlTiRlGHTHAND
COMPRESSOR SIDE
GROUND
BGROUND
EM12.5 iM,Z-6 EM12-8
ENGINE
GROUND
BRAKE CANCEL
I I I
Location
Connector I Type /Color P136,I-WAYS”MlTOM0090A-TYPE,BLACK
CLUTCH
RELAYACTIVATE
SWTCH
CRUISE
CONTROL
ON , OFF SWITCH
CRUISE
CONTROL
SWITCHES
ENGINE
CONTROL
MODULE
AC4,22-WAY
MULTILOCK
47 i GREY
ACZ4!4-WAY
MULTILOCK
070 !WHITE
TOP OF BRAKE
NATURAL
REARWARD OF GEAR SELECTOR CENTER OF STEERING WHEEL
FC63
(STEERING
,O~WAY AMP MOL!
SW3 I3-WAY
WHEEL,
EPC,
BLACK
AND WHlTE
PEDAL
ENGINE
COMPARTMENT!CONTROL
TRVNK,
ELtCTRlCAL
MODULE
ENCLOSURE
B+ B+ B-
GROUND LED
GROUND
NOT USED SERIES iLOW PARALLEL
SPEED FAN *CTI”*TE
(HIGHI
B+
SPEED FAN ACT,“*TE
IGYITION
COIL REL*YACT,“ATE
IGNITION
MODULE
1 SWliCHlNG
lGNlTiON
MODULE
2 SWTCHING 2 SWITCHING
B+ B+
FUSE BOX
BTlO: 10.WAY Bill I ,&WAY BT12,10-WAY BT13,10-WAY BT64, EYELET
TRUNK
“.T.A u T4. U T.A U T A
FVSEBOX, FUSEBOX, FUSEBOX, FVSEBOX,
NATURAL BLACK GREEN BLUE
CARRIER
0
IGNITION
MODULE
0
IGNITION
MODULE
1 SWlTCHlNG
IGNITION
COlL - ,A
pi,*,
090x,
BLACK
ENGINE
COMPARTMENT,
CAMSHAFT
COVER
0
IGNITION
MODULE
2 SWlTCWlNG
IGNlTlON
COiL-
1B
P122, Z-WAY YAZAKI
mm,
BLACK
ENGINE
COMPARTMENT,
CAMSHAFT
COVER
IGNITION
MODULE
1 SWlTCHlNG
lGNlT\ON
COlL
2A
P119 i Piv*y
090x
: BLACK
CAMSHAFT
CO”ER
IGNITION
MODULE
1 SWlTCHlNG
lGNlTlON
COIL - 28
Pi23,
?~W/IY YAZAKI
IGNITION
MODULE
1 SWlTCHlNG
IGNlTlON
COIL-W.
Pm,
P-WAY YAZAKlO9OX,
ICNlTlON
COlLLBB
P124, Z-WAY YALM
IGNlTlON
COIL-U
PI21 ,l~WAY
lGNlT,ON
COILL4B
Pi25,2~WAY
0
iNJECTOR
‘3B’ACTl”ATE
GROUND
B-
INJECTOR
‘2B’ACTl”ATE
GROUND
B7
INJECTOR
‘4K ACTIVATE
GROUND
B+
INJECTOR
‘,A
ACTIVATE
GROUND
B+
INJECTOR
‘48’ ACTIVATE
GROUND
B-
INJECTOR
‘3N ACTIVATE
GROUND
B+
INJECTOR
‘2K ACTIVATE
GROVND
B+
lNJECTOR
‘1B’ACTI”ATE
GROUND
B-
AIR CONDlTlONlNG CONTROL v Pin Description I ACbl COMPRESSOR CLUTCH Al31
AIR CONDlTlONlNG
I
AC4-7
LOAD INHIBIT
KS9
COMPRESSOR
I
AC%17
REFRIGERANT&WAY
CLUTCH
COMP*RTMENT,CAMSHAFTCO”EB
ENGINE
COMPARTMENT,
CAMSHAFT
COVER
090x,
BLACK
ENGINE
COMPARTMENT,
CAMSHAFT
COVER
YAZAKI
090x,
BLACK
ENGINE
COMPARTMENTiCAMSHAFT
YAZAKI
090X,
BLACK
ENGINE
COMP*RTMENT,CAMSHAFTCO”ER
COVER
MODULE
1
EM27,12-WAY
lGNlT,ON
POWER MODULE:
BLACK
ENGINE
COMPARTMENT/BULKHEAD,
RIGHT
- 2
EM29,12-WAY
IGNITION
POWER MODULE!
BLACK
ENGINE
COMPARTMENT,
LEFT HAND
FAN CONTROL
MODULE
LB, WI?,
2~WAY REINSHAGEN
SWITCH
LB,,
G-WAY ECONOSEAL
RELAY
%WAY
LF13,
RADlATOR
FAN - LH
RADIATOR
FAN - RH
REFRIGERANT4-WAY
PRESSURE
TRW,
Z-WAY
ADJACENT
BLACK
RElNSHAGEN
METR,
630,
BLACK
METRI
530,
BLACK
ENGINE
111LC, BLACK
BULKHEAD,
TO LEFT HAND
HANDSIDE SIDE
HORN
COMPARTMENT,
FRONT
ENGINE
COMPARTMENT/FRONT
ENGINE
COMPARTMENT,
REARWARD
OF RADlATOR
RELAYS Relay
Inactive D”
Active B+,ONi
STATUS LOAD SlGNA,
ON REOUEST PRESSURE
COMPARTMENT,
ENGINE
090X,
MODULE
AIR CONDlTlONlNG
B+
0”
0”
B-
B+
0”
Cl”,*-30BARi
B- (OUT OF ACTIVE
FUEL PUMP IGNITION
0
ENGINE
BLACK BLACK
YAZAK,
IGNiTlON RADIATOR
MODULE
ELECTRICAL
YAZAK,
IGNlTlON
SWlTC,,
RANGE1
COMPRESSOR
CLUTCH
RELAY
Connector
CONTROL TRUNK
RELAY
BROWN
RELAY (#4)
BROWN
BUS
BROWN
EM’Z,
COIL RELAY
HARNESS-TO-HARNESS
/ Color
/ Access
LX ENCLOSURE
Location
AC13 BT2
*O-WAY
EM1 EM2 EM3 LF3
14~WAY MVLTiLOCK
MODULE
TOP CONNECTOR
FASCIA
BOTTOM
MOUNTING
CONNECTOR
REAR WHEEL
HAND
RIGHT
ENCLOSURE
RELAYS
SIDE HAND
TRUNK,
ABOVE
20.WAY
MULTILOCK
070,
WHITE
ENGINE
COMPARTMENT,AOJACENTTO
RIGHT
l&WAY
MULTILOCK
070,YELLOW
ENGINE
COMPARTMENTiADJACENTTO
RlGHTHAND
ENCLOSURE
070,
ENGINE
COMP*RTMENT,ADJACENTTO
RIGHTHAND
ENCLOSURE
ENGlNE
COMPARTMENT,
LEFT HAND
HAND
ENCLOSURE
ENCLOSURE
LF40
13WAY
ECONOSEAL
111LC, BLACK
ENGINE
COMPARTMENT,
LEFT HAND
Pll
57.WAY
SUMlTOMO,
BLACK
ENGlNE
COMPARTMENT,
BRKKET
ON TOP OF TRANSMlSSiON
ECONOSEAL
ENGINE
COMPARTMENT,
BRACKET
ON TOP OF TRANSMlSSiON
BEHIND
GLOVE
PI2
IS-WAY
2O~WA.Y MULTiLOCK
l/l LC, BLACK 070,
GREY
RH2
PO-WAY MULTILOCK
070,
WHITE
REAR OF CENTER
12.WAY
MULTlLOCK
070,
GREY
RIGHT
HAND
SW,
‘I?-WAY
MULTlLOCK
040 II BLACK
INSIDE
STEERING
JST,
WHlTE
ENCLOSURE
BOX
SC3
CENTER
SIDE
ARCH
II/ K,
RH1
WHITE
HAND
RlGHT
BRACKET,
070 /WHITE
GREY
RIGHT
BRACKET,
MOUNTING
M”LT!LOCK
6-WAY
RELAYS
/ Access
FASCIA
13~WA\y ECONOSEAL
SW2
ENCLOSURE
FUSE BOX
CONTROL
BROWN
RELAYS
MODULE
CONNECTORS
Type I Color 20.WAY MULTILOCK 070,WHlTE X-WAYMULTILOCK OX, YELLOW
Connector AC12
Location
Color / Stripe BROWN
BUS EM5 i BROWN
FUEL INJECTION 0
*-WAY
CONSOLE
ASSEMBLY
SIDE OF STEERING COLUMN
OF STEERING
COLUMN
COWL
WHEEL
GROUNDS
The following
symbols
are used to represent
I Input 0 output SG Signal Ground CAUTION: The information REFERENCE ONLY.
D C S
values for Control
Serial and encoded CAN (Network) SCP Network
communications
on this data page is furnished
NOTE: The values listed are approximately ComPonents connected and fitted. “Active”
Module
Pin Out data: B+ V Hz
Battery voltage Voltage (DC) Freauencv
to aid the user in understanding
circuit operation.
KHz Frequency x 1000 MS Milliseconds MV Millivolts THIS INFORMATION
Ground BTML
Location
/ Type
EYELET
IPA,Rl
-LEFT
EMlAR
EYELET
(PAIR, - RlGHT
HAND
LEG!
ENGINE
COMPARTMENT.
RIGHT
EMZAR
EYELET
IPA,R, - RlGHT
HAND
LEG,
ENGINE
COMPARTMENT.
LEFT HAND
HAND
LEG : TRUNK,
RIGHT REAR HAND
ENCLOSURE ENCLOSURE
FC3BL
EYELET
(PAIRI -LEFT
HAND
LEG,
TRANSMlSSlON
LF2.u
EYELET
(PA,%
- LEFT HAND
LEG,
ENGINE
COMPARTMENT,
FORWARD
OF LEFT HAND
HOOD
CATCH
LFlBL
EYELET
(PA,R)
LEFT HAND
LEG,
ENGiNE
COMPARTMENT,
FORWARD
OF LEFT HAND
HOOD
CATCH
CONTROL
MODULE
PIN OUT INFORMATION
TUNNEL.
LEFT HAND
SIDE
(FOLD OUT PAGE)
SHOULD BE USED FOR
those that can be expected at the control module connector pins with all circuit connections made and all means a load is applied or a switch is ON; “Inactive” means a load is not applied or a switch is OFF.
REFER TO THE FRONT OF THE BOOK FOR ILLUSTRATIONS DETAILING THE LOCATION AND IDENTIFICATION CONNECTORS, HARNESSES, GROUNDS, VEHICLE CONTROL MODULES AND CONTROL MODULE PINS. DATE
OF ISSUE:
FEBRUARY
1998
OF COMPONENTS,
RELAYS.
CONTROL
MODULE
ENGINE CONTROL
PIN OUT INFORMATION COMPONENTS
MODULE
Component
Connector
B+ B*
Inactive 0” B-
BRAKE SWITCH
AC24,
BGROUND
BB-
ECM ANDTCM
COOLING
FAN
ECTS
COOLANT
TEMPERATURE
Description
Active
GNlTlON SWTCHED POWER SUPPLY IGNITION SWITCHED POWER SUPPLY OKTOSTART-ENCODED COMMUNICATIONS BRAKE SWITCH - NOT USED BATTERY POWER SVPPLY BRAKE SWITCH SERIAL COMMUNlCATlONS SERIAL COMMUNICATIONS PARKING BRAKE SWITCH PARK I NEUTRAL COYF,RMAT,ON EMS CONTROLLED RELAY ACTIVATE SECURITY ACKNOWLEDGE IATS / ECTS TPS I MECHANICAL GUARD POSITION PEDAL POSITION COMMON REFERENCE GROUND MECHANlCAL GUARD POSlTlON ‘PEDAL POSlTlON TPS COMMON REFERENCE VOLTAGE GROUND GROUND CAN NETWORK CAN NETWORK CAN NEWORK CAN NETWORK
CKPS: CRANKSHAFT cMPS
CAMSHAFT ENGiNE
ENGINE
I
GROUND iAPPLIED, B+ ip. N, GROUND ENCODED COMMUNICATIONS GROUND
Bi GROUND Bi
5”
5v
GROUND GROUND
GRO”4D GROUND
POSITION
CONTROL
HOE
HEATED
HO-S:
HEATED
1~75 2. INTAKE
B+ B+ 5”
symbols
CAUTION: The information REFERENCE ONLY.
D C S
GROUNC
GROUND GROUND GROUND
GROUND GROUND GROUND
*i Bi Bi Bi
GROUND GROUND GROUND GROUND 0 KHz = NO KNOCK, 2 - 20 KHz = KNOCK 0 KHz = NO KNOCK, 2 - 20 KHz = KNOCK 5v Q 1000 RPM = 565 Hz; 2000 RPM = 1132 HZ 5 Hz @ IDLE GROUND
GROUND
B+ E+ B+ GROUND E+ B+ GROUND GROUND GROUND GROUND GROUND B+ GROUND GROUND
GROUND GROUND GROUND GROUND GROUND GROUND GROUND GROUND GROUND GROUND GROUND
GROUND GROUND GROUND GROUND GROUND
(VALVE
values for Control
Module
communications
on this data page is furnished
NOTE: The values listed are approximately components connected and fitted. “Active”
PI15 /Z-WAY
ECONOSEAL
111HC,
ENGINE, ‘B’ BANK
BLACK
CYLINDER
ENGINE
COMPARTMENT/
REAR OF ENGINE
EMlO ‘28.WAY MULTlLOCK 040, GREY EM,, : IS-WAY’ MULTILOCK 040 iGREY EM12 Z2-WAY MULTILOCK 040, GREY EM13 34.WAY MULTILOCK 040: GREY EM14 i2-WAYM”LTlLOCK47.‘WHITE EM,5’ZZ-WAYMULT,LOCK47,WHlTE
ENGlNE
COMPARTMENT:
CONTROL
E J2 II GREY
LF58,
?-WAY
ECONOSEAL
JZ I BLACK
LH FRONT
UPSTREAM
EM21
4WAY
SUMlTOMO
090 II I GREY
‘& BANK
OXYGEN
SENSOR
- B UPSTREAM
EMZ,
b-WAY
SUMITOMO
AIR TEMPERATURE
SENSOR
VALVE
2
REAR
COMPARTMENT/CONTROL
070 ‘WHITE
-A
CONTROL
HEAD,
ENGINE
MULTILOCK
SENSOR
EMlSSlON
PEDAL
REAR OF BED PLATE
OUARTER!
REARWARD
CATALYTlC
CONVERTER
CATALYTIC
CONVERTER
‘B’ BANK
POWER TIMER/BLACK
ENGlNE
COMPARTMENT!‘K
BANK
P126,‘2-WAY
III LC I BLACK
ENGINE
VEE i UNDER
INTAKE
MANIFOLD
INTAKE
MANIFOLD
ECONOSEAL
KS. KNOCK
SENSOR
- B
P127 ; 2~WAY ECONOSEAL
111LC, BLACK
ENGlNE
“EE II UNDER
AIR FLOW SENSOR
P135, B-WAY YAZAKlO902
! BLACK
ENGINE
COMPARTMENT!
BELOW
PARKING
ENGWE
COMPARTMENT,
ENGINE
COMPARTMENT,THRO”LE
ENGINE
COMPARTMENT
BEHlND
RiGHT
FC19 I LUCAR
BRAKE SWTCH AND MECHANlCAL
THROTTLE
MOTOR
THRO”LE
POSlTlON
VACUUM
SWlTCHlNG
GUARD
Pm
SENSORS
RIGHT ANGLE
/ i-WAY
Y*ZAKI
PI33 , P-WAY TWIN PIE! a-WAY
SENSOR VALVE
- 1
EL2,
“ACUUM
SWlTCHlNG
VALVE
2
VACUUM
SWITCHING
VALVE
- 3
0902 I BL&CK CLIP,
BLACK
S”MlTOM0
TS090,
BLACK
Z-WAY SUMITOMO
090 DC INHIBIT
1, BLUE
EU,
2.WAY
090 DC INHlBlT
1, BROWN
EL4,
Z-WAY YAZAKI
SUMITOMO 090,
GREY
REARWARD
BRAKE
INTERCOOLER!
REAR
OF AIR CLEANER
LEVER THROTTLE
ASSENlBLY ASSEMBLY
/THROTTLE
ASSEMBLY
HAND
WHEEL
BEHIND
RIGHT HAND
WHEEL
ARCH LINER
BEHIND
RlGHT
WHEEL
ARCH LINER
HAND
ENCLOSURE
OF ROAD WHEEL
090 II i GREY
-A
ENCLOSURE TOP HOSE
MODULE
PI41 , Z-WAY AMP JUNIOR
SENSOR
MASS
MODULE
ARCH LINER
Relay MOTOR
POWER
RELAY
Color / Stripe
Connector
BROWN
EM16,
Location
/Color
CONTROL
BROWN
/ Access MODULE
ENCLOSURE
RELAYS
CONNECTORS Location
Connector AC13
Type / Color 2O~WbY MULTlLOCK
070,
BT2
20.W.AY
070 ,WHlTE
ELI
B-WAY ECONOSEAL
111iC,
EM?
20.WAY
MULTILOCK
070,
LF3
,3~WAY
M”LT\LOCK
YELLOW
/ Access
FASClA
BOTTOM
TRUNK,
ABOYE
CONNECTOR RlGHT
HAND
MOUNTING
ENGINE
COMPARTMENT,
WHITE
ENGINE
COMPARTMENT,ADJACENTTO
ECONOSEAL
111LC,WHITE
ENGINE
COMPARTMENT,
LEFT HAND
BLACK
BRACKET,
REAR WHEEL
RIGHT
HAND
RlGHT
RIGHT HAND
ENCLOSURE
ENCLOSURE
LF40
IS-WAY
ECONOSEAL
111LC, BLACK
ENGINE
COMPARTMENT,
LEFT HAND
57.WAY
SUMITOMO,
BLACK
ENGINE
COMPARTMENT,
BRACKET
ON TOP OF TRANSMlSSlON
ENGlNE
COMPARTMENT,
BRACKET
ON TOP OF TRANSMISSION
BEHIND
GLOVE
PI2
ISWAY
ECONOSEAL
Z&WAY
MULTILOCK
/II LC! BLACK 070,
GREY
SIDE
ENCLOSURE
PI, RH1
HAND
ARCH
ENCLOSURE
BOX
GROUNDS Ground
Location
EMlAL
EYELET
(PAIR) - LEFT HAND
I Type
EMIAR
EYELET
IPAIR)
EMlBR
EYELET
(PAlRi
EMZAL
EYELET
(PAIR, - LEFT HAND
RIGHT
LEG,
ENGINE
COMPARTMENT,
RIGHT
HAND
ENCLOSURE
HAND
LEG,
ENGINE
COMPARTMENT,
RlGHT
HAND
ENCLOSURE
- RIGHT HAND
LEG,
ENGINE
COMPARTMENT,
RIGHT
HAND
ENCLOSURE
LEG,
ENGINE
COMPARTMENT.
LEFT HAND
ENCLOSURE
EM?AR
EYELET
IPAIR) - RIGHT
HAND
LEG,
ENGINE
COMPARTMENT,
LEFT HAND
ENCLOSURE
EMlBR
EYELET
(PAIR) - RiGHT
HAND
LEG,
ENGINE
COMPARTMENT.
LEFT HAND
ENCLOSURE
CONTROL
MODULE
PIN OUT INFORMATION
(FOLD OUT PAGE)
GROUND GROUND B+ GROUND GROUND GROUND
OPEN1
AT THE REAR OF THIS BOOK FOR CAN AND SCP NETWORK
Serial and encoded CAN (Network) SCP Network
111LC / BLACK
KS: KNOCK
THRO”LE
2 38” @ 20°C. DECREASING WlTH TEMPERATURE 0 98” Q 10°C. DECREASiNG WITH TEMPERATURE 1 2” @ IDLE, INCREASING WlTH RPM INCREASE 0.1 - 0 9 “@ IDLE ,SWiNGi 0 1 - 0.9” Q IDLE iSWING,
are used to represent
ECONOSEAL
P,4 / 2 WAY ECONOSEAL
SENSOR
/ Access
TOP OF BRAKE
WHITE
RELAYS 05”=IDLE:475”=WOT GROUND 0.5 V = IDLE: 4.75 ” = WOT 0.5 ” = IDLE; 4.75 V = WOT
SHlELD
THROTTLE MOTOR POWER SUPPLY THROTTLE MOTOR POWER SUPPLY IGNlTlON SWITCHED POWER SUPPLY GROUND THROTTLE MOTOR POWER SUPPLY THROTTLE MOTOR POWER SUPPLY GROUND GROUND GROUND GROUND THROTTLE MOTOR POWER SUPPLY THROTTLE MOTOR POWER SUPPLY
I Input 0 output SG Signal Ground
070,
PI17 ! Z-WAY EM64,2-WAY
HARNESS-TO-HARNESS
UPSTREAM ‘B’ BANK HOZS HEATER UPSTREAM ‘A’ BANK H02.S HEATER EVAP VALVE ACTIVATE GROUND GROUND GROUND
MULTlLOCK
OXYGEN
EVAPP: EVAPORATIVE
PARKING
ECM PROGRAMMlNG NOT USED VACUUM SWITCHING VALVE iy3 ACTIVATE VACUUM SWITCHING VALVE tfl ACTIVATE VACUUM SWITCHING VALVE #2 ACT,“ATE THROTTLE MOTOR POWER RELAY ACTIVATE ‘E’ BANK KNOCK SENSOR FEEDBACK ‘A’ BANK KNOCK SENSOR FEEDBACK CKPS SIGNAL CMPS SIGNAL CMPS,CKPS, KNOCKSENSORS COMMON SHIELD CKPS SIGNAL CMPS SIGNAL GROUND
The following
SENSOR
fR,D.GZr
MAE:
NOT USED NOT USED NOT USED NOT USED IATS 2 FEEDBACK IATS FEEDBACK MAFS FEEDBACK ‘B’ BANK H02S ‘R BANK HOX NOT USED NOT USED MAFS REFERENCE GROUND MAFS REFERENCE GROUND HWS COMMON SHlELD
NOTE: REFER TO THE APPENDIX
SENSOR
MODULE
PEDAL POSlTlON ECM PROGRAMMING ENGINE CRANK NOT USED MECHANICAL GUARD POSITION, PEDAL POSITION I TPS COMMON REFERENCE VOLTAGE ECT FEEDBACK TPS FEEDBACK TPS FEEDBACK lATS, ECTS, TPS, MECHANlCAL GUARD POSITION , PEDAL POSITION COMMON REFERENCE GROUND MECHANICAL GUARD POSITION FEEDBACK MECHANlCAL GUARD POSITION! PEDAL POSITION ,TPS PEDAL POSlTlON FEEDBACK PEDAL POSITiON FEEDBACK
POSITION
Location
/ Type / Color
a-WAY
MESSAGES.
Pin Out data: B+ V Hz
Battery voltage Voltage (DC) Frequency
to aid the user in understanding
circuit operation.
KHz MS MV
Frequency x 1000 Milliseconds Millivolts
THIS INFORMATION
SHOULD BE USED FOR
those that can be expected at the control module connector pins with all circuit connections made and all means a load is applied or a switch is ON; “Inactive” means a load is not applied or a switch is OFF.
REFER TO THE FRONT OF THE BOOK FOR ILLUSTRATIONS DETAILING THE LOCATION AND IDENTIFICATION CONNECTORS, HARNESSES, GROUNDS, VEHICLE CONTROL MODULES AND CONTROL MODULE PINS. DATE
OF ISSUE:
FEBRUARY
1998
OF COMPONENTS,
RELAYS,
CONTROL
MODULE
PIN OUT INFORMATION COMPONENTS Inactive B,
Active GROUND B+ B-
Connector
Component AIR CONDlTlONlNG AIR CONDlTlONlNG
GROUND GROUND
B+
GROUND
BRAKE CANCEL SWITCH CRUlSE CONTROL ON, OFF SWITCH CRUISE CONTROL SWITCHES (STEERING ENGINE CONTROL MODULE
GROUND
SW3, &WAY EPC, BLACK EMlO IZ8~WAY MULTILOCK EM,, :,G-WAYM”LTlLOCK040, EM,2 i22~WAY MULTlLOCK EM13!34-WAY MULTliOCK EM14,12-WAY MULTILOCK EM15 / Z-WAY MULTiLOCK IJ3, Z-WAY AMP JUNIOR lJ7 1/Z-WAY AMP JUNIOR IJ4i Z-WAY AMP JUNIOR IJ8 i Z-WAY AMP JUNlOR IJ5 I Z-WAY AMP JUNIOR
WHEEL)
FUEL INJECTOR - ,A FUEL iNJECTOR - ,B FUEL INJECTOR-2A FUEL FUEL FUEL FUEL FUEL FUEL
FUEL PUMP RELAY ACTIVATE CRUISE CONTROL
ON STATUS
LED
FUEL PUMP RELAY ACTIVATE INTERCOOLER
PUMP RELAY ACTIVATE
PARALLEL
iHIGH)
IGNITION
INJECTOR - 2B INJECTOR -3A INJECTOR - 38 INJECTOR-4A INJECTOR -48 PUMPS
SPEED FAN ACTIVATE
COIL RELAY ACT,“ATE
IGNITION
MODULE
1 SWlTCHlNG
IGNITION
MODULE
2 SWITCHING
IGNITION
MODULE
2 SWlTCHlNG
IGNITION
MODULE
I SWITCHING
IGNITION
MODULE
2 SWiTCHlNG
GNlTlON
MODULE
1 SWlTCHlNG
lGNlTlON
MODULE
1 SWlTCHiNG
IGNITION
MODULE
1 SWITCHING
INJECTOR
‘38’ ACTIVATE
GROUND
INJECTOR
‘2B’ACTI”ATE
GROUND
INJECTOR
‘4X ACT,“ATE
GROUND
INJECTOR
‘,A’ ACTIVATE
GROUND
INJECTOR
‘48’ ACTIVATE
GROUND
INJECTOR
‘3R ACT,“ATE
GROUND
INJECTOR
‘2X ACTIVATE
GROUND
INJECTOR
‘1B’ACTl”ATE
GROUND
lGNlTlON
COlL-
,A
GNlTlON IGNlTlON
COILCOIL-
1s ZA
RADlATOR FAN CONTROL RELAY MODULE RADIATOR FAN LH RADIATOR FAN RH REFRIGERANT.&WAY PRESSURE SWTCH
LF13, Z-WA, REINSHAGEN LF12, P-WAY RElNSHAGEN LF5.7, S-WAY ECONOSEAL
MODULE
1
AC?-,
COMPRESSORCLVTCHSTATUS
0
AC-1
AIR CONDITIONING
I
AC&7
LOAD ,NHlBlT
0
AC4~9
COMPRESSOR
/
AC4-17
REFRIGERANT4~XZWAY
Active B+(ONI
ELECTRICAL
CENTER OF STEERING WHEEL ENGlNE COMPARTMENT! CONTROL
INTAKE INTAKE INTAKE INTAKE INTAKE INTAKE
MANIFOLD; MANIFOLD, MANIFOLD MANlFOLD, MANIFOLD, MANIFOLD,
FUEL FUEL 1 FUEL FUEL FVEL FUEL
MODULE
ENCLOSURE
RAIL RAIL RAIL RAIL RAli RAIL
INTAKE MANIFOLD, FUEL RAIL INTAKE MANIFOLD, FUEL RAlL TRUNK/TOP OF FUELTANK TRUNK i ELECTRICAL CARRIER
ENGINE ENGlNE ENGINE
COMPARTMENT, COMPARTMENT COMPARTMENT,
CAMSHAFT / CAMSHAFT CAMSHAFT
COVER COVER COVER
ENGINE ENGlNE
COMPARTMENT, CAMSHAFT COMPARTMENT/CAMSHAFT
COVER COVER
ENGlNE COMPARTMENT, CAMSHAFT ENGINE COMPARTMENT, CAMSHAFT ENGINE COMPARTMENT, CAMSHAFT ENGINE COMPARTMENT! BULKHEAD, ENGINE COMPARTMENT, BULKHEAD, ENGINE COMPARTMENT,BELOWA,R AWACENT TO LEFT HAND HORN
BLACK BLACK
ENGINE ENGINE ENGINE
METRI 630: BLACK METR! 630, BLACK 111LC, BLACK
COMPARTMENT, FRONT COMPARTMENT, FRONT COMPARTMENT/REARWARD
COVER COVER COVER RIGHT HAND SIDE LEFT HAND SIDE CLEANER
OF RADlATOR
RELAYS Relay
AIR CONDITIONING CONTROL V Pin Description
A/C COMPRESSOR SIDE
TOP OF BRAKE PEDAL REARWARD OF GEAR SELECTOR
AND WHITE 040 I GREY GREY 040, GREY 040: GREY 47 I WHITE 47, WHlTE POWER TlMER I BLACK PCWER TlMER, BLACK POWER TIMER i BLACK POWER TlMER! BLACK POWER TlMER, BLACK
P123! Z-WAY YAZAKI 090X, BLACK P120, I-WAY YAZAKl 090x, BLACK Pi24 i 2WAY YAZAKl 090X , BLACK PI21 , ?-WAY YAZAKI 090X, BLACK P125,2-WAY YAZAKI 090X, BLACK EM27,15-WAY lGNlTlON POWER MODULE, EM29! 1%WAY lGNlTlON POWER MODULE, EM75,2-WAY AUGAT 1.6, BLACK LF9, S-WAY TRW, BLACK
IGNiTlON COIL - ZB IGNITION COIL-3A lGNlT,DN COlL 38 IGNlTlON COIL-W !GNlTlON COIL 48 IGNITION MODULE - 1 IGNlTlON MODULE - 2 ,NTERCOOLER PUMP
/ Access
ENGINE COMPARTMENT, NC “NIT, RIGHT HAND
IJ9 ! ?-WAY AMP J”NlOR POWER TIMER, BLACK 136/Z-WAYAMPJUNlOR POWERTIMER,BLACK lJlO!Z.WAYAMPJ”NlOR POWERTIMER, BLACK ST55 P-WAY SUMlTOMO DLOBil, NATURAL BTlO: IO-WAY “.T A. FUSEBOX, NATURAL BTll , IO-WAY “.T.A FUSEBOX, BLACK ST,*, ID-WAY U.T.A. FUSEBOX, GREEN BT13, IO-WAY U.T.A. FUSEBOX, BLUE BT64, EYELET PIIS, P-WAY YAZM 090X i BLACK P122,1WAY Y*zAKlo9cJx, BLACK P119, ?-WAY YAZAKI 090X, BLACK
FUSE BOX-TRVNK
SERIES ILOWI SPEED FAN ACTIVATE
Location
/ Type I Color
P136, ,WAY SUMlTOMO 090 A-TYPE, BLACK AC,, 26.WAY MULTILOCK 47, GREY AC2, ,&WAY MULTlLOCK 47 I GREY AC3 : 12.WAY MULTlLOCK 47 I GREY AC4,22-WAY MULTILOCK 471 GREY AC24 I4-WAY MULTILOCK 070 / WHlTE FC63 I_IO-WAY AMP MC%, NATURAL
COMPRESSOR CLUTCH CONTROL MODULE
AIR CONDlTlONlNG COMPRESSOR FUEL INJECTION RELAY FUEL PVMP I RELAY W, FUEL PUMP 2 RELAY IGNITION COIL RELAY INTERCOOLER PUMP RELAY
Inactive 0” 0”
LOAD SIGNAL
CLUTCH
RELAY
Color / Stripe
Connector
BROWN BROWN BROWN BROWN BROWN BROWN
BUS EMS, BROWN BUS BT51, BROWN EM26, BROWN EM31, BROWN
/ Color
Location
/ Access
LH ENCLOSURE RELAYS CONTROL MODULE ENCLOSURE RELAYS TRUNK FUSE BOX TRUNK RELAYS CONTROL MODULE ENCLOSURE RELAYS LHD: CONTROL MODULE ENCLOSURE RELAYS RHD: RH ENCLOSURE RELAYS
B+ CLUTCH
ON REQUEST PRESSURE
HARNESS-TO-HARNESS
0” SWlTCH
B+ iOUT OF ACTIVE
RANGE)
CONNECTORS Location
Connector
Type / Color
AC12 AC13 .8T2 EM,
Z-WAY MULTILOCK ZO~WAY MULTILOCK IO-WAY MULTlLOCK
070,WHITE 070, YELLOW 070, WHITE
ZO~WAY IO-WAY 14~WAY 1%WAY 1G~WAY 13.WAY
MULTILOCK MULTILOCK MULTILOCK AUGAT 1.6, AUGAT 1 6, ECONOSEAL
070, WHITE 070 /YELLOW 070, GREY BLKK BLACK 11,LCiWHlTE
EM2 EM3 IJ1 iJ2 LF3 LF40 PI1 PI2 RH, RH2
l%WAY ST-WAY
ECONOSEAL SUMITOMO,
111LC, BLACK BLACK
IS~WAY Z&WAY 20.WAY
ECONOSEAL MULTlLOCK MULTILOCK
111LC, BLACK 070, GREY 070 /WHITE
SC3 SW1 SW2
12.WAY M”LT,LOCK 1%WAY MULTILOCK B-WAY JST , WHlTE
070, 040,
/ Access
FASCIA TOP CONNECTOR MOUNTlNG BRACKET, RIGHT HAND SIDE FASCIA BOTTOM CONNECTOR MOUNTING BRACKET, RIGHT HAND SiDE TRUNK /ABOVE RIGHT HAND REAR WHEEL ARCH ENGINE COMPARTMENT, ADJACENT TO RIGHT HAND ENCLOSURE ENGINE COMPARTMENTiADjACENTTO RIGHT HAND ENCLOSURE ENGINE COMPARTMENT,ADJACENTTO RIGHTHAND ENCLOSURE ENGlNE COMPARTMENT, FORWARD OF INTAKE MANIFOLD ENGINE COMPARTMENT/FORWARD OF ,NTAKE MANIFOLD ENGINE COMPARTMENT, LEFT HAND ENCLOSURE ENGINE COMPARTMENT, LEFT HAND ENCLOSURE ENGINE COMPARTMENT, BRACKET ON TOP OFTRANSMlSSlON ENGiNE COMPARTMENT, BRACKET ON TOP OF TRANSMlSSlON BEHIND GLOVE BOX REAR OF CENTER CONSOLE ASSEMBLY
GREY BLACK
RiGHT HAND SiDE OF STEERING COLUMN INSIDE STEERING COLUMN COWL CENTER OF STEERING WHEEL
GROUNDS
The following
symbols
are used to represent
I Input 0 output SG Signal Ground CAUTION: The information REFERENCE ONLY.
D C S
values for Control
Serial and encoded CAN (Network) SCP Network
communications
on this data page is furnished
NOTE: The values listed are approximately components connected and fitted. “Active”
Module
Pin Out data: B+ V Hz
to aid the user in understanding
Battery voltage Voltage (DC) Frequency circuit operation.
KHz MS MV
Frequency x 1000 Milliseconds Millivolts
THIS INFORMATION
Ground
Location
BTZAL EMlAR EM2AR FCBBL LF?AL
EYELET (PAIR1 - LEFT HAND LEG! TRUNK. RIGHT REAR EYELET IPAIR) - RlGHT HAND IEG, ENGINE COMPARTMENT, EYELET (PAIRI RlGHT HAND LEG, ENGINE COMPARTMENT. EYELET iPAIR, LEFT HAND LEG, TRANSMlSSiON TUNNEL,
RIGHT HAND ENCLOSURE LEFT HAND ENCLOSURE LEFT HAND SIDE
EYELET EYELET
FORWARD FORWARD
LF2BL
CONTROL
MODULE
I Type
(PAIR1 - LEFT HAND iPAiR - LEFT HAND
LEG, LEG,
ENGINE ENGINE
PIN OUT INFORMATION
COMPARTMENT. COMPARTMENT,
OF LEFT WAND HOOD CATCH OF LEFT HAND HOOD CATCH
(FOLD OUT PAGE)
SHOULD BE USED FOR +
those that can be expected at the control module connector pins with all circuit connections made and all means a load is applied or a switch is ON; “Inactive” means a load is not applied or a switch is OFF.
REFER TO THE FRONT OF THE BOOK FOR ILLUSTRATIONS DETAILING THE LOCATION AND IDENTIFICATION CONNECTORS, HARNESSES, GROUNDS, VEHICLE CONTROL MODULES AND CONTROL MODULE PINS. DATE
OF ISSUE:
FEBRUARY
1998
OF COMPONENTS.
RELAYS.
CONTROL
MODULE
TRANSMISSION
PIN OUT INFORMATION
CONTROL
MODULE:
AJ26 N/A
COMPONENTS
Description PRESSURE
Active
REGULATOR
C2
SPORT MODE SWITCH
STATUS
LEO
GROUND
,MAXlM”M
GROUND
= LED ON
PRESSURE1
Inactive
Component
Connector
B- ,NO PRESSURE1
D - 4 SWITCH
FC83,
Z-WA”
ST
GEAR SELECTOR
RX8
IO-WAY
ILLUMlNATlON
PRESSURE
REGULATOR
tS
GROUND
IMAXIMUM
PRESSURE,
B- iNO PRESSURE,
MODE SWITCH
PRESSURE
REGULATOR
il
GROUND
iMAXlM”M
PRESSURE,
B- iN0
TRANSMlSSlON
CONTROL
GROUND
TRANSMlSSiON
ELECTRICAL
TRANSMlSSlON
ROTARY
‘L2’ CONTACTS
B-
GROUND
‘L& CONTACTS
B-
GROUND
STRATEGY
GROUYD
SELECT
TURBINE OUTPUT
SPEED SEWOR
OUTPUT
SPEED SENSOR
SHlELD
SENSOR
FLUID TEMPERATURE
SENSOR
TURBINE
SPEED SENSOR
BA”ERY
POWER SUPPLY
ROTARY
‘D~4:
N’A
SWITCH
AMP M0L BOSCH
88~WAY
FRONT
BLACK
EM46
16.WAY
KOSTAL,
EM47
10.WAY
REINSHAGEN
ENGINE
BLACK MPLSO,
BLACK
ASSEMBLY,
REAR
OF GEAR SELECTOR
REARWARD
I BLACK
HARNESS-TO-HARNESS
GROUND
GROUND
Type I Color
GROUND
GROUND
AC12
2O~WAY MULTILOCK
070,
WHITE
FASCIATOP
EM1
Z&WAY
M”LTlLOCK
070
WHITE
ENGINE
COMP*RTMENT
ASSEMBLY
OF GEAR SELECTOR
COMPARTMENT,
CONTROL
TRANSMISSION,
LEFT H*ND
TRANSMISSION,
RIGHT
HAND
MODULE
ENCLOSURE
SlDE SIDE
CONNECTORS
EM3
14.WAY
MULTILOCK
070 ‘GREY
ENGINE
COMPARTMENT:AOJACENTTO
Location
/ Access CONKECTOR
MOVNTING ADJACENTTO
BRACKET,‘RlGHT
HAYD
SlOE
RIGHT HAND
ENCLOSURE
RIGHT H*ND
ENCLOSURE
FEEDBACK
SH,ELO
GROUND
GROUNDS
B-
KICK DOWN
Ad26
FC35,10-WAY EM7
/ Access
GEAR SELECTOR
070 /WHITE
Connector
YOT USED FLUID TEMPERATURE
CONNECTOR,
MULTILOCK
B.
300 Hz @ IDLE 12 5 Vi
SPEED SEYSOR
A.,26 WA
070 i YELLOW
9 V = NORMAL
= SPORT
GROUND
4 SWlTCH
MODULE
GROUND
ROTARY SWITCH D
(TRANSMISSION)
GROUND
ROTARY SWITCH
SPORT MODE SWiTCH
PRESSVRE,
MODULE
Location
I Type I Color MULTlLOCK
SWITCHES
COMMON
GROUND
GROUUD
PRESSURE
REGULATOR&2
B- iN0
Ground
Location
SOLENOID
VALVE II
B-
EMIAL
EYELET
IPAIR,
SOLENOID
VALVE #3
B-
EMlAL
EYELET
iPAiR1 - LEFT HAND
SOLENOID
VALVE #2
B+
FCSBR
EYELET
(PAIR,
PRESSURE,
/ Type LEFT HAND RIGHT
HAND
LEG ‘ENGINE
COMPARTMENT,
RIGHT
LEG,
COMPARTMENT.
LEFT HAND
LEG,
ENGINE
TRANSMISSION
TUNNEL,
HAND
ENCLOSURE ENCLOSVRE
LEFT HAND
SIDE
GROUND
GROUND ROTARY
SWITCH
‘L,’ CONTACTS
GROUND
ROTARY
SWITCH
I3
GROUND
TURBINE
SPEED SENSOR
0”TP”T
SPEED SENSOR
CONTACTS
SPORT MODE SWITCH
STRATEGY
PRESSURE
REGULATOR
SOLENOID
VALVES
PRESSURE
REGULATORS
SELECT
GROUND
f5
B- iN0
COMMON
MODULE
PIN OUT INFORMATION
(FOLD OUT PAGE)
= NORMAL PRESSURE)
B-
SUPPLY
COMMON
CONTROL
B+
SUPPLY
IGNITION
SWITCHED
POWER SUPPLY
GROVND
IGNITION
SWITCHED
POWER SUPPLY
GROUND
CAN NETWORK CAN NETWORK CAN NETWORK CAN NETWORK
GEAR SELECTOR v
ILLUMINATION
MODULE
Pin FC88-1
IGNITION
C
FC88-3
CAN NETWORK
15-,sooHzQ25”
c
FC88~4
CAN NETWORK
15-l5&3HiQ25”
Description SWITCHEO
POWER SUPPLY
Active
Inactive
St
GROUND
I
FC88-6
GROUND
GROUND
C
FC88-8
CAN NETWORK
[email protected]”
C
FC88~9
CAN NETWORK
15-1500
NOTE: REFER TO THE APPENDIX
The following
symbols
CAUTION: The information REFERENCE ONLY.
D C S
[email protected]
AT THE REAR OF THIS BOOK FOR CAN AND SCP NETWORK
are used to represent
I Input 0 output SG Signal Ground
GROUND
values for Control
Serial and encoded CAN (Network) SCP Network
communications
on this data page is furnished
NOTE: The values listed are approximately components connected and fitted. “Active”
Module
MESSAGES.
Pin Out data: B+ V Hz
Battery voltage Voltage (DC) Frequency
to aid the user in understanding
circuit operation.
KHz Frequency x 1000 MS Milliseconds MV Millivolts THIS INFORMATION
SHOULD BE USED FOR
those that can be expected at the control module connector pins with all circuit connections made and all means a load is applied or a switch is ON; “Inactive” means a load is not applied or a switch is OFF.
REFER TO THE FRONT OF THE BOOK FOR ILLUSTRATIONS DETAILING THE LOCATION AND IDENTIFICATION CONNECTORS, HARNESSES, GROUNDS, VEHICLE CONTROL MODULES AND CONTROL MODULE PINS. DATE
OF ISSUE:
FEBRUARY
1998
OF COMPONENTS,
RELAYS,
CONTROL
MODULE
PIN OUT INFORMATION
GEAR SELECTOR ILLUMINATION MODULE 7 Pin Description I FC88-1 lGNlTlON SWITCHED POWER SUPPLY c FC88-3 CANNETWORK c FC884 CANNETWORK I FC88-6 GROUND c FC88Z CANNETWORK c FC88~9 CANNETWORK TRANSMISSION -. / ’ Pin c EM,* L c EM,*-H I EM72-12
CONTROL
MODULE:
0
EM72-13
SPEED SENSOR
EM72~14
‘1~2
4-5’
COMMON
SOLENOID
0
EM,*-l5
‘3-C SOLENOID
ACTIVATE
EM72 16
‘2~3’ SOLENOID
ACTIVATE
D
EM72~17
KC
ACTIVATE
0
EM72-33
SPEED SENSOR
EM72-34
FLUID TEMP
EM72~35
“3 SPEED SENSOR
SOLENOID
0
EM,*-36
MODULATION
K,CKDOWN
VOLTAGE
0
EM72~37
SHIFT PRESSURE
0
EM,*-38
SOLENOID
SUPPLY
GROUND COMMON
GROUND
REGULATOR
ACTIVATE
ACTIVATE REGULATOR
COMMON
VOLTAGE
SUPPLY
42% PWM @ IDLE)
GROUND
t 39% PWM @ IDLE1
GROUND GROUND
= R, D, 4.3
SWITCH
VOLTAGE
ENCODED
GEAR RECOGNlTlON
GROVND
= N, D. 4.2
LINEAR
SWITCH
VOLTAGE
ENCODED
GEAR RECOGNITION
GROUND
= N. 4.3.2
DUAL LINEAR
SWITCH
VOLTAGE
ENCODED
GEAR RECOGNiilON
GROUND
= P, D, 3.2
SUPPLIED
VOLTAGE
DUAL LINEAR
SWITCH
NOTE: REFER TO THE APPENDIX
symbols
CAUTION: The information REFERENCE ONLY.
D C S
URANSMiSSlON,
TRANSMlSSlON
CONTROL
TRANSMlSSlON
ELECTRICAL
MODULE
CONNECTOR:
/ Access SIDE OF GEAR SELECTOR,
ACZS/?-WAYiECONOSEAL1IILCIBLACK
“NDER
ACCELERATOR
FC35,
REARWARD
MULTlLOCK
IO~WAY AMP MOL, 14.WAY 18.WAY
GBi ,13-WAY
A.,26 SC
LEFT HAND
GREY
OF GEAR SELECTOR
EMX!, EM73:
AJ26 SC
070,
FRONT
FC88,10-WAY
MODULE
SWITCH
MODE SWITCH
MULTILOCK
070iWHlTE BLACK
AMP JUNIOR AMP JUNIOR KOSTAL
POWER TIMER! POWER TIMER!
ENGINE
BLACK BLACK
CENTER
CONSOLE
ASSEMBLY
PEDAL
OF GEAR SELECTOR
COMPARTMENT/CONTROL
MODULE
ENCLOSURE
TRANSMlSSlON
1 5 I BLACK
GROUND
SUPPLY
Serial and encoded CAN (Network) SCP Network
NOTE: The values listed are approximately comPonents connected and fitted. “Active”
/ Access
070! WHlTE
FASCIA
TOP CONNECTOR
MOUNTING
EM1
20 WAY MULTlLOCK
070,
ENGINE
COMPARTMENT:
ADJACENTTO
WHlTE
BRACKET RIGHT
i RlGHT HAND
HAND
SIDE
ENCLOSURE
EM2
?&WAY
MULTlLOCK
070 /YELLOW
ENGINE
COMPARTMENT,ADJACENTTO
RIGHT
HAND
ENCLOSURE
EM3
Id-WAY
MVLTlLOCK
070,
ENGINE
COMP~RIMENT,ADJACENTTO
RIGHT
HAND
ENCLOSURE
GE
12~WAY AUGAT
ENGINE
COMPARTMENT!
1.5,
GREY
BLACK
BRACKET
ON TOP OF TRANSMISSION
GROUNDS (PAIR,
LEFT HAND
LEG,
ENGfNE
COMPARTMENT,
RIGHT
BB-
EMWL
EYELET
(PAIR, - LEFT HAND
LEG,
ENGINE
COMPARTMENT,
LEFT HAND
ENCLOSURE
FCBBL
EYELET
(PAIR, - LEFT HAND
LEG /TRANSMISSION
LEFT HAND
SIDE
GROUND
FCBBR
EYELET
(PAIRI - RIGHi
CONTROL
MODULE
/ Type
HAND
LEG,
TUNNEL,
TRANSMISSION
PIN OUT INFORMATION
TUNNEL,
HA.ND ENCLOSURE
LEFT HAND
SIDE
(FOLD OUT PAGE)
+
BT = R. N. 4 GROUND GROUND
MESSAGES.
Pin Out data:
communications
on this data page is furnished
Location
20 WAY MULTILOCK
Location
B- = P, R, 3
GROUND
Module
CONNECTORS
Type / Color
BL = P
8”=R,D
AT THE REAR OF THIS BOOK FOR CAN AND SCP NETWORK
values for Control
HARNESS-TO-HARNESS Connector AC12
B- = P. N, 2
BCOMMON
are used to represent
I Input 0 output SG Signal Ground
ILLUMINATION
Location
I Type / Color
72.WAY
EYELET
B- c< WOTi
t= WOTj
GEAR RECOGNITION
D”AL
IGNlTlON
FC100:
EMlAL
0 v = SPORT, 0 ” = NORMAL ENCODED
DUAL LINEAR
KM!
The following
GROUND, B+
SWITCH VOLTAGE
Connector SWITCH
Ground
5”=85HI~,0MPH,16KPHI;170Hr@20MPH~32XPHi (‘2’ SELECTED ‘2’ ENGAGED)
REGULATOR
SWITCH
= LOCKED
1.75 v Q 90’ c = R, D, 4.3.2
SPORT MODE SWlTCH DUAL LlNEAR
B+ B+ BB- = UNLOCKED GROUND S”=P.N
GROUND
FEEDBACK
VALVE i PRESSURE
KICKDOWN
Inactive
Active
FEEDBACK
PRESSURE
LINEAR
AJ26 SC
: FLUID TEMP. SENSOR
SENSOR
DUAL
GROUND
ACTIVATE
0
Component
GROUND
GEAR SELECTOR
Description CANNEWORK CANNETWORK n2SPEED SENSOR FEEDBACK
0
1
COMPONENTS Inactive
B+ V Hz
to aid the user in understanding
at the those that can be expected means a load is applied or a switch
control
KHz Frequency x 1000 MS Milliseconds MV Millivolts
Battery voltage Voltage (DC) Frequency circuit operation. module
is ON; “Inactive”
connector
THIS INFORMATION pins
with
all
circuit
means a load is not applied
SHOULD BE USED FOR
connections made and all or a switch is OFF.
REFER TO THE FRONT OF THE BOOK FOR ILLUSTRATIONS DETAILING THE LOCATION AND lDENTlFlCATlON CONNECTORS, HARNESSES, GROUNDS, VEHICLE CONTROL MODULES AND CONTROL MODULE PINS. DATE
OF ISSUE:
FEBRUARY
1998
OF COMPONENTS,
RELAYS,
CONTROL
MODULE
PIN OUT INFORMATION COMPONENTS
BODY PROCESSOR MODULE ;J Pin Description FC14-15 IGNITION SWITCHED I
FC14-32
IGNITION
0
FC14-48
GEARSHIFT
0
FC14~5,
KEY LOCK SOLENOID
SWITCHED
GROUND
SUPPLY
GROUND
GROUND
SUPPLY
GROUND
lNTERLOCK
I
FC14-58
NOT-IN-PARK
I
FC14~80
BAKERY
S
FC14-84
SCP NETWORK
S
FC14-85
SW NETWORK
I
FC14-104
LIGHTING,
Inactive
Active
SOLENOID
SUPPLY
POWER SUPPLY
BODY PROCESSOR
GROUND
B- ,GEARSHIFT
SUPPLY ,LOGlC,
GROUND
FREE)
BL (KEY CAPTIVE,
GROUND
GROUND
B+ (PARK)
iR.N.D.4.3.21
,GEARSHlFT
LOCKED)
ENGINE
CONTROL
GEARSELECTOR
2-1500HZ BA”ERY
POWER SUPPLY
B+
B,
GEARSHIFT
Inactive 53,
Active
I
EM10-10
BRAKE SWITCH
GROUND
EM10~28
CAN NETWORK
1551500HZ
c
EM,O-27
CAN NETWORK
15-1500Hr
c
FC88-9
CAN NETWORK
MAJOR D
ILLUMINATION
CAN NEWORK
S
Pin FCE-19
S c c
Inactive
PACK Active 2-1600H2
Fc?S-20
SW NETWORK
2 - ,600
FCZ524
CAN NEWORK
15
1500 Hi
FCZS-47
CAN NETWORK
15
1500 Hz
CAUTION: The information REFERENCE ONLY.
EM,0 : zsw*\y EM,, / IS-WAY EM12 Z-WAY EM,3,34-WAY EM14 / 12.WAY EM15 22.WAY
MULTlLOCK MULTILOCK MULTILOCK MULTILOCK MULTILOCK M”LTlLOCK47
FC88,
IO-WAY
MULTILOCK
FIX?,
Z~WAY MVLTILOCK
SC, II 12.WAY
SWlTCHGEARi
MULTILOCK
FC25 ! 489fvAY FC26 i Z&WAY
PACK
FC87 : 3.WAY
MICROSWTCH
MVLTILOCK
ENGINE
040, GREY 040 i GREY 040, GREY WI! GREY /WHITE : WHlTE
FRONT
070 i WHlTE 070,
i CONTROL
OF GEAR SELECTOR
STEERING
WHITE
AIRBAG
BRACKET
PEDAL
COMPARTMENT
GEAR SELECTOR
070 /WHITE
AMP PCB SGNAL: AMP PCB SIGNAL
/ Access SIDE FASCIA,
TOP OF BRAKE
WHITE
MODULE
ENCLOSURE
ASSEMBLY
ASSEMBLY
COLUMN
FASCIA
BLXK i BLACK
GEAR SELECTOR
070 ,’ WHITE
ASSEMBLY
CONNECTORS Location
/ Access
Connector AC13
Type / Color 20.WAY
MULTILOCK
070 /YELLOW
FASC,A
BOFFOM
EM,
20.WAY
MULTILOCK
070,
ENG,NE
COMPARTMENT/ADJACENT
WHITE
D C S
values for Control
Serial and encoded CAN (Network) SCP Network
communications
on this data page is furnished
NOTE: The values listed are approximately components connected and fitted. “Active”
Module
Ground
Location
FC2BR
EYELET
IPAIR) -RIGHT
HAND
LEG,
RIGHT
FC3BR
EYELET
(PAIR, - RlGHT
HAND
LEG,
TRANSMISSION
FC4BR
EYELET
IPAIR)
HAND
LEG,
LEFT HAND
CONTROL
Hz
CONNECTOR
MOUNTING
BRACKET,
TO RIGHT HAND
RIGHT
HAND
SIDE
ENCLOSURE
/ Type
RIGHT
HAND
‘A’ POST TUNNEL.
LEFT HAND
SIDE
‘A’ POST
MODULE
PIN OUT INFORMATION
(FOLD OUT PAGEI
t-
AT THE REAR OF THIS BOOK FOR CAN AND SCP NETWORK
are used to represent
Input output Signal Ground
iCOLUMN
070,
Location PASSENGER
Inactive
Description
symbols
NOT-IN-PARK
I Type I Color AMP EEECIGREY
GROUNDS
NOTE: REFER TO THE APPENDIX
I 0 SG
MODULE
SW NETWORK
The following
SOLENOID
MODVLE
SOLENOID
HARNESS-TO-HARNESS
Description CANNETWORK CANNETWDRK
INSTRUMENT
lLL”MlNATlDN
,NTERLOCK
MA.JOR lNSTR”MENT
c
Pin FC88-4 FC88-3 FC88~8
MODULE
(KEY RELEASED)
2 - ,600 HZ
MOTORS
704.WAY
AC24 ! 4~WAY MULTILOCK
B-
B+
ENGINE CONTROL MODULE 7 Pin Description
;;;i c c c
FCld;
MODULE
BRAKE SWITCH
KEYLOCK
GEAR SELECTOR
Connector
Component
MESSAGES.
Pin Out data: B+ V Hz
to aid the user in understanding
Battery voltage Voltage (DC) Frequency circuit
operation.
KHz MS MV
Frequency x 1000 Milliseconds Millivolts
THIS INFORMATION
SHOULD BE USED FOR
those that can be expected at the control module connector pins with all circuit connections made and all means a load is applied or a switch is ON; “Inactive” means a load is not applied or a switch is OFF.
REFER TO THE FRONT OF THE BOOK FOR ILLUSTRATIONS DETAILING THE LOCATION AND IDENTlFlCATlON CONNECTORS, HARNESSES, GROUNDS, VEHICLE CONTROL MODULES AND CONTROL MODULE PINS. DATE
OF ISSUE:
FEBRUARY
1998
OF COMPONENTS,
RELAYS,
CONTROL
MODULE
PIN OUT INFORMATION
ABS /TRACTION CONTROL CONTROL MODULE \I Pin Description 0 LF37-1 BRAKE FLUIDRESERVOIR LEVEL SWITCH REFERENCE LKw2 BRAKE SWlTCH LF37-3 RHFRONT WHEEL SPEED SENSOR SG LF37-4 RHFRONT WHEEL SPEED SENSOR c LF37~5 CANNETWORK SG LF37~6 RHREAR WHEEL SPEED SENSOR I LF37-7 RHREAR WHEEL SPEED SENSOR LF37-8 GROUND LF379 EATERYPOWER SUPPLY LF37-10 NOTUSED LF37-l, NOT“SE0 / LF37-13 BRAKE FLUIDRESERVOIR LEVEL SWiTCH STABILITY,
TRACTION
CONTROL
SWATCH
CONTROL
SWlTCH
COMPONENTS Inactive E+ B+
Connector
Component AES /TRACTION BRAKE FLUID
CONTROL
CONTROL
MODULE
RESERVOlR
BRAKE SWTCH
AMP
EM37 / Z-WAY
AMP JUNIOR
AC24,
MULTILOCK
I TRACTION
BLACK POWER TIMER,
BLACK
E+
HARNESS-TO-HARNESS
LEO
Location / Access FASClABOTTOM CONNECTOR
Ei
TRUNK,
LH FRONT WHEEL
SPEED SENSOR
REAR OF REAR HUB ASSEMBLY,
LEFT HAND
REAR OF REAR HUB ASSEMBLY,
RIGHT
NOT USED
ENGINE
GROUND
AT THE REAR OF THIS BOOK FOR CAN AND SCP NETWORK
MESSAGES.
REAR WHEEL
LEFT HAND
ENGINE
COMPARTMENT,ADJACENTTO
ENGINE
COMPARTMENTiADJACENTTOAlR
BEHIND
ES+
RIGHT HAND
COMPARTMENT,
LEFT HAND
GROUND POWER SUPPLY
ABOVE
MOUNTING BRACKET,
SPEED SENSOR
NOTE: REFER TO THE APPENDIX
FRONT
LEFT
ENGINE
COMPARTMENT,
BRAKE
BOOSTER
ENCLOSURE
PEDAL
CONNECTORS
LH FRONT WHEEL
BATTERY
COMPARTMENT,
TOP OF BRAKE
070 I WHITE
/ Access
ENGINE
B-
B+ STATE
HYBRID,
GROUtiD
CAN NETWORK STABILITY
I-WAY
Location
/ Type / Color
LF37 i E-WAY
‘K POST CONNECTOR
GLOVE
RIGHT
HANDSIOE
ARCH
HAND
SlDE SIDE
ENCLOSURE ENGINE
COMPARTMENT
FUSE BOX
CLEANER MOUNTlNG
BRACKET,
‘4’ POST TRIM
BOX
GROUNDS Location / Type EYELET PAIR,- RIGHTHANDLEG,RIGHTHAND‘K POST EYELET ,PAlR,- RIGHT HANDLEG, LEFTHAND‘N POST
Ground FClER FC4BR LFSAS CONTROL
EYELET
MODULE
ISINGW,ENGINE
COMPARTMENT,
PIN OUT INFORMATION
FORWARD
OF LEFT HAND
HOOD CATCH
(FOLD OUT PAGE)
+
The following
symbols
are used to represent
I Input 0 output SG Signal Ground CAUTION: The information REFERENCE ONLY.
D C S
Serial and encoded CAN (Network) SCP Network
Module
communications
on this data page is furnished
NOTE: The values listed are approximately connected and fitted. “Active”
COmPOnentS
values for Control
Pin Out data: B+ V Hz
Battery voltage Voltage (DC) Frequency
to aid the user in understanding
circuit operation.
KHz Frequency x 1000 MS Milliseconds MV Millivolts THIS INFORMATION
SHOULD BE USED FOR
those that can be expected at the control module connector pins with all circuit connections made and all means a load is applied or a switch is ON; “Inactive” means a load is not applied or a switch is OFF.
REFER TO THE FRONT OF THE BOOK FOR ILLUSTRATIONS DETAILING THE LOCATION AND lDENTlFlCATlON CONNECTORS, HARNESSES, GROUNDS, VEHICLE CONTROL MODULES AND CONTROL MODULE PINS. DATE
OF ISSUE:
FEBRUARY
1998
OF COMPONENTS.
RELAYS,
CONTROL
MODULE
PIN OUT INFORMATION
AIR CONDITIONING CONTROL MODULE \I Pin Description 0 ACM DEFROST VENTSERVO MOTOR 0
AC,-7
COMPONENTS B+
CENTER VENT SERVO MOTOR
B+
0
ACM
LH FRESH i RECIRCULATION
VENT MOTOR
B+
0
ACE
RH FRESH,
RECIRCULATION
VENT MOTOR
B-
0
AC1~12
FOOTWELL
VENT SERVO MOTOR
0
AC,-13
COOL AIR BYPASS
0
AC,-19
DEFROST
0
ACb20
CENTER VENT SERVO MOTOR
0
AC,-21
LH FRESH I RECIRCULATION
VENTSERVO
MOTOR
B-
VENT SERVO MOTOR
P,-
BBB-
0
AC,-22
RH FRESH ‘RECIRCULATION
0
NY-25
FOOnvELL
0
AC1~26
COOL AIR BYPASS
AC2-1
SOLAR SENSOR
AC2 2
CENTER VENT POTENTIOMETER
ACZ-3
RH FRESH:
AC-5
COOL AIR BYPASS
SERVO MOTOR
B-
SERVO MOTOR
ENGINE
DEFROSTVENT
ACZ-11
LH FRESH,
AC*-13
FOOTWELLVENT
0
AC-2
CLOCK
D
AC3~3
SERIAL
I
AK-5
AMBIENT
BA
FEEDBACK
0 75 ” - 4.75 “: INCREASiNG
RECIRCULATION
ACX
FEEDBACK VENT POTENTIOMETER
VENT POTENTIOMETER
FEEDBACK
FEEDBACK
COOLANTTEMPERATURE REClRCULATlON
FEEDBACK
POTENTIOMETER
FEEDBACK
FEEDBACK
DATA OUTPUT
TO CONTROL
PANEL
SENSOR
FEEDBACK
TEMPERATURE
AC36
HEATER
AC-7
SERfAL DATA INPUT
0
AC38
START
I
AK-11
IN CAR TEMPERATURE
I
AX-12
EVAPORATOR
AC4-1
IGNITION
AC4-2
ISOLATE
AC4-3
IGNITION
AC4-4
CONTROL
AC4-5
BATTERY
AC46
ENGINE
AIR CONDITIONING
CONTROL
PANEL
MATRIX
TEMPERATURE
SENSOR
FROM CONTROL
FEEDBACK
AIR INT*KE
- RH BLOWER
NC “NIT
AMBIENTTEMPERATURE ASPIRATOR
8 HEATER
TEMPERATURE
SWITCHED
SENSOR
AlC “NIT!
MATRlXASSEMBLY
SWITCHED
BATTERY
A/C “NIT
VENT ASSEMBLY
SIDE
HAND
RIGHT
SIDE
HAND
HORN
LEFT HAND
SIDE ADJACENT
TO DEFROST
“EN7
‘TOP
RELAYS Relay ISOLATE
RELAY
Color / Stripe
Connector
BLACK,
FC24,“IOLET
VIOLET
/ Color
Location RH FASCIA
I Access RELAYS
WITH TEMPERATURE c 1”
= OPEN
= CLOSED
>35”=OPEN
< 1 V = CLOSED
>35”=OPEN
< 1 V = CLOSED
2.18 V Q 25’ C; DECREASING
WITH TEMPERATURE
2 25 V @ WC:
WITH TEMPERATURE
DECREASlNG
HARNESS-TO-HARNESS Connector
CONNECTORS Location
Type / Color
/ Access CONNECTOR
MOUNTING
BRACKET,
RIGHT HAND
SiDE
FASCIA
BOTTOM
CONNECTOR
MOUNTING
BRACKET,
RlGHT
HAND
SIDE
FASCIA
BO”OM
CONNECTOR
MOUNTING
BRACKET,
RIGHT HAND
SIDE
FASCIA
BOTTOM
CONNECTOR
MOUNTING
BRACKET,
RIGHT HAND
SIDE
‘K POST CONNECTOR
MOUNTING
BRACKET,‘A’POSTTRlM
0”
3 25 V Q 0” C, DECREASING
WlTH TEMPERATURE
3 25 “Q
WITH TEMPERATURE
O’C, DECREASING
GROUNDS
POWER SUPPLY
GROUND
PANEL BATERY
LEFT HAND IRIGHT
DRIVER SIDE FASCIA!
SENSOR
AIR CONDlTlONlNG
POWER SUPPLY
RELAY CONTROLLED
SIDE
DRIVER KNEE BOLSTER
LEFT HAND
FEEDBACK
HAND
CONSOLE
ADJACENTTO
SENSOR
ASSEMBLY
EVAPORATOR SOLAR
/ Access
N/c “NIT/RIGHT
GREY GREY GREY GREY
CENTER
PANEL
FEEDBACK
47: 47, 47, 47,
A/C “NlT,
< 1 ” = CLOSED
B+ (MOMENTARY! SENSOR
Location
/ Type / Color MULTILOCK MULTlLOCK MULTlLOCK MVLTlLOCK
- LH BLOWER
>35”.OPEN DECREASING
AC,, 26.WAY AC2, IS-WAY AC3,12-WAY AC4,22-WAY
A,R INTAKE
c 1” = CLOSED
POWER SUPPLY
POWER SUPPLY
0”
Ground
Location
0”
FC2BR
EYELET
(PAIR) -RIGHT
/ Type
B+
FCSCS
EYELET
(SINGLE,,
0”
FC4BR
EYELET
(PAIR) -RIGHT
HAND
LEG,
TRANSMISSION HAND
LEG,
RIGHT HAND TUNNEL.
‘A’ POST
LEFT HAND
LEFT HAND
SIDE
‘N POST
B+
SPEED SlGNAL
0
AC4-8
POTENTIOMETER
.x4-10
SERIAL COMMUNlCATlONS
INPUT
0
AC4~12
CONTROL
POWER SUPPLY
/x4-13
GROUND
0
AW14
CONTROL
0
AC4~15
ISOLATE
RELAY ACTIVE
B+
AC4-16
VEHICLE
SPEED SIGNAL
22 Hz @ 10 MPH 116 KM/H,,
0
AC4-18
ASPIRATOR
0
At%19
POTENTlOMETER
AW20
GROUND
ACI-21
SERIAL COMMUNICATIONS
symbols
MODULE
35”=OPEN
> 3.5”
VENT POTENTIOMETER
WITH SOLAR
Connector
Component
,35”=OPEN
2.5 V @ WC,
POTENTIOMETER
D
0
L
VENT SERVO MOTOR
VENT SERVO MOTOR
AC*-10
Inactive 0” 0” 0” 0” 0” 0” 0” 0” 0” 0” 0” 0”
Active
COMMON
PANEL BATTERY PANEL GROUND
MOTOR
REFERENCE
SUPPLY
POWER SUPPLY
COMMON
REFERENCE
CAUTION: The information REFERENCE ONLY.
D C S
GROUND
5”
CONTROL +
B+
B-
0”
0”
0”
0”
MODULE
PIN OUT INFORMATION
(FOLD OUT PAGE)
0” 44 Hz @ 20 MPH (32 KM/H,
@ B+
B-
0”
0”
0”
0”
0”
OUTPUT
are used to represent
I Input 0 output SG Signal Ground
VOLTAGE
values for Control
Serial and encoded CAN (Network) SCP Network
on this data page is furnished
NOTE: The values listed are approximately components connected and fitted. “Active”
Module
communications
to
aid
the
Pin Out data: B+ V Hz
user
in understanding
Battery voltage Voltage (DC) Frequency circuit
operation.
KHz Frequency x 1000 MS Milliseconds MV Millivolts THIS INFORMATION
SHOULD BE USED FOR
those that can be expected at the control module connector pins with all circuit connections made and all means a load is applied or a switch is ON; “Inactive” means a load is not applied or a switch is OFF.
REFER TO THE FRONT OF THE BOOK FOR ILLUSTRATIONS DETAILING THE LOCATION AND IDENTIFICATION CONNECTORS, HARNESSES, GROUNDS, VEHICLE CONTROL MODULES AND CONTROL MODULE PINS. DATE
OF ISSUE:
FEBRUARY
1998
OF COMPONENTS,
RELAYS.
CONTROL
MODULE
PIN OUT INFORMATION
ENGINE CONTROL MODULE ‘7 Pin Description
COMPONENTS
AICCM
LOAD INHlBlT
AlCCM
ELECTRICAL
AiCCM
COMPRESSOR
CLUTCH
4-WAY REFRIGERANT
SWITCH
4-WAY
LOAD SIGNAL BEClUES HIGH PRESSURE
REFRIGERANTSWITCH
AIR CONDlTlONlNG
HIGH PRESSURE
COMPRESSOR
RELAY ACTI’$ATE
0
EMIS-
SERIES ILOW) SPEED FAY ACTIVATE
0
EM13-16
PARALLEL
IHIGH) SPEED FAN ACTIVATE
AIR CONDITIONING CONTROL I Pin Description COMPRESSOR
B7
AIR CONDITIONING
COMPRESSOR
B+
GROUND
AIR CONDITIONING
CONTROL
BA
GROVNO
GROUND
0 20 BAR ,290 PSli
GROUND
@ 12 BAR 1174 PSI,
GROUND
B-
GROUND
B-
GROUND
B7
Active STATUS
B+ 0”
B+
0”
B-
0”
RELAY ACTIVE HEATER
HEATER
MOTOR
RELAYS ACTIVATE
PUMP RELAY ACTIVATE
HEATED
BACKLIGHT
RELAY ACTIVATE
ACZ-7
RHBLOWERSPEEDFEEDBACK
*CT*-8
RH BLOWER
SPEED CONTROL
1
AC2-15
LH BLOWER
SPEED FEEDBACK
At216
LH BLOWER
SPEED CONTROL
I
ACS-7
LOAD INHIBIT
AC4-9
COMPRESSOR
1
Awl,
REFRIGERANTCWAY
7.6” DRIVE SiGNAL DRIVE SIGNAL
ELECTRICAL
= LOW SPEED
0.83”
= HIGH SPEED
S”MlTOM0
090 HYBRlD
! GREEN
A/C “NIT,
AC6,
SUMITOMO
090 HYBRID
i GREEN
A/C “NIT,
CONTROL
IS-WAY
EM?0 2%WAY EM,, ! 16.WAY EM12, Z-WAY EM13 34.WAY EM14,72-WAY EM15 :22-WAY
MODULE
LF5,10-WAY LF6, ,&WAY LF7, IO-WAY LFB / IO-WAY LF70, EYELET
COMPARTMENT
MULTILOCK MULTILOCK MULTILOCK MULTILOCK MULTILOCK MULTILOCK U.T.A. U.T.A. U.T.A. UT A.
BTlO , ?&WAY BTll / IO~WAY BT12, IO-WAY BT13, ,O~WAY BT64, EYELET
040, GREY 040 i GREY 0401 GREY 040: GREY 47 {WHITE 47 /WHITE
FUSEBOX FUSEBOX! FUSEBOX, FUSEBOX,
“.T A. U.T.A. U T.A U TA.
i NATURAL BLACK GREEN BLUE
FUSEBOX, FUSEBOX FUSEBOX, FUSEBOX!
RIGHT HAND
LEFT HAND COMPARTMENT
ENGlNE
COMPARTMENT!
TRUNK,
NATURAL / BLACK GREEN BLUE
SIDE
RIGHT HAND
ENGINE
ELECTRICAL
BACKLIGHT,
RIGHT
COMPRESSOR SIDE
SIDE I CONTROL
MODULE
ENCLOSURE
LEFT FRONT
CARRIER
HAND
SIDE
HEATED
BACKLIGHT
RH17;L”CAIR
RIGHTANGLE
HEATER
PUMP
EM41 /Z-WAY
ECONOSEAL
111LC / BLACK
ENGINE
COMPARTMENT,
BULKHEAD,
LEFT HAND
SIDE
HEATERVALVE
EM43,2-WAY
ECONOSEAL
111LC, WHITE
ENGINE
COMPARTMENT,
BULKHEAD,
LEFT HAND
SIDE
MlRROR
DD8,
MULTlLOCK
040,
BLUE
DRIVER DOOR
MULTILOCK
040,
BLUE
PASSENGER
DRIVER
,l~WAY
DPB,
RADlATOR
FAN CONTROL
= LOW SPEED
0.83”
RADlATOR
FAN - RH
1.3”
= LOW SPEED
0 ” = HIGH SPEED
REFRIGERANT4~WAY
LF9,
RELAY MODULE
PRESSURE
SWITCH
,*-WAY &WAY
TRW,
ADJACENT
BLACK
LF13,
Z-WAY
REINSHAGEN
LF12,
&WAY
REINSHAGEN
LF57,
&WAY
ECONOSEAL
DOOR TO LEFT HAND
HORN
METRI
630,
BLACK
ENGINE
COMPARTMENT,
FRONT
METRI
630,
BLACK
ENGINE
111LC, BLACK
COMPARTMENT,
FRONT
ENGINE
COMPARTMENT,
REARWARD
COMPARTMENT, COMPARTMENT,
WlNDSHlELD
HEATER
- LH
EM49,
Z-WAY AMP SERIES
187C,
GREY
ENGINE
WINDSHIELD
HEATER
- RH
EM48,
Z-WAY AMP SERIES
18X,
GREY
ENGINE
OF RADIATOR
RELAYS
0” BT ,O”T
A/C “NIT,
GREY GREY GREY GREY
&X,15-WAY
7 5”
SWlTCH
471 47! 47; 47 :
- RH
FAN - LH
ON REQUEST PRESSURE
MULTILOCK MULTILOCK MULTILOCK MULTILOCK
/ Access
COMPARTMENT,A,C
- LH
RADIATOR
0”
AC, ,26-WAY AU, 16.WAY AC3,12~WAY AC4 1 SWAY
ENGINE
BLACK
MOTOR
0 ” = HIGH SPEED
LOAD SlGNAL
090 A-TYPE,
MOTOR
1.3 V = LOW SPEED
= HIGH SPEED
Location
I Type / Color
I~WAY SUMlTOMO
BLOWER
FUSE BOX-TRUNK
B+ CLUTCH
MODULE
MIRROR-PASSENGER
1 0
0
0”
RELAY ACTIVATE
HEATER
AIR CONDITIONING
0”
RELAYACTIVATE
PI%,
CLUTCH
BLOWER ENGlNE
Inactive 0” 0” B, B+ B0”
Br iON, E+
MOTOR
Connector
FUSE BOX - ENGlNE
HEATER VALVE ACTIVE
LH BLOWER
AC3-1
Component
GROUND
RH BLOWER
LH ,‘RH WINDSHIELD
0
Inactive
MODULE
CLUTCH
DOOR MIRROR
0
Active
OF ACTIVE
RANGE)
Relay AIR CONDITIONING
COMPRESSOR
CLUTCH
RELAY
Color / Stripe
Connector
BROWN
BUS
Location
/ Color
/ Access
LH ENCLOSURE
RELAYS
BLOWER
MOTOR
RELAY-
LH
BLACK,
BLUE
ACZO,
BLUE
DRIVESHAFTTUNNEL
RELAYS
BLOWER
MOTOR
RELAY - RH
BLACK,
BLUE
*cm,
BLUE
DRiVESHAFT
RELAYS
BLUE
DOOR MIRROR
HEATER
HEATED
BACKLIGHT
HEATER
PUMP
RELAY
RELAY
1#21
RELAY (#1)
LH FASCIA
BLACK/BLUE
FC28,
BROWN
BUS
TRUNK
BROWN
BUS
ENGINE
TUNNEL RELAYS
RELAYS COMPARTMENT
WlNOSHlELD
HEATER
RELAY-
LH
BROWN
EM44,
BROWN
RH ENCLOSURE
RELAYS
WiNDSHlELD
HEATER
RELAY
RH
BROWN
EM45,
BROWN
RH ENCLOSURE
RELAYS
HARNESS-TO-HARNESS Connector
CONNECTORS Location
Type / Color
FASCIA
/ Access
TOP CONNECTOR
MOUNTING
BRACKET,
RIGHT HAND
SIDE
PO-WAY MULTILOCK
070,
WHITE
?&WAY
070,
YELLOW
FASCIA
BOTTOM
CONNECTOR
MOUNTING
BRACKET,
RIGHT
HAND
SIDE
BOTTOM
CONNECTOR
MO”NT,NG
BRACKET,
RlGHT
HAND
SIDE
ABOVE
RIGHT HAND
REAR WHEEL
ARCH
RIGHT
REAR WHEEL
ARCH
MULTILOCK
20.WA’,
MULTILOCK
070,
GREY
FASCIA
20.WAY
MULTILOCK
070,
WHITE
TRUNK,
d-WAY
ECONOSEAL
TRUNK/ABOVE
111HC, BLACK
23~WAY AMP - FORD,
BLACK
DRl”ER
23.WAY
BLACK
PASSENGER
AMP
FORD,
HAND
SlDE ‘N POST MO”NT,NG SIDE ‘R POST,‘A’
BRACKET,
‘R POST TRlM
POSTTRIM
Z&WAY
MULTILOCK
070 /WHITE
ENGINE
COMPARTMENT,ADJACENITO
RiGHT
HAND
ENCLOSURE
IB-WAY
MULTiLOCK
070,
ENGINE
COMPARTMENTiADJACENTTO
RIGHT
HAND
ENCLOSURE
1%WAY
ECONOSEAL
13WAY
FUSE BOX RELAYS
ECONOSEAL
X-WAY
MULTILOCK
57.WAY
SUMlTOMO,
X-WAY
M”LTILOCK
YELLOW
111LC / WHlTE
ENGINE
COMPARTMENT,
LEFT HAN0
ENCLOSURE
111LC I BLACK
ENGINE
COMPARTMENT,
LEFT HAND
ENCLOSURE
070,
LEFT HAND
WHITE
ENGINE
BLACK
‘A’ POST CONNECTOR
REAR OF CENTER
070 l WHlTE
MO”NTlNG
COMPARTMENT,BRACKETON CONSOLE
BRACKET,‘A’
POSTTRIM
TOP OF TRANSMISSION
ASSEMBLY
GROUNDS Ground
Location
EMlAR
EYELET
symbols
are used to represent
I Input 0 output SG Signal Ground CAUTION: The information REFERENCE ONLY.
D C S
values for Control
Serial and encoded CAN (Network) SCP Network
communications
on this data Page is furnished
NoTE: The values listed are approximately components connected and fitted. “Active”
Module
Pin Out data: B+ V Hz
to aid the user in understanding
Battery voltage Voltage (DC) Frequency circuit operation.
KHz MS MV
Frequency x 1000 Milliseconds Millivolts
THIS INFORMATION
HAND
LEG,
ENGINE
COMPARTMENT.
HAND
LEG,
ENGINE
COMPARTMENT,
EMlBL
EYELET
(PAIR) - RlGHT
EMIBS
EYELET
ISINGLE),
EMZAR
EYELET
(P,+,R)
EM2BL
EYELET
IPAIR) - LEFT HAND
ENGlNE RlGHT
COMPARTMENT,
HAND
ENGINE
LEG, LEG,
RIGHT
ENGINE ENGINE
HAND
COMPARTMENT,
EYELET
(SINGLE),
FCZAL
EYELET
(PAIR) - LEFT HAND
LEG,
RIGHT
FIXAL
EYELET EYELET
(PAIRI - LEFT HAND (PA,R) LEFT HAND
LEG, LEG,
LEFT HAND ‘X POST ENGINE COMPARTMENT.
LFZAR
EYELET
(PAIR)
LF?BL
EYELET
(PAIR, - LEFT HAND
RH2S
EYELET
(SINGLE),
CONTROL
MODULE
COMPARTMENT.
RIGHT HAND
LEG, LEG,
LEFT HAND
LEFT HAND HAND
ENGINE ENGlNE
RIGHT
HAND
ENCLOSURE
RIGHT
HAND
ENCLOSURE
ENCLOSURE
COMPARTMENT,
EM?BS
LF2AL
The following
/ Type
iPAl!% - RlGHT
LEFT HAND LEFT HAND
ENCLOSURE ENCLOSURE
ENCLOSURE
‘X POST
COMPARTMENT, COMPARTMENT,
FORWARD FORWARD FORWARD
OF LEFT HAND OF LEFT HAND OF LEFT HAND
HOOD CATCH HOOD HOOD
CATCH CATCH
REAR QUARTER
PIN OUT INFORMATION
(FOLD OUT PAGE)
SHOULD BE USED FOR
those that can be expected at the control module connector pins with all circuit connections made and all means a load is applied or a switch is ON; “Inactive” means a load is not aoolied or a switch is OFF.
REFER TO THE FRONT OF THE BOOK FOR ILLUSTRATIONS DETAILING THE LOCATION AND lDENTlFlCATlON CONNECTORS. HARNESSES. GROUNDS, VEHICLE CONTROL MODULES AND CONTROL MODULE PINS. DATE
OF ISSUE:
FEBRUARY
1998
OF COMPONENTS,
RELAYS,
CONTROL MAJOR
MODULE
PIN OUT INFORMATION
INSTRUMENT
COMPONENTS
PACK
Description GROUND
Active GROUND B+ B+ GROUND
SUPPLY MINORINSTRUMENT PACKWLITTERY POWER SUPPLY ADAPTl”E DAMPING WARNlNG TRIPCYCLE ‘NB’TRIPSELECT ‘ML,KM’SELECT SWNErwORK SW NETWORK cm NEWORK CANNETWORK BATTERY POWER SUPPLY GROUNO lLL”MlNATlON SUPPLY MINOR lNSTRUMENT PACK ILL”M,NAT,ON SUPPLY GROUND REFERENCE ‘CLEAR’ SELECT ‘000’SELECT CANNETWORK CANNETWORK IGNITION
SWITCHED
POWER
SPEED-ADAPTIVE
BAnERY
VOLTAGE
BATTERYVOLTAGE OIL PRESSURE BATTERY
B-
GROUND
IMOMENTARY)
GROUND
IMOMENTARY)
GROUND
IMOMENTARY)
DAMPING
CONTROL
MlNOR lNSTRUMENT TR,P COMPUTER
FC79
20.WAY
PI40 ,‘1-WAY
,COLUMN
SC2
SWITCHGEAR)
ENGlNE
BROWN
RESERVOIR
FASCIA ENGINE
BLACK
BLACK
FASCIA;
070 I YELLOW
STEERING
AMP MOL:
BLOCK:
RlGHT
HAND
SIDE
DRIVER SIDE COLUMN
CONNECTORS Location
/ Access
WWAY
MULTfiOCK
070 /WHITE
TRUNK
20.WAY
MULTILOCK
070 /WHITE
ENGlNE
COMPARTMENT!ADJACENTTO
RlGHT
HAND
ENCLOSURE
070,
ENGlNE
COMPARTMENT
R,GHT HAND
ENCLOSURE
ENGINE
COMPARTMENT!
BEHIND
GLOVE
16-WAY
I COOLANT
FASCIA
BLACK BLACK
040 ,’ BLACK ECJZ,
MULT,LOCK
I Access
COMPARTMENT
TRUNK!FUELTANK
MULTILOCK ECONOSEAL
10.WAY
Type / Color
Connector
POWER TIMER,
AMP PCB SIGNAL, AMP PCS SIGNAL,
FCZ, / 10.WAY
PACK
MULTILOCK
(MOMENTARY)
57~WAY SUMlTOMO,
GROUND
iMOMENTARY
20.WAY
15-1500
HZ
MULTILOCK
YELLOW
BLACK 070,
GREY
/ABOVE
RIGHT
HAND
REAR WHEEL
‘ADJACENTTO BRACKET
ARCH
ON TOP OF TRANSMISSION
BOX
15-1500Hr C3”
B+
3w
VEHICLE
SPEED
22 Hz @ 10 MPH 116 KM/HI:
DIMMER
OVERRIDE
GROUND
CHARGE
WARNING
B+
WARNING
(PAIR) - RlGHT
@ B+
5”
WARNING
EYELET
44 Hz @ 20 MPH 132 KM/HI
5”
FEEDBACK
Location
EMlBR
44 HZ @ 20 MPH 132 KM/HI
FEEDBACK
GROUND
Ground
22 HZ Q 10 MPH ,16 KWH,;
FEEDBACK
FEEDBACK
GROUNDS
22 HZ @ 10 MPH 116 KM/H,;
37-5”iPULSEl
LOW COOLANT
PACK
GROUND
MOVEMENT
LOW OIL PRESSURE
4%WAY 24.WAY
HARNESS-TO-HARNESS
GROUND
POSlTlON
POSlTlON
FC25! FC26:
SWITCH
Location
I Type I Color RIGHT ANGLE RIGHT ANGLE
PACK
SWITCH
TRlP CYCLE SWITCH
POSITION
GAUGE
BT7 ! LUCAR BTB / LUCAR
INSTRUMENT
OIL PRESSURE
GAUGE
POSlTlON
MAJOR
GROUND
GAUGE
44 HZ @ 20 MPH 132 KWH,
e Br
B+ GROUND Bt
GROUND
PACK Inactive B+
Pin FCE~E
MINOR
/
x79-9
OIL PRESSURE
GAUGE
MOVEMENT
37-5”iPULSEi
I
FC79-10
Oil PRESSURE
GAUGE
MOVEMENT
3 7 - 6 ” ,PULSEi
I
FC79-1,
CHARGE
I
FC79-12
BATTERY
1
FC79~13
EATERY
VOLTAGE
I
FCX-14
BATTERY
VOLTAGE VOLTAGE
GAUGE
Description
Active
INSTRUMENT
PACK ,LLUMlNAT,ON
SUPPLY
B+
WARNING
Bi